ee592d91cb40012b5463de3ead716940c788501e
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,
3 @c 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006
4 @c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 @c
6 @c %**start of header
7 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
8 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
9 @setfilename gdb.info
10 @c
11 @include gdb-cfg.texi
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @syncodeindex ky cp
24
25 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
26 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
27 @syncodeindex vr cp
28 @syncodeindex fn cp
29
30 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
31 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
32 @set EDITION Ninth
33
34 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
35 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
36
37 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
38
39 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
40 @c manuals to an info tree.
41 @dircategory Software development
42 @direntry
43 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
44 @end direntry
45
46 @ifinfo
47 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
48
49
50 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
51 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
52 Version @value{GDBVN}.
53
54 Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,@*
55 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006@*
56 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
57
58 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
59 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
60 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
61 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
62 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
63 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
64
65 (a) The Free Software Foundation's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have
66 freedom to copy and modify this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies
67 published by the Free Software Foundation raise funds for GNU
68 development.''
69 @end ifinfo
70
71 @titlepage
72 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
73 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
74 @sp 1
75 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
76 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
77 @page
78 @tex
79 {\parskip=0pt
80 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to bug-gdb\@gnu.org.)\par
81 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
82 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
83 }
84 @end tex
85
86 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
87 Copyright @copyright{} 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995,
88 1996, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2006
89 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
90 @sp 2
91 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
92 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
93 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
94 ISBN 1-882114-77-9 @*
95
96 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
97 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
98 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
99 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
100 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
101 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
102
103 (a) The Free Software Foundation's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have
104 freedom to copy and modify this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies
105 published by the Free Software Foundation raise funds for GNU
106 development.''
107 @end titlepage
108 @page
109
110 @ifnottex
111 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
112
113 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
114
115 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
116
117 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} Version
118 @value{GDBVN}.
119
120 Copyright (C) 1988-2006 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
121
122 @menu
123 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
124 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
125
126 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
127 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
128 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
129 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
130 * Stack:: Examining the stack
131 * Source:: Examining source files
132 * Data:: Examining data
133 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
134 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
135 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
136
137 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
138
139 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
140 * Altering:: Altering execution
141 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
142 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
143 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
144 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
145 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
146 * Sequences:: Canned sequences of commands
147 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
148 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
149 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
150 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
151 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
152
153 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
154
155 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
156 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
157 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
158 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
159 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
160 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
161 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
162 * Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to
163 @value{GDBN}
164 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
165 how you can copy and share GDB
166 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
167 * Index:: Index
168 @end menu
169
170 @end ifnottex
171
172 @contents
173
174 @node Summary
175 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
176
177 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
178 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
179 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
180
181 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
182 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
183
184 @itemize @bullet
185 @item
186 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
187
188 @item
189 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
190
191 @item
192 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
193
194 @item
195 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
196 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
197 @end itemize
198
199 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
200 For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}.
201 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
202
203 @cindex Modula-2
204 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
205 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
206
207 @cindex Pascal
208 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
209 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
210 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
211 syntax.
212
213 @cindex Fortran
214 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
215 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
216 underscore.
217
218 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
219 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
220
221 @menu
222 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
223 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
224 @end menu
225
226 @node Free Software
227 @unnumberedsec Free Software
228
229 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
230 General Public License
231 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
232 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
233 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
234 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
235 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
236 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
237
238 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
239 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
240 from anyone else.
241
242 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
243
244 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
245 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
246 include with the free software. Many of our most important
247 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
248 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
249 when an important free software package does not come with a free
250 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
251 gaps today.
252
253 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
254 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
255 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
256 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
257 them from the free software world.
258
259 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
260 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
261 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
262 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
263 contract to make it non-free.
264
265 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
266 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
267 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
268 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
269 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
270 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
271 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
272
273 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
274 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
275 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
276 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
277
278 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
279 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
280 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
281 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
282 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
283 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
284 community.
285
286 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
287 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
288 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
289 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
290 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
291 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
292 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
293 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
294 of the manual.
295
296 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
297 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
298 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
299 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
300 manual to replace it.
301
302 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
303 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
304 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
305 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
306 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
307 the free software community.
308
309 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
310 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
311 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
312 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
313 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
314 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
315 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
316 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
317 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
318
319 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
320 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
321 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
322 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
323 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
324 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
325 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
326 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
327
328 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
329 published by other publishers, at
330 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
331
332 @node Contributors
333 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
334
335 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
336 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
337 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
338 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
339 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
340 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
341 blow-by-blow account.
342
343 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
344
345 @quotation
346 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
347 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
348 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
349 @end quotation
350
351 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
352 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
353 releases:
354 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
355 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
356 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
357 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
358 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
359 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
360 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
361 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
362 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
363
364 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
365 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
366
367 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
368 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
369 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
370 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
371 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
372
373 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
374 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
375 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
376
377 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
378 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
379
380 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
381
382 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
383 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
384 support.
385 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
386 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
387 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
388 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
389 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
390 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
391 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
392 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
393 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
394 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
395 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
396 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
397 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
398 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
399 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
400 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
401
402 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
403
404 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
405 libraries.
406
407 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
408 about several machine instruction sets.
409
410 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
411 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
412 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
413 and RDI targets, respectively.
414
415 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
416 command-line editing and command history.
417
418 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
419 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
420
421 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
422 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
423 symbols.
424
425 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
426 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
427
428 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
429
430 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
431 processors.
432
433 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
434
435 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
436
437 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
438
439 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
440 watchpoints.
441
442 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
443
444 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
445
446 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
447 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
448
449 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
450 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
451 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
452 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
453 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
454 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
455 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
456
457 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
458 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
459
460 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
461 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
462 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
463 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
464 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
465 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
466 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
467 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
468 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
469 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
470 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
471 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
472 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
473 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
474 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
475
476 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
477 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
478
479 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
480 Hat.
481
482 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
483 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
484 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
485 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
486 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
487 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
488
489 Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
490 unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
491 frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
492 Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
493 libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
494 trad unwinders. The architecture-specific changes, each involving a
495 complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
496 Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
497 Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
498 Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
499 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
500 Weigand.
501
502 Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
503 Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
504 who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
505 Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
506
507 @node Sample Session
508 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
509
510 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
511 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
512 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
513
514 @iftex
515 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
516 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
517 @end iftex
518
519 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
520 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
521
522 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
523 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
524 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
525 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
526 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
527 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
528 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
529 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
530 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
531
532 @smallexample
533 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
534 $ @b{./m4}
535 @b{define(foo,0000)}
536
537 @b{foo}
538 0000
539 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
540
541 @b{bar}
542 0000
543 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
544
545 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
546 @b{baz}
547 @b{Ctrl-d}
548 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
549 @end smallexample
550
551 @noindent
552 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
553
554 @smallexample
555 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
556 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
557 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
558 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
559 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
560 the conditions.
561 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
562 for details.
563
564 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
565 (@value{GDBP})
566 @end smallexample
567
568 @noindent
569 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
570 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
571 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
572 that examples fit in this manual.
573
574 @smallexample
575 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
576 @end smallexample
577
578 @noindent
579 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
580 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
581 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
582 @code{break} command.
583
584 @smallexample
585 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
586 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
587 @end smallexample
588
589 @noindent
590 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
591 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
592 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
593
594 @smallexample
595 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
596 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
597 @b{define(foo,0000)}
598
599 @b{foo}
600 0000
601 @end smallexample
602
603 @noindent
604 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
605 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
606 context where it stops.
607
608 @smallexample
609 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
610
611 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
612 at builtin.c:879
613 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
614 @end smallexample
615
616 @noindent
617 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
618 the next line of the current function.
619
620 @smallexample
621 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
622 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
623 : nil,
624 @end smallexample
625
626 @noindent
627 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
628 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
629 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
630 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
631
632 @smallexample
633 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
634 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
635 at input.c:530
636 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
637 @end smallexample
638
639 @noindent
640 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
641 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
642 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
643 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
644 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
645 stack frame for each active subroutine.
646
647 @smallexample
648 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
649 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
650 at input.c:530
651 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
652 at builtin.c:882
653 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
654 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
655 at macro.c:71
656 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
657 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
658 @end smallexample
659
660 @noindent
661 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
662 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
663 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
664
665 @smallexample
666 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
667 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
668 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
669 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
670 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
671 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
672 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
673 : xstrdup(rq);
674 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
675 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
676 @end smallexample
677
678 @noindent
679 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
680 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
681 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
682 (@code{print}) to see their values.
683
684 @smallexample
685 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
686 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
687 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
688 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
689 @end smallexample
690
691 @noindent
692 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
693 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
694 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
695
696 @smallexample
697 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
698 533 xfree(rquote);
699 534
700 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
701 : xstrdup (lq);
702 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
703 : xstrdup (rq);
704 537
705 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
706 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
707 540 @}
708 541
709 542 void
710 @end smallexample
711
712 @noindent
713 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
714 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
715
716 @smallexample
717 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
718 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
719 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
720 540 @}
721 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
722 $3 = 9
723 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
724 $4 = 7
725 @end smallexample
726
727 @noindent
728 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
729 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
730 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
731 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
732 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
733 assignments.
734
735 @smallexample
736 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
737 $5 = 7
738 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
739 $6 = 9
740 @end smallexample
741
742 @noindent
743 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
744 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
745 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
746 example that caused trouble initially:
747
748 @smallexample
749 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
750 Continuing.
751
752 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
753
754 baz
755 0000
756 @end smallexample
757
758 @noindent
759 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
760 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
761 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
762
763 @smallexample
764 @b{Ctrl-d}
765 Program exited normally.
766 @end smallexample
767
768 @noindent
769 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
770 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
771 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
772
773 @smallexample
774 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
775 @end smallexample
776
777 @node Invocation
778 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
779
780 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
781 The essentials are:
782 @itemize @bullet
783 @item
784 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
785 @item
786 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
787 @end itemize
788
789 @menu
790 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
791 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
792 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
793 * Logging Output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
794 @end menu
795
796 @node Invoking GDB
797 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
798
799 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
800 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
801
802 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
803 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
804
805 The command-line options described here are designed
806 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
807 options may effectively be unavailable.
808
809 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
810 specifying an executable program:
811
812 @smallexample
813 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
814 @end smallexample
815
816 @noindent
817 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
818 specified:
819
820 @smallexample
821 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
822 @end smallexample
823
824 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
825 to debug a running process:
826
827 @smallexample
828 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
829 @end smallexample
830
831 @noindent
832 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
833 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
834
835 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
836 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
837 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
838 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
839 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
840
841 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
842 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
843 option processing.
844 @smallexample
845 @value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
846 @end smallexample
847 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
848 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
849
850 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
851 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
852
853 @smallexample
854 @value{GDBP} -silent
855 @end smallexample
856
857 @noindent
858 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
859 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
860
861 @noindent
862 Type
863
864 @smallexample
865 @value{GDBP} -help
866 @end smallexample
867
868 @noindent
869 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
870 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
871
872 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
873 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
874 @samp{-x} option is used.
875
876
877 @menu
878 * File Options:: Choosing files
879 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
880 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
881 @end menu
882
883 @node File Options
884 @subsection Choosing Files
885
886 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
887 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
888 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
889 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
890 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
891 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
892 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
893 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
894 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
895 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
896 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
897 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
898 prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
899
900 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
901 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
902 argument and ignore it.
903
904 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
905 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
906 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
907 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
908 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
909
910 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
911 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
912 @c it.
913
914 @table @code
915 @item -symbols @var{file}
916 @itemx -s @var{file}
917 @cindex @code{--symbols}
918 @cindex @code{-s}
919 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
920
921 @item -exec @var{file}
922 @itemx -e @var{file}
923 @cindex @code{--exec}
924 @cindex @code{-e}
925 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
926 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
927
928 @item -se @var{file}
929 @cindex @code{--se}
930 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
931 file.
932
933 @item -core @var{file}
934 @itemx -c @var{file}
935 @cindex @code{--core}
936 @cindex @code{-c}
937 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
938
939 @item -c @var{number}
940 @item -pid @var{number}
941 @itemx -p @var{number}
942 @cindex @code{--pid}
943 @cindex @code{-p}
944 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
945 If there is no such process, @value{GDBN} will attempt to open a core
946 file named @var{number}.
947
948 @item -command @var{file}
949 @itemx -x @var{file}
950 @cindex @code{--command}
951 @cindex @code{-x}
952 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}. @xref{Command
953 Files,, Command files}.
954
955 @item -eval-command @var{command}
956 @itemx -ex @var{command}
957 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
958 @cindex @code{-ex}
959 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
960
961 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
962 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
963
964 @smallexample
965 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
966 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
967 @end smallexample
968
969 @item -directory @var{directory}
970 @itemx -d @var{directory}
971 @cindex @code{--directory}
972 @cindex @code{-d}
973 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
974
975 @item -r
976 @itemx -readnow
977 @cindex @code{--readnow}
978 @cindex @code{-r}
979 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
980 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
981 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
982
983 @end table
984
985 @node Mode Options
986 @subsection Choosing Modes
987
988 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
989 batch mode or quiet mode.
990
991 @table @code
992 @item -nx
993 @itemx -n
994 @cindex @code{--nx}
995 @cindex @code{-n}
996 Do not execute commands found in any initialization files. Normally,
997 @value{GDBN} executes the commands in these files after all the command
998 options and arguments have been processed. @xref{Command Files,,Command
999 Files}.
1000
1001 @item -quiet
1002 @itemx -silent
1003 @itemx -q
1004 @cindex @code{--quiet}
1005 @cindex @code{--silent}
1006 @cindex @code{-q}
1007 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1008 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1009
1010 @item -batch
1011 @cindex @code{--batch}
1012 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1013 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1014 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1015 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1016 in the command files.
1017
1018 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1019 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1020 make this more useful, the message
1021
1022 @smallexample
1023 Program exited normally.
1024 @end smallexample
1025
1026 @noindent
1027 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1028 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1029 mode.
1030
1031 @item -batch-silent
1032 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1033 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1034 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1035 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1036 for an interactive session.
1037
1038 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1039 messages, for example.
1040
1041 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1042 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1043
1044 @item -return-child-result
1045 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1046 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1047 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1048
1049 @itemize @bullet
1050 @item
1051 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1052 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1053 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1054 @item
1055 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1056 @item
1057 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1058 the exit code will be -1.
1059 @end itemize
1060
1061 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1062 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1063 interface.
1064
1065 @item -nowindows
1066 @itemx -nw
1067 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1068 @cindex @code{-nw}
1069 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1070 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1071 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1072
1073 @item -windows
1074 @itemx -w
1075 @cindex @code{--windows}
1076 @cindex @code{-w}
1077 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1078 used if possible.
1079
1080 @item -cd @var{directory}
1081 @cindex @code{--cd}
1082 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1083 instead of the current directory.
1084
1085 @item -fullname
1086 @itemx -f
1087 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1088 @cindex @code{-f}
1089 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1090 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1091 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1092 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1093 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1094 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1095 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1096 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1097 frame.
1098
1099 @item -epoch
1100 @cindex @code{--epoch}
1101 The Epoch Emacs-@value{GDBN} interface sets this option when it runs
1102 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to modify its print
1103 routines so as to allow Epoch to display values of expressions in a
1104 separate window.
1105
1106 @item -annotate @var{level}
1107 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1108 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1109 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1110 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1111 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1112 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1113 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1114 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1115 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1116
1117 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1118 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1119
1120 @item --args
1121 @cindex @code{--args}
1122 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1123 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1124 This option stops option processing.
1125
1126 @item -baud @var{bps}
1127 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1128 @cindex @code{--baud}
1129 @cindex @code{-b}
1130 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1131 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1132
1133 @item -l @var{timeout}
1134 @cindex @code{-l}
1135 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1136 for remote debugging.
1137
1138 @item -tty @var{device}
1139 @itemx -t @var{device}
1140 @cindex @code{--tty}
1141 @cindex @code{-t}
1142 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1143 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1144
1145 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1146 @item -tui
1147 @cindex @code{--tui}
1148 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1149 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1150 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1151 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Alternatively, the
1152 Text User Interface can be enabled by invoking the program
1153 @samp{@value{GDBTUI}}. Do not use this option if you run @value{GDBN} from
1154 Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1155
1156 @c @item -xdb
1157 @c @cindex @code{--xdb}
1158 @c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1159 @c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1160 @c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1161 @c systems.
1162
1163 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1164 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1165 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1166 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1167 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1168 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1169
1170 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1171 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1172 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1173 previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1174 selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier
1175 @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1176
1177 @item -write
1178 @cindex @code{--write}
1179 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1180 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1181 (@pxref{Patching}).
1182
1183 @item -statistics
1184 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1185 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1186 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1187
1188 @item -version
1189 @cindex @code{--version}
1190 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1191 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1192
1193 @end table
1194
1195 @node Startup
1196 @subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup
1197 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1198
1199 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1200
1201 @enumerate
1202 @item
1203 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1204 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1205
1206 @item
1207 @cindex init file
1208 Reads the @dfn{init file} (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1209 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1210 @code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1211 that file.
1212
1213 @item
1214 Processes command line options and operands.
1215
1216 @item
1217 Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1218 working directory. This is only done if the current directory is
1219 different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1220 init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1221 to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1222 @value{GDBN}.
1223
1224 @item
1225 Reads command files specified by the @samp{-x} option. @xref{Command
1226 Files}, for more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1227
1228 @item
1229 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1230 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1231 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1232 @end enumerate
1233
1234 Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1235 Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1236 file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1237 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1238 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1239 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing Modes}).
1240
1241 @cindex init file name
1242 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1243 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1244 The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1245 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1246 the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1247 ports of @value{GDBN} use the standard name, but if they find a
1248 @file{gdb.ini} file, they warn you about that and suggest to rename
1249 the file to the standard name.
1250
1251
1252 @node Quitting GDB
1253 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1254 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1255 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1256
1257 @table @code
1258 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1259 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1260 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1261 @itemx q
1262 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1263 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1264 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1265 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1266 error code.
1267 @end table
1268
1269 @cindex interrupt
1270 An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1271 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1272 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1273 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1274 until a time when it is safe.
1275
1276 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1277 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1278 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
1279
1280 @node Shell Commands
1281 @section Shell Commands
1282
1283 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1284 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1285 just use the @code{shell} command.
1286
1287 @table @code
1288 @kindex shell
1289 @cindex shell escape
1290 @item shell @var{command string}
1291 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command string}.
1292 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1293 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1294 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1295 @end table
1296
1297 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1298 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1299 @value{GDBN}:
1300
1301 @table @code
1302 @kindex make
1303 @cindex calling make
1304 @item make @var{make-args}
1305 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1306 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1307 @end table
1308
1309 @node Logging Output
1310 @section Logging Output
1311 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1312 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1313
1314 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1315 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1316
1317 @table @code
1318 @kindex set logging
1319 @item set logging on
1320 Enable logging.
1321 @item set logging off
1322 Disable logging.
1323 @cindex logging file name
1324 @item set logging file @var{file}
1325 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1326 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1327 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1328 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1329 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1330 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1331 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1332 @kindex show logging
1333 @item show logging
1334 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1335 @end table
1336
1337 @node Commands
1338 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1339
1340 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1341 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1342 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1343 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1344 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1345
1346 @menu
1347 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1348 * Completion:: Command completion
1349 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1350 @end menu
1351
1352 @node Command Syntax
1353 @section Command Syntax
1354
1355 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1356 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1357 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1358 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1359 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1360 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1361
1362 @cindex abbreviation
1363 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1364 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1365 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1366 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1367 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1368 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1369 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1370
1371 @cindex repeating commands
1372 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1373 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1374 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1375 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1376 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1377 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1378 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1379
1380 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1381 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1382 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1383
1384 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1385 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1386 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}). Since it is easy to press one
1387 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1388 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1389
1390 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1391 @cindex comment
1392 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1393 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1394 Files,,Command Files}).
1395
1396 @cindex repeating command sequences
1397 @kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1398 The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1399 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1400 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1401 for editing.
1402
1403 @node Completion
1404 @section Command Completion
1405
1406 @cindex completion
1407 @cindex word completion
1408 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1409 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1410 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1411 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1412
1413 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1414 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1415 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1416 enter it). For example, if you type
1417
1418 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1419 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1420 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1421 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1422 @smallexample
1423 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1424 @end smallexample
1425
1426 @noindent
1427 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1428 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1429
1430 @smallexample
1431 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1432 @end smallexample
1433
1434 @noindent
1435 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1436 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1437 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1438 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1439 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1440 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1441
1442 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1443 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1444 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1445 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1446 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1447 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1448 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1449 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1450 example:
1451
1452 @smallexample
1453 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1454 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1455 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1456 make_abs_section make_function_type
1457 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1458 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1459 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1460 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1461 @end smallexample
1462
1463 @noindent
1464 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1465 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1466 command.
1467
1468 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1469 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1470 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1471 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1472 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1473
1474 @cindex quotes in commands
1475 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1476 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1477 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1478 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1479 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1480 @value{GDBN} commands.
1481
1482 The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1483 name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1484 overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1485 by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1486 may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1487 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1488 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1489 word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1490 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1491 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1492 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1493
1494 @smallexample
1495 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1496 bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1497 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1498 @end smallexample
1499
1500 In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1501 quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1502 completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1503 place:
1504
1505 @smallexample
1506 (@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1507 @exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1508 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1509 @end smallexample
1510
1511 @noindent
1512 In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1513 you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1514 completion on an overloaded symbol.
1515
1516 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus
1517 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1518 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1519 see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
1520
1521
1522 @node Help
1523 @section Getting Help
1524 @cindex online documentation
1525 @kindex help
1526
1527 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1528 using the command @code{help}.
1529
1530 @table @code
1531 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1532 @item help
1533 @itemx h
1534 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1535 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1536
1537 @smallexample
1538 (@value{GDBP}) help
1539 List of classes of commands:
1540
1541 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1542 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1543 data -- Examining data
1544 files -- Specifying and examining files
1545 internals -- Maintenance commands
1546 obscure -- Obscure features
1547 running -- Running the program
1548 stack -- Examining the stack
1549 status -- Status inquiries
1550 support -- Support facilities
1551 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without
1552 stopping the program
1553 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1554
1555 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1556 commands in that class.
1557 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1558 documentation.
1559 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1560 (@value{GDBP})
1561 @end smallexample
1562 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1563
1564 @item help @var{class}
1565 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1566 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1567 help display for the class @code{status}:
1568
1569 @smallexample
1570 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1571 Status inquiries.
1572
1573 List of commands:
1574
1575 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1576 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1577 info -- Generic command for showing things
1578 about the program being debugged
1579 show -- Generic command for showing things
1580 about the debugger
1581
1582 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1583 documentation.
1584 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1585 (@value{GDBP})
1586 @end smallexample
1587
1588 @item help @var{command}
1589 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1590 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1591
1592 @kindex apropos
1593 @item apropos @var{args}
1594 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1595 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1596 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1597
1598 @smallexample
1599 apropos reload
1600 @end smallexample
1601
1602 @noindent
1603 results in:
1604
1605 @smallexample
1606 @c @group
1607 set symbol-reloading -- Set dynamic symbol table reloading
1608 multiple times in one run
1609 show symbol-reloading -- Show dynamic symbol table reloading
1610 multiple times in one run
1611 @c @end group
1612 @end smallexample
1613
1614 @kindex complete
1615 @item complete @var{args}
1616 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1617 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1618 command you want completed. For example:
1619
1620 @smallexample
1621 complete i
1622 @end smallexample
1623
1624 @noindent results in:
1625
1626 @smallexample
1627 @group
1628 if
1629 ignore
1630 info
1631 inspect
1632 @end group
1633 @end smallexample
1634
1635 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1636 @end table
1637
1638 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1639 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1640 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1641 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1642 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Index point to
1643 all the sub-commands. @xref{Index}.
1644
1645 @c @group
1646 @table @code
1647 @kindex info
1648 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1649 @item info
1650 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1651 program. For example, you can list the arguments given to your program
1652 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1653 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1654 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1655 @w{@code{help info}}.
1656
1657 @kindex set
1658 @item set
1659 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1660 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1661 @code{set prompt $}.
1662
1663 @kindex show
1664 @item show
1665 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1666 @value{GDBN} itself.
1667 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1668 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1669 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1670 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1671
1672 @kindex info set
1673 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1674 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1675 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1676 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1677 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1678 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1679 @end table
1680 @c @end group
1681
1682 Here are three miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1683 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1684
1685 @table @code
1686 @kindex show version
1687 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1688 @item show version
1689 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1690 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1691 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1692 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1693 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1694 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1695 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1696 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1697 @value{GDBN}.
1698
1699 @kindex show copying
1700 @kindex info copying
1701 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1702 @item show copying
1703 @itemx info copying
1704 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1705
1706 @kindex show warranty
1707 @kindex info warranty
1708 @item show warranty
1709 @itemx info warranty
1710 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1711 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1712
1713 @end table
1714
1715 @node Running
1716 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1717
1718 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1719 debugging information when you compile it.
1720
1721 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1722 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1723 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1724 kill a child process.
1725
1726 @menu
1727 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1728 * Starting:: Starting your program
1729 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1730 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1731
1732 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1733 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1734 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1735 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1736
1737 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1738 * Processes:: Debugging programs with multiple processes
1739 * Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1740 @end menu
1741
1742 @node Compilation
1743 @section Compiling for Debugging
1744
1745 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1746 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1747 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1748 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1749 and addresses in the executable code.
1750
1751 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1752 the compiler.
1753
1754 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
1755 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, many
1756 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
1757 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1758 executables containing debugging information.
1759
1760 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1761 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1762 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1763 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1764 in pushing your luck.
1765
1766 @cindex optimized code, debugging
1767 @cindex debugging optimized code
1768 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
1769 optimizer is rearranging your code; the debugger shows you what is
1770 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
1771 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
1772 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
1773 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
1774
1775 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
1776 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
1777 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
1778 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
1779 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
1780
1781 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1782 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1783 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1784
1785 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
1786 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
1787 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
1788 the @option{-g} flag alone, because this information is rather large.
1789 Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
1790 provides macro information if you specify the options
1791 @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3}; the former option requests
1792 debugging information in the Dwarf 2 format, and the latter requests
1793 ``extra information''. In the future, we hope to find more compact
1794 ways to represent macro information, so that it can be included with
1795 @option{-g} alone.
1796
1797 @need 2000
1798 @node Starting
1799 @section Starting your Program
1800 @cindex starting
1801 @cindex running
1802
1803 @table @code
1804 @kindex run
1805 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
1806 @item run
1807 @itemx r
1808 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1809 You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1810 argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1811 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1812 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
1813
1814 @end table
1815
1816 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1817 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1818 that process run your program. (In environments without processes,
1819 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program.)
1820
1821 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
1822 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
1823 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
1824 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
1825 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
1826 divided into four categories:
1827
1828 @table @asis
1829 @item The @emph{arguments.}
1830 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
1831 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
1832 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
1833 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
1834 the arguments.
1835 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
1836 @code{SHELL} environment variable.
1837 @xref{Arguments, ,Your Program's Arguments}.
1838
1839 @item The @emph{environment.}
1840 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
1841 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
1842 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
1843 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}.
1844
1845 @item The @emph{working directory.}
1846 Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
1847 the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
1848 @xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working Directory}.
1849
1850 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
1851 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
1852 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
1853 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
1854 set a different device for your program.
1855 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}.
1856
1857 @cindex pipes
1858 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
1859 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
1860 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
1861 wrong program.
1862 @end table
1863
1864 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
1865 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion
1866 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
1867 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
1868 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
1869
1870 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
1871 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
1872 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
1873 your current breakpoints.
1874
1875 @table @code
1876 @kindex start
1877 @item start
1878 @cindex run to main procedure
1879 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
1880 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
1881 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
1882 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
1883 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
1884 procedure, depending on the language used.
1885
1886 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
1887 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
1888 the @samp{run} command.
1889
1890 @cindex elaboration phase
1891 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
1892 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
1893 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
1894 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
1895 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
1896 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
1897 will remain to halt execution.
1898
1899 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
1900 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
1901 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
1902 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
1903 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
1904
1905 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
1906 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution of
1907 your program too late, as the program would have already completed the
1908 elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, insert breakpoints in your
1909 elaboration code before running your program.
1910 @end table
1911
1912 @node Arguments
1913 @section Your Program's Arguments
1914
1915 @cindex arguments (to your program)
1916 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
1917 @code{run} command.
1918 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
1919 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
1920 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
1921 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
1922 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
1923
1924 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
1925 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
1926 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
1927 the program, not by the shell.
1928
1929 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
1930 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
1931
1932 @table @code
1933 @kindex set args
1934 @item set args
1935 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
1936 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
1937 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
1938 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
1939 it again without arguments.
1940
1941 @kindex show args
1942 @item show args
1943 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
1944 @end table
1945
1946 @node Environment
1947 @section Your Program's Environment
1948
1949 @cindex environment (of your program)
1950 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
1951 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
1952 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
1953 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
1954 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
1955 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
1956 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
1957
1958 @table @code
1959 @kindex path
1960 @item path @var{directory}
1961 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
1962 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
1963 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
1964 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
1965 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
1966 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
1967 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
1968
1969 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
1970 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
1971 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
1972 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
1973 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
1974 @var{directory} to the search path.
1975 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
1976 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
1977
1978 @kindex show paths
1979 @item show paths
1980 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
1981 environment variable).
1982
1983 @kindex show environment
1984 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
1985 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
1986 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
1987 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
1988 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
1989
1990 @kindex set environment
1991 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
1992 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
1993 changes for your program only, not for @value{GDBN} itself. @var{value} may
1994 be any string; the values of environment variables are just strings, and
1995 any interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
1996 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
1997 null value.
1998 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
1999 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2000
2001 For example, this command:
2002
2003 @smallexample
2004 set env USER = foo
2005 @end smallexample
2006
2007 @noindent
2008 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2009 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2010 are not actually required.)
2011
2012 @kindex unset environment
2013 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2014 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2015 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2016 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2017 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2018 @end table
2019
2020 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2021 the shell indicated
2022 by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it exists (or
2023 @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable names a shell
2024 that runs an initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, or
2025 @file{.bashrc} for BASH---any variables you set in that file affect
2026 your program. You may wish to move setting of environment variables to
2027 files that are only run when you sign on, such as @file{.login} or
2028 @file{.profile}.
2029
2030 @node Working Directory
2031 @section Your Program's Working Directory
2032
2033 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2034 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
2035 working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
2036 The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
2037 from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
2038 working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
2039
2040 The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
2041 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2042 Specify Files}.
2043
2044 @table @code
2045 @kindex cd
2046 @cindex change working directory
2047 @item cd @var{directory}
2048 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}.
2049
2050 @kindex pwd
2051 @item pwd
2052 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2053 @end table
2054
2055 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2056 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2057 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} is
2058 configured with the @file{/proc} support, you can use the @code{info
2059 proc} command (@pxref{SVR4 Process Information}) to find out the
2060 current working directory of the debuggee.
2061
2062 @node Input/Output
2063 @section Your Program's Input and Output
2064
2065 @cindex redirection
2066 @cindex i/o
2067 @cindex terminal
2068 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2069 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2070 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2071 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2072 running your program.
2073
2074 @table @code
2075 @kindex info terminal
2076 @item info terminal
2077 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2078 program is using.
2079 @end table
2080
2081 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2082 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2083
2084 @smallexample
2085 run > outfile
2086 @end smallexample
2087
2088 @noindent
2089 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2090
2091 @kindex tty
2092 @cindex controlling terminal
2093 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2094 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2095 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2096 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2097 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2098
2099 @smallexample
2100 tty /dev/ttyb
2101 @end smallexample
2102
2103 @noindent
2104 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2105 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2106 that as their controlling terminal.
2107
2108 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2109 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2110 terminal.
2111
2112 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2113 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2114 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2115 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2116
2117 @cindex inferior tty
2118 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2119 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2120 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2121 program.
2122
2123 @table @code
2124 @item set inferior-tty /dev/ttyb
2125 @kindex set inferior-tty
2126 Set the tty for the program being debugged to /dev/ttyb.
2127
2128 @item show inferior-tty
2129 @kindex show inferior-tty
2130 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2131 @end table
2132
2133 @node Attach
2134 @section Debugging an Already-running Process
2135 @kindex attach
2136 @cindex attach
2137
2138 @table @code
2139 @item attach @var{process-id}
2140 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2141 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2142 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2143 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2144 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2145
2146 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2147 executing the command.
2148 @end table
2149
2150 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2151 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2152 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2153 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2154
2155 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2156 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2157 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2158 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}). You can also use
2159 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2160 Specify Files}.
2161
2162 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2163 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2164 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2165 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2166 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2167 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2168 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2169
2170 @table @code
2171 @kindex detach
2172 @item detach
2173 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2174 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2175 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2176 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2177 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2178 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2179 executing the command.
2180 @end table
2181
2182 If you exit @value{GDBN} while you have an attached process, you detach
2183 that process. If you use the @code{run} command, you kill that process.
2184 By default, @value{GDBN} asks for confirmation if you try to do either of these
2185 things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using the
2186 @code{set confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
2187 Messages}).
2188
2189 @node Kill Process
2190 @section Killing the Child Process
2191
2192 @table @code
2193 @kindex kill
2194 @item kill
2195 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2196 @end table
2197
2198 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2199 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2200 is running.
2201
2202 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2203 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2204 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2205 outside the debugger.
2206
2207 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2208 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2209 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2210 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2211 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2212 breakpoint settings).
2213
2214 @node Threads
2215 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads
2216
2217 @cindex threads of execution
2218 @cindex multiple threads
2219 @cindex switching threads
2220 In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
2221 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2222 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2223 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2224 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2225 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2226 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2227
2228 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2229 programs:
2230
2231 @itemize @bullet
2232 @item automatic notification of new threads
2233 @item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
2234 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2235 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
2236 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2237 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2238 @end itemize
2239
2240 @quotation
2241 @emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
2242 @value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
2243 If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
2244 effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
2245 from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
2246 like this:
2247
2248 @smallexample
2249 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2250 (@value{GDBP}) thread 1
2251 Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
2252 see the IDs of currently known threads.
2253 @end smallexample
2254 @c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
2255 @c doesn't support threads"?
2256 @end quotation
2257
2258 @cindex focus of debugging
2259 @cindex current thread
2260 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2261 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2262 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2263 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2264 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2265
2266 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2267 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2268 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2269 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2270 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2271 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2272 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2273 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2274 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2275 @sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see
2276
2277 @smallexample
2278 [New Thread 46912507313328 (LWP 25582)]
2279 @end smallexample
2280
2281 @noindent
2282 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
2283 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2284 further qualifier.
2285
2286 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2287 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2288 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2289 @c program?
2290 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2291 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2292 @c threads ab initio?
2293
2294 @cindex thread number
2295 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2296 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2297 number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
2298
2299 @table @code
2300 @kindex info threads
2301 @item info threads
2302 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2303 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2304
2305 @enumerate
2306 @item
2307 the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2308
2309 @item
2310 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2311
2312 @item
2313 the current stack frame summary for that thread
2314 @end enumerate
2315
2316 @noindent
2317 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2318 indicates the current thread.
2319
2320 For example,
2321 @end table
2322 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2323
2324 @smallexample
2325 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2326 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2327 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2328 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2329 at threadtest.c:68
2330 @end smallexample
2331
2332 On HP-UX systems:
2333
2334 @cindex debugging multithreaded programs (on HP-UX)
2335 @cindex thread identifier (GDB), on HP-UX
2336 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2337 number---a small integer assigned in thread-creation order---with each
2338 thread in your program.
2339
2340 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message, on HP-UX
2341 @cindex thread identifier (system), on HP-UX
2342 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2343 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2344 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2345 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2346 both @value{GDBN}'s thread number and the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2347 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2348 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2349 HP-UX, you see
2350
2351 @smallexample
2352 [New thread 2 (system thread 26594)]
2353 @end smallexample
2354
2355 @noindent
2356 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread.
2357
2358 @table @code
2359 @kindex info threads (HP-UX)
2360 @item info threads
2361 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2362 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2363
2364 @enumerate
2365 @item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2366
2367 @item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2368
2369 @item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2370 @end enumerate
2371
2372 @noindent
2373 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2374 indicates the current thread.
2375
2376 For example,
2377 @end table
2378 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2379
2380 @smallexample
2381 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2382 * 3 system thread 26607 worker (wptr=0x7b09c318 "@@") \@*
2383 at quicksort.c:137
2384 2 system thread 26606 0x7b0030d8 in __ksleep () \@*
2385 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2386 1 system thread 27905 0x7b003498 in _brk () \@*
2387 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2388 @end smallexample
2389
2390 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
2391 Solaris-specific command:
2392
2393 @table @code
2394 @item maint info sol-threads
2395 @kindex maint info sol-threads
2396 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
2397 Display info on Solaris user threads.
2398 @end table
2399
2400 @table @code
2401 @kindex thread @var{threadno}
2402 @item thread @var{threadno}
2403 Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2404 argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2405 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2406 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2407 you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2408
2409 @smallexample
2410 @c FIXME!! This example made up; find a @value{GDBN} w/threads and get real one
2411 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
2412 [Switching to process 35 thread 23]
2413 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2414 @end smallexample
2415
2416 @noindent
2417 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2418 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
2419 threads.
2420
2421 @kindex thread apply
2422 @cindex apply command to several threads
2423 @item thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{command}
2424 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
2425 @var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the numbers of the
2426 threads that you want affected with the command argument
2427 @var{threadno}. It can be a single thread number, one of the numbers
2428 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display; or it
2429 could be a range of thread numbers, as in @code{2-4}. To apply a
2430 command to all threads, type @kbd{thread apply all @var{command}}.
2431 @end table
2432
2433 @cindex automatic thread selection
2434 @cindex switching threads automatically
2435 @cindex threads, automatic switching
2436 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
2437 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
2438 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
2439 message of the form @samp{[Switching to @var{systag}]} to identify the
2440 thread.
2441
2442 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for
2443 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
2444 programs with multiple threads.
2445
2446 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about
2447 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
2448
2449 @node Processes
2450 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Processes
2451
2452 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
2453 @cindex multiple processes
2454 @cindex processes, multiple
2455 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
2456 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
2457 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
2458 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
2459 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
2460 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
2461 will cause it to terminate.
2462
2463 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
2464 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
2465 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
2466 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
2467 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
2468 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
2469 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
2470 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
2471 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
2472 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
2473
2474 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs that
2475 create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork} functions.
2476 Currently, the only platforms with this feature are HP-UX (11.x and later
2477 only?) and GNU/Linux (kernel version 2.5.60 and later).
2478
2479 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
2480 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
2481
2482 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
2483 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
2484
2485 @table @code
2486 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
2487 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
2488 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
2489 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
2490 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
2491
2492 @table @code
2493 @item parent
2494 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
2495 unimpeded. This is the default.
2496
2497 @item child
2498 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
2499 unimpeded.
2500
2501 @end table
2502
2503 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
2504 @item show follow-fork-mode
2505 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
2506 @end table
2507
2508 @cindex debugging multiple processes
2509 On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
2510 command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
2511
2512 @table @code
2513 @kindex set detach-on-fork
2514 @item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
2515 Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
2516 retain debugger control over them both.
2517
2518 @table @code
2519 @item on
2520 The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
2521 @code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
2522 independently. This is the default.
2523
2524 @item off
2525 Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
2526 One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
2527 @code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
2528 is held suspended.
2529
2530 @end table
2531
2532 @kindex show detach-on-follow
2533 @item show detach-on-follow
2534 Show whether detach-on-follow mode is on/off.
2535 @end table
2536
2537 If you choose to set @var{detach-on-follow} mode off, then
2538 @value{GDBN} will retain control of all forked processes (including
2539 nested forks). You can list the forked processes under the control of
2540 @value{GDBN} by using the @w{@code{info forks}} command, and switch
2541 from one fork to another by using the @w{@code{fork}} command.
2542
2543 @table @code
2544 @kindex info forks
2545 @item info forks
2546 Print a list of all forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN}.
2547 The listing will include a fork id, a process id, and the current
2548 position (program counter) of the process.
2549
2550
2551 @kindex fork @var{fork-id}
2552 @item fork @var{fork-id}
2553 Make fork number @var{fork-id} the current process. The argument
2554 @var{fork-id} is the internal fork number assigned by @value{GDBN},
2555 as shown in the first field of the @samp{info forks} display.
2556
2557 @end table
2558
2559 To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
2560 from it by using the @w{@code{detach fork}} command (allowing it to
2561 run independently), or delete (and kill) it using the
2562 @w{@code{delete fork}} command.
2563
2564 @table @code
2565 @kindex detach fork @var{fork-id}
2566 @item detach fork @var{fork-id}
2567 Detach from the process identified by @value{GDBN} fork number
2568 @var{fork-id}, and remove it from the fork list. The process will be
2569 allowed to run independently.
2570
2571 @kindex delete fork @var{fork-id}
2572 @item delete fork @var{fork-id}
2573 Kill the process identified by @value{GDBN} fork number @var{fork-id},
2574 and remove it from the fork list.
2575
2576 @end table
2577
2578 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
2579 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
2580 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
2581 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
2582 the child process's @code{main}.
2583
2584 When a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you cannot debug the
2585 child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
2586
2587 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
2588 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent process,
2589 use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name as its
2590 argument.
2591
2592 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
2593 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
2594 Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}.
2595
2596 @node Checkpoint/Restart
2597 @section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later
2598
2599 @cindex checkpoint
2600 @cindex restart
2601 @cindex bookmark
2602 @cindex snapshot of a process
2603 @cindex rewind program state
2604
2605 On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
2606 @sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
2607 program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
2608 later.
2609
2610 Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
2611 happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
2612 includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
2613 system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
2614 moment when the checkpoint was saved.
2615
2616 Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
2617 getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
2618 a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
2619 the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
2620 from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
2621 start again from there.
2622
2623 This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
2624 steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
2625
2626 To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
2627
2628 @table @code
2629 @kindex checkpoint
2630 @item checkpoint
2631 Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
2632 The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
2633 is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
2634
2635 @kindex info checkpoints
2636 @item info checkpoints
2637 List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
2638 session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
2639 listed:
2640
2641 @table @code
2642 @item Checkpoint ID
2643 @item Process ID
2644 @item Code Address
2645 @item Source line, or label
2646 @end table
2647
2648 @kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
2649 @item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
2650 Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
2651 @var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
2652 etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
2653 was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
2654 in time when the checkpoint was saved.
2655
2656 Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
2657 are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
2658 only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
2659 the debugger.
2660
2661 @kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
2662 @item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
2663 Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
2664
2665 @end table
2666
2667 Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
2668 of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
2669 (OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
2670 a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
2671 so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
2672 opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
2673 previously read data can be read again.
2674
2675 Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
2676 external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
2677 from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
2678 but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
2679 be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
2680 been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
2681
2682 However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
2683 program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
2684 again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
2685 different execution path this time.
2686
2687 @cindex checkpoints and process id
2688 Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
2689 different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
2690 id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
2691 and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
2692 If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
2693 potentially pose a problem.
2694
2695 @subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints
2696
2697 On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
2698 is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
2699 difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
2700 absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
2701 absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
2702 next.
2703
2704 A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
2705 Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
2706 and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
2707 process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
2708 your symbols will all stay in the same place.
2709
2710 @node Stopping
2711 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
2712
2713 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
2714 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
2715 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
2716
2717 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
2718 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
2719 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
2720 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
2721 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
2722 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
2723 explicitly request this information at any time.
2724
2725 @table @code
2726 @kindex info program
2727 @item info program
2728 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
2729 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
2730 @end table
2731
2732 @menu
2733 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2734 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
2735 * Signals:: Signals
2736 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
2737 @end menu
2738
2739 @node Breakpoints
2740 @section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints
2741
2742 @cindex breakpoints
2743 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
2744 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
2745 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
2746 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
2747 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
2748 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
2749 program.
2750
2751 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
2752 the executable is run. There is a minor limitation on HP-UX systems:
2753 you must wait until the executable is run in order to set breakpoints
2754 in shared library routines that are not called directly by the program
2755 (for example, routines that are arguments in a @code{pthread_create}
2756 call).
2757
2758 @cindex watchpoints
2759 @cindex data breakpoints
2760 @cindex memory tracing
2761 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
2762 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
2763 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
2764 when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
2765 of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
2766 combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
2767 @dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
2768 watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside
2769 from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
2770 enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
2771 same commands.
2772
2773 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
2774 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
2775 Automatic Display}.
2776
2777 @cindex catchpoints
2778 @cindex breakpoint on events
2779 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
2780 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
2781 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
2782 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
2783 Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
2784 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
2785 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
2786
2787 @cindex breakpoint numbers
2788 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
2789 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2790 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
2791 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
2792 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
2793 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
2794 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
2795 enable it again.
2796
2797 @cindex breakpoint ranges
2798 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
2799 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
2800 operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
2801 @samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
2802 hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
2803 all breakpoints in that range are operated on.
2804
2805 @menu
2806 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
2807 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
2808 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
2809 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
2810 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
2811 * Conditions:: Break conditions
2812 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
2813 * Breakpoint Menus:: Breakpoint menus
2814 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
2815 * Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
2816 @end menu
2817
2818 @node Set Breaks
2819 @subsection Setting Breakpoints
2820
2821 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
2822 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
2823 @c
2824 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
2825
2826 @kindex break
2827 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
2828 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
2829 @cindex latest breakpoint
2830 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
2831 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
2832 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
2833 Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
2834 convenience variables.
2835
2836 You have several ways to say where the breakpoint should go.
2837
2838 @table @code
2839 @item break @var{function}
2840 Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function}.
2841 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
2842 C@t{++}, @var{function} may refer to more than one possible place to break.
2843 @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint Menus}, for a discussion of that situation.
2844
2845 @item break +@var{offset}
2846 @itemx break -@var{offset}
2847 Set a breakpoint some number of lines forward or back from the position
2848 at which execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}.
2849 (@xref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.)
2850
2851 @item break @var{linenum}
2852 Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in the current source file.
2853 The current source file is the last file whose source text was printed.
2854 The breakpoint will stop your program just before it executes any of the
2855 code on that line.
2856
2857 @item break @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2858 Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in source file @var{filename}.
2859
2860 @item break @var{filename}:@var{function}
2861 Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function} found in file
2862 @var{filename}. Specifying a file name as well as a function name is
2863 superfluous except when multiple files contain similarly named
2864 functions.
2865
2866 @item break *@var{address}
2867 Set a breakpoint at address @var{address}. You can use this to set
2868 breakpoints in parts of your program which do not have debugging
2869 information or source files.
2870
2871 @item break
2872 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
2873 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
2874 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
2875 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
2876 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
2877 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
2878 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
2879 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
2880 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
2881 inside loops.
2882
2883 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
2884 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
2885 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
2886 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
2887 existed when your program stopped.
2888
2889 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
2890 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
2891 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
2892 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
2893 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
2894 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
2895 ,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
2896
2897 @kindex tbreak
2898 @item tbreak @var{args}
2899 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the
2900 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
2901 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
2902 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
2903
2904 @kindex hbreak
2905 @cindex hardware breakpoints
2906 @item hbreak @var{args}
2907 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. @var{args} are the same as for the
2908 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
2909 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
2910 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
2911 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
2912 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
2913 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
2914 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
2915 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
2916 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
2917 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
2918 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
2919 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
2920 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}).
2921 @xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
2922 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
2923 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
2924 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
2925
2926
2927 @kindex thbreak
2928 @item thbreak @var{args}
2929 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args}
2930 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
2931 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
2932 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
2933 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
2934 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
2935 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
2936 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
2937
2938 @kindex rbreak
2939 @cindex regular expression
2940 @cindex breakpoints in functions matching a regexp
2941 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
2942 @item rbreak @var{regex}
2943 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
2944 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
2945 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
2946 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
2947 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
2948 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
2949
2950 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
2951 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
2952 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
2953 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
2954 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
2955 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
2956
2957 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
2958 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
2959 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
2960 classes.
2961
2962 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
2963 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
2964 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
2965
2966 @smallexample
2967 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
2968 @end smallexample
2969
2970 @kindex info breakpoints
2971 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
2972 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2973 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2974 @itemx info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2975 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
2976 not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
2977 about the specified breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint). For
2978 each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
2979
2980 @table @emph
2981 @item Breakpoint Numbers
2982 @item Type
2983 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
2984 @item Disposition
2985 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
2986 @item Enabled or Disabled
2987 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
2988 that are not enabled.
2989 @item Address
2990 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. If the
2991 breakpoint is pending (see below for details) on a future load of a shared library, the address
2992 will be listed as @samp{<PENDING>}.
2993 @item What
2994 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
2995 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
2996 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
2997 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
2998 @end table
2999
3000 @noindent
3001 If a breakpoint is conditional, @code{info break} shows the condition on
3002 the line following the affected breakpoint; breakpoint commands, if any,
3003 are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is allowed to have a condition
3004 specified for it. The condition is not parsed for validity until a shared
3005 library is loaded that allows the pending breakpoint to resolve to a
3006 valid location.
3007
3008 @noindent
3009 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
3010 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3011 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3012 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3013 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).
3014
3015 @noindent
3016 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3017 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3018 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3019 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3020 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3021 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3022 @end table
3023
3024 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3025 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3026 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3027 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3028
3029 @cindex pending breakpoints
3030 If a specified breakpoint location cannot be found, it may be due to the fact
3031 that the location is in a shared library that is yet to be loaded. In such
3032 a case, you may want @value{GDBN} to create a special breakpoint (known as
3033 a @dfn{pending breakpoint}) that
3034 attempts to resolve itself in the future when an appropriate shared library
3035 gets loaded.
3036
3037 Pending breakpoints are useful to set at the start of your
3038 @value{GDBN} session for locations that you know will be dynamically loaded
3039 later by the program being debugged. When shared libraries are loaded,
3040 a check is made to see if the load resolves any pending breakpoint locations.
3041 If a pending breakpoint location gets resolved,
3042 a regular breakpoint is created and the original pending breakpoint is removed.
3043
3044 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling pending
3045 breakpoint support:
3046
3047 @kindex set breakpoint pending
3048 @kindex show breakpoint pending
3049 @table @code
3050 @item set breakpoint pending auto
3051 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
3052 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
3053
3054 @item set breakpoint pending on
3055 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
3056 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
3057
3058 @item set breakpoint pending off
3059 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
3060 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
3061 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
3062
3063 @item show breakpoint pending
3064 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
3065 @end table
3066
3067 @cindex operations allowed on pending breakpoints
3068 Normal breakpoint operations apply to pending breakpoints as well. You may
3069 specify a condition for a pending breakpoint and/or commands to run when the
3070 breakpoint is reached. You can also enable or disable
3071 the pending breakpoint. When you specify a condition for a pending breakpoint,
3072 the parsing of the condition will be deferred until the point where the
3073 pending breakpoint location is resolved. Disabling a pending breakpoint
3074 tells @value{GDBN} to not attempt to resolve the breakpoint on any subsequent
3075 shared library load. When a pending breakpoint is re-enabled,
3076 @value{GDBN} checks to see if the location is already resolved.
3077 This is done because any number of shared library loads could have
3078 occurred since the time the breakpoint was disabled and one or more
3079 of these loads could resolve the location.
3080
3081 @cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
3082 For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
3083 software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
3084 breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to
3085 breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
3086 breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For
3087 breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
3088 breakpoints.
3089
3090 You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands::
3091
3092 @kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
3093 @kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
3094 @table @code
3095 @item set breakpoint auto-hw on
3096 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
3097 will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
3098 breakpoint must be used.
3099
3100 @item set breakpoint auto-hw off
3101 This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
3102 type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
3103 trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
3104 @end table
3105
3106
3107 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
3108 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
3109 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
3110 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
3111 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
3112 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
3113 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
3114 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
3115
3116
3117 @node Set Watchpoints
3118 @subsection Setting Watchpoints
3119
3120 @cindex setting watchpoints
3121 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
3122 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
3123 this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
3124 The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
3125 as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
3126
3127 @itemize @bullet
3128 @item
3129 A reference to the value of a single variable.
3130
3131 @item
3132 An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
3133 @samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
3134 address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
3135
3136 @item
3137 An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
3138 expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
3139 language (@pxref{Languages}).
3140 @end itemize
3141
3142 @cindex software watchpoints
3143 @cindex hardware watchpoints
3144 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
3145 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
3146 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
3147 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
3148 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
3149 culprit.)
3150
3151 On some systems, such as HP-UX, @sc{gnu}/Linux and most other
3152 x86-based targets, @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware
3153 watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your program.
3154
3155 @table @code
3156 @kindex watch
3157 @item watch @var{expr}
3158 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
3159 expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
3160 changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
3161 to watch the value of a single variable:
3162
3163 @smallexample
3164 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo
3165 @end smallexample
3166
3167 @kindex rwatch
3168 @item rwatch @var{expr}
3169 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
3170 by the program.
3171
3172 @kindex awatch
3173 @item awatch @var{expr}
3174 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
3175 or written into by the program.
3176
3177 @kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3178 @item info watchpoints
3179 This command prints a list of watchpoints, breakpoints, and catchpoints;
3180 it is the same as @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
3181 @end table
3182
3183 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
3184 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
3185 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
3186 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
3187 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
3188 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
3189
3190 @cindex use only software watchpoints
3191 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
3192 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
3193 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
3194 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
3195 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
3196 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
3197 mechanism of watching expression values.)
3198
3199 @table @code
3200 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
3201 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
3202 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
3203
3204 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
3205 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
3206 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
3207 @end table
3208
3209 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3210 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3211 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3212
3213 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
3214
3215 @smallexample
3216 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
3217 @end smallexample
3218
3219 @noindent
3220 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
3221
3222 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
3223 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
3224 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
3225 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
3226 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
3227 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
3228 will print a message like this:
3229
3230 @smallexample
3231 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
3232 @end smallexample
3233
3234 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
3235 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
3236 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
3237 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
3238 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
3239 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
3240 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
3241 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
3242
3243 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
3244 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
3245 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
3246 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
3247 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
3248 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
3249
3250 @smallexample
3251 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
3252 @end smallexample
3253
3254 @noindent
3255 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
3256
3257 Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
3258 exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
3259 That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
3260 expression with separately allocated resources.
3261
3262 The SPARClite DSU will generate traps when a program accesses some data
3263 or instruction address that is assigned to the debug registers. For the
3264 data addresses, DSU facilitates the @code{watch} command. However the
3265 hardware breakpoint registers can only take two data watchpoints, and
3266 both watchpoints must be the same kind. For example, you can set two
3267 watchpoints with @code{watch} commands, two with @code{rwatch} commands,
3268 @strong{or} two with @code{awatch} commands, but you cannot set one
3269 watchpoint with one command and the other with a different command.
3270 @value{GDBN} will reject the command if you try to mix watchpoints.
3271 Delete or disable unused watchpoint commands before setting new ones.
3272
3273 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
3274 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
3275 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
3276
3277 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
3278 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
3279 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
3280 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
3281 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
3282 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
3283 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
3284 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
3285 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
3286
3287 @quotation
3288 @cindex watchpoints and threads
3289 @cindex threads and watchpoints
3290 @emph{Warning:} In multi-thread programs, watchpoints have only limited
3291 usefulness. With the current watchpoint implementation, @value{GDBN}
3292 can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a single thread}. If
3293 you are confident that the expression can only change due to the current
3294 thread's activity (and if you are also confident that no other thread
3295 can become current), then you can use watchpoints as usual. However,
3296 @value{GDBN} may not notice when a non-current thread's activity changes
3297 the expression.
3298
3299 @c FIXME: this is almost identical to the previous paragraph.
3300 @emph{HP-UX Warning:} In multi-thread programs, software watchpoints
3301 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
3302 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
3303 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
3304 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
3305 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
3306 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
3307 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
3308 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
3309 @end quotation
3310
3311 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
3312
3313 @node Set Catchpoints
3314 @subsection Setting Catchpoints
3315 @cindex catchpoints, setting
3316 @cindex exception handlers
3317 @cindex event handling
3318
3319 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
3320 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
3321 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
3322
3323 @table @code
3324 @kindex catch
3325 @item catch @var{event}
3326 Stop when @var{event} occurs. @var{event} can be any of the following:
3327 @table @code
3328 @item throw
3329 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
3330 The throwing of a C@t{++} exception.
3331
3332 @item catch
3333 The catching of a C@t{++} exception.
3334
3335 @item exception
3336 @cindex Ada exception catching
3337 @cindex catch Ada exceptions
3338 An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified
3339 at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
3340 the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
3341 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
3342
3343 @item exception unhandled
3344 An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program.
3345
3346 @item assert
3347 A failed Ada assertion.
3348
3349 @item exec
3350 @cindex break on fork/exec
3351 A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3352
3353 @item fork
3354 A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3355
3356 @item vfork
3357 A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3358
3359 @item load
3360 @itemx load @var{libname}
3361 @cindex break on load/unload of shared library
3362 The dynamic loading of any shared library, or the loading of the library
3363 @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3364
3365 @item unload
3366 @itemx unload @var{libname}
3367 The unloading of any dynamically loaded shared library, or the unloading
3368 of the library @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3369 @end table
3370
3371 @item tcatch @var{event}
3372 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
3373 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
3374
3375 @end table
3376
3377 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
3378
3379 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling
3380 (@code{catch throw} and @code{catch catch}) in @value{GDBN}:
3381
3382 @itemize @bullet
3383 @item
3384 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
3385 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
3386 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
3387 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
3388 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
3389 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
3390 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
3391 disabled within interactive calls.
3392
3393 @item
3394 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
3395
3396 @item
3397 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
3398 @end itemize
3399
3400 @cindex raise exceptions
3401 Sometimes @code{catch} is not the best way to debug exception handling:
3402 if you need to know exactly where an exception is raised, it is better to
3403 stop @emph{before} the exception handler is called, since that way you
3404 can see the stack before any unwinding takes place. If you set a
3405 breakpoint in an exception handler instead, it may not be easy to find
3406 out where the exception was raised.
3407
3408 To stop just before an exception handler is called, you need some
3409 knowledge of the implementation. In the case of @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, exceptions are
3410 raised by calling a library function named @code{__raise_exception}
3411 which has the following ANSI C interface:
3412
3413 @smallexample
3414 /* @var{addr} is where the exception identifier is stored.
3415 @var{id} is the exception identifier. */
3416 void __raise_exception (void **addr, void *id);
3417 @end smallexample
3418
3419 @noindent
3420 To make the debugger catch all exceptions before any stack
3421 unwinding takes place, set a breakpoint on @code{__raise_exception}
3422 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Exceptions}).
3423
3424 With a conditional breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions})
3425 that depends on the value of @var{id}, you can stop your program when
3426 a specific exception is raised. You can use multiple conditional
3427 breakpoints to stop your program when any of a number of exceptions are
3428 raised.
3429
3430
3431 @node Delete Breaks
3432 @subsection Deleting Breakpoints
3433
3434 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
3435 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
3436 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3437 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
3438 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
3439 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
3440
3441 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
3442 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
3443 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
3444 their breakpoint numbers.
3445
3446 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
3447 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
3448 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
3449
3450 @table @code
3451 @kindex clear
3452 @item clear
3453 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
3454 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). When
3455 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
3456 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
3457
3458 @item clear @var{function}
3459 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
3460 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
3461
3462 @item clear @var{linenum}
3463 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
3464 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
3465 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
3466
3467 @cindex delete breakpoints
3468 @kindex delete
3469 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
3470 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3471 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
3472 ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
3473 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
3474 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
3475 @end table
3476
3477 @node Disabling
3478 @subsection Disabling Breakpoints
3479
3480 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
3481 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
3482 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
3483 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
3484 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
3485
3486 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
3487 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying one
3488 or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} or
3489 @code{info watch} to print a list of breakpoints, watchpoints, and
3490 catchpoints if you do not know which numbers to use.
3491
3492 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of four different
3493 states of enablement:
3494
3495 @itemize @bullet
3496 @item
3497 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
3498 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
3499 @item
3500 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
3501 @item
3502 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
3503 disabled.
3504 @item
3505 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
3506 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
3507 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
3508 @end itemize
3509
3510 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
3511 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
3512
3513 @table @code
3514 @kindex disable
3515 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
3516 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3517 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
3518 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
3519 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
3520 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
3521 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
3522
3523 @kindex enable
3524 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3525 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
3526 become effective once again in stopping your program.
3527
3528 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
3529 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
3530 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
3531
3532 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
3533 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
3534 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
3535 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
3536 @end table
3537
3538 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
3539 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
3540 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
3541 ,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
3542 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
3543 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
3544 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
3545 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
3546 Stepping}.)
3547
3548 @node Conditions
3549 @subsection Break Conditions
3550 @cindex conditional breakpoints
3551 @cindex breakpoint conditions
3552
3553 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
3554 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
3555 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
3556 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
3557 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
3558 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
3559 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
3560 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
3561
3562 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
3563 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
3564 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
3565 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
3566 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
3567
3568 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
3569 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
3570 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
3571 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
3572 one.
3573
3574 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
3575 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
3576 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
3577 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
3578 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
3579 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
3580 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
3581 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
3582 conditions for the
3583 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
3584 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}).
3585
3586 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
3587 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
3588 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
3589 with the @code{condition} command.
3590
3591 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
3592 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
3593 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
3594 catchpoint.
3595
3596 @table @code
3597 @kindex condition
3598 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
3599 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
3600 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
3601 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
3602 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
3603 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
3604 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
3605 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
3606 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
3607 prints an error message:
3608
3609 @smallexample
3610 No symbol "foo" in current context.
3611 @end smallexample
3612
3613 @noindent
3614 @value{GDBN} does
3615 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
3616 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
3617 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
3618
3619 @item condition @var{bnum}
3620 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
3621 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
3622 @end table
3623
3624 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
3625 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
3626 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
3627 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
3628 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
3629 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
3630 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
3631 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
3632 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
3633 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
3634 your program reaches it.
3635
3636 @table @code
3637 @kindex ignore
3638 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
3639 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
3640 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
3641 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
3642 takes no action.
3643
3644 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
3645 a count of zero.
3646
3647 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
3648 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
3649 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
3650 Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}.
3651
3652 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
3653 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
3654 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
3655
3656 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
3657 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
3658 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
3659 Variables}.
3660 @end table
3661
3662 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
3663
3664
3665 @node Break Commands
3666 @subsection Breakpoint Command Lists
3667
3668 @cindex breakpoint commands
3669 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
3670 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
3671 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
3672 enable other breakpoints.
3673
3674 @table @code
3675 @kindex commands
3676 @kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
3677 @item commands @r{[}@var{bnum}@r{]}
3678 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
3679 @itemx end
3680 Specify a list of commands for breakpoint number @var{bnum}. The commands
3681 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
3682 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
3683
3684 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
3685 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
3686
3687 With no @var{bnum} argument, @code{commands} refers to the last
3688 breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most
3689 recently encountered).
3690 @end table
3691
3692 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
3693 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
3694
3695 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
3696 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
3697 that resumes execution.
3698
3699 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
3700 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
3701 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
3702 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
3703 ambiguities about which list to execute.
3704
3705 @kindex silent
3706 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
3707 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
3708 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
3709 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
3710 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
3711 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
3712
3713 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
3714 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
3715 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}.
3716
3717 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
3718 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
3719
3720 @smallexample
3721 break foo if x>0
3722 commands
3723 silent
3724 printf "x is %d\n",x
3725 cont
3726 end
3727 @end smallexample
3728
3729 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
3730 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
3731 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
3732 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
3733 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
3734 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
3735 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
3736
3737 @smallexample
3738 break 403
3739 commands
3740 silent
3741 set x = y + 4
3742 cont
3743 end
3744 @end smallexample
3745
3746 @node Breakpoint Menus
3747 @subsection Breakpoint Menus
3748 @cindex overloading
3749 @cindex symbol overloading
3750
3751 Some programming languages (notably C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit a
3752 single function name
3753 to be defined several times, for application in different contexts.
3754 This is called @dfn{overloading}. When a function name is overloaded,
3755 @samp{break @var{function}} is not enough to tell @value{GDBN} where you want
3756 a breakpoint. If you realize this is a problem, you can use
3757 something like @samp{break @var{function}(@var{types})} to specify which
3758 particular version of the function you want. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} offers
3759 you a menu of numbered choices for different possible breakpoints, and
3760 waits for your selection with the prompt @samp{>}. The first two
3761 options are always @samp{[0] cancel} and @samp{[1] all}. Typing @kbd{1}
3762 sets a breakpoint at each definition of @var{function}, and typing
3763 @kbd{0} aborts the @code{break} command without setting any new
3764 breakpoints.
3765
3766 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
3767 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
3768 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
3769
3770 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
3771 @smallexample
3772 @group
3773 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
3774 [0] cancel
3775 [1] all
3776 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
3777 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
3778 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
3779 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
3780 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
3781 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
3782 > 2 4 6
3783 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
3784 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
3785 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
3786 Multiple breakpoints were set.
3787 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
3788 breakpoints.
3789 (@value{GDBP})
3790 @end group
3791 @end smallexample
3792
3793 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
3794 @node Error in Breakpoints
3795 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3796 @c
3797 @c FIXME!! 14/6/95 Is there a real example of this? Let's use it.
3798 @c
3799 Under some operating systems, breakpoints cannot be used in a program if
3800 any other process is running that program. In this situation,
3801 attempting to run or continue a program with a breakpoint causes
3802 @value{GDBN} to print an error message:
3803
3804 @smallexample
3805 Cannot insert breakpoints.
3806 The same program may be running in another process.
3807 @end smallexample
3808
3809 When this happens, you have three ways to proceed:
3810
3811 @enumerate
3812 @item
3813 Remove or disable the breakpoints, then continue.
3814
3815 @item
3816 Suspend @value{GDBN}, and copy the file containing your program to a new
3817 name. Resume @value{GDBN} and use the @code{exec-file} command to specify
3818 that @value{GDBN} should run your program under that name.
3819 Then start your program again.
3820
3821 @item
3822 Relink your program so that the text segment is nonsharable, using the
3823 linker option @samp{-N}. The operating system limitation may not apply
3824 to nonsharable executables.
3825 @end enumerate
3826 @c @end ifclear
3827
3828 A similar message can be printed if you request too many active
3829 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints:
3830
3831 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
3832 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
3833 @smallexample
3834 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
3835 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
3836 @end smallexample
3837
3838 @noindent
3839 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
3840 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
3841 watchpoints it needs to insert.
3842
3843 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
3844 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
3845
3846 @node Breakpoint-related Warnings
3847 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3848 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
3849
3850 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
3851 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
3852 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
3853 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
3854
3855 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
3856 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
3857 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
3858 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
3859 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
3860 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
3861 first in the bundle.
3862
3863 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
3864 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
3865 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
3866 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
3867 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
3868 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
3869 is hit.
3870
3871 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
3872 that's been subject to address adjustment:
3873
3874 @smallexample
3875 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
3876 @end smallexample
3877
3878 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
3879 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
3880 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
3881 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
3882 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
3883 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
3884 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
3885 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
3886
3887 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
3888 adjusted breakpoints:
3889
3890 @smallexample
3891 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
3892 to 0x00010410.
3893 @end smallexample
3894
3895 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
3896 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
3897 frequently than expected.
3898
3899 @node Continuing and Stepping
3900 @section Continuing and Stepping
3901
3902 @cindex stepping
3903 @cindex continuing
3904 @cindex resuming execution
3905 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
3906 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
3907 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
3908 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
3909 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
3910 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
3911 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
3912 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3913
3914 @table @code
3915 @kindex continue
3916 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
3917 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
3918 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3919 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3920 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3921 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
3922 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
3923 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
3924 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
3925 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3926
3927 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
3928 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
3929 @code{continue} is ignored.
3930
3931 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
3932 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
3933 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
3934 @code{continue}.
3935 @end table
3936
3937 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
3938 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the
3939 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
3940 Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
3941
3942 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
3943 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the
3944 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
3945 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
3946 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
3947 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
3948
3949 @table @code
3950 @kindex step
3951 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
3952 @item step
3953 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
3954 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
3955 abbreviated @code{s}.
3956
3957 @quotation
3958 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
3959 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
3960 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
3961 @c distinction here.
3962 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
3963 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
3964 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
3965 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
3966 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
3967 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
3968 below.
3969 @end quotation
3970
3971 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
3972 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
3973 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
3974 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
3975 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
3976 called within the line.
3977
3978 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
3979 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
3980 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
3981 on MIPS machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
3982 was any debugging information about the routine.
3983
3984 @item step @var{count}
3985 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
3986 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
3987 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
3988
3989 @kindex next
3990 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
3991 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
3992 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
3993 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
3994 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
3995 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
3996 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
3997 is abbreviated @code{n}.
3998
3999 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
4000
4001
4002 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
4003 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
4004 @c
4005 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
4006 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
4007 @c function are executed without stopping.
4008
4009 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
4010 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
4011 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
4012
4013 @kindex set step-mode
4014 @item set step-mode
4015 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
4016 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
4017 @itemx set step-mode on
4018 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
4019 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
4020 information rather than stepping over it.
4021
4022 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
4023 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
4024 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
4025
4026 @item set step-mode off
4027 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
4028 debug information. This is the default.
4029
4030 @item show step-mode
4031 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
4032 source line debug information.
4033
4034 @kindex finish
4035 @item finish
4036 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
4037 returns. Print the returned value (if any).
4038
4039 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
4040 ,Returning from a Function}).
4041
4042 @kindex until
4043 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
4044 @cindex run until specified location
4045 @item until
4046 @itemx u
4047 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
4048 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
4049 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
4050 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
4051 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
4052 than the address of the jump.
4053
4054 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
4055 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
4056 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
4057 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
4058 through the next iteration.
4059
4060 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
4061 stack frame.
4062
4063 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
4064 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
4065 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
4066 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
4067 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
4068
4069 @smallexample
4070 (@value{GDBP}) f
4071 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
4072 206 expand_input();
4073 (@value{GDBP}) until
4074 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
4075 @end smallexample
4076
4077 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
4078 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
4079 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
4080 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
4081 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
4082 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
4083 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
4084
4085 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
4086 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
4087 argument.
4088
4089 @item until @var{location}
4090 @itemx u @var{location}
4091 Continue running your program until either the specified location is
4092 reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} is any of
4093 the forms of argument acceptable to @code{break} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
4094 ,Setting Breakpoints}). This form of the command uses breakpoints, and
4095 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
4096 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
4097 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
4098 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
4099 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
4100 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner
4101 invocations have returned.
4102
4103 @smallexample
4104 94 int factorial (int value)
4105 95 @{
4106 96 if (value > 1) @{
4107 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
4108 98 @}
4109 99 return (value);
4110 100 @}
4111 @end smallexample
4112
4113
4114 @kindex advance @var{location}
4115 @itemx advance @var{location}
4116 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
4117 required, which should be of the same form as arguments for the @code{break}
4118 command. Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
4119 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
4120 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
4121 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
4122
4123
4124 @kindex stepi
4125 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
4126 @item stepi
4127 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
4128 @itemx si
4129 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
4130
4131 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
4132 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
4133 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
4134 Display,, Automatic Display}.
4135
4136 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
4137
4138 @need 750
4139 @kindex nexti
4140 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
4141 @item nexti
4142 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
4143 @itemx ni
4144 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
4145 proceed until the function returns.
4146
4147 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
4148 @end table
4149
4150 @node Signals
4151 @section Signals
4152 @cindex signals
4153
4154 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
4155 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
4156 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
4157 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
4158 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
4159 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
4160 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
4161 requested an alarm).
4162
4163 @cindex fatal signals
4164 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
4165 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
4166 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
4167 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
4168 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
4169 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
4170
4171 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
4172 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
4173 signal.
4174
4175 @cindex handling signals
4176 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
4177 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
4178 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
4179 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
4180 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
4181
4182 @table @code
4183 @kindex info signals
4184 @kindex info handle
4185 @item info signals
4186 @itemx info handle
4187 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
4188 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
4189 the defined types of signals.
4190
4191 @item info signals @var{sig}
4192 Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
4193
4194 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
4195
4196 @kindex handle
4197 @item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
4198 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal}
4199 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
4200 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
4201 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
4202 known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
4203 say what change to make.
4204 @end table
4205
4206 @c @group
4207 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
4208 Their full names are:
4209
4210 @table @code
4211 @item nostop
4212 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
4213 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
4214
4215 @item stop
4216 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
4217 the @code{print} keyword as well.
4218
4219 @item print
4220 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
4221
4222 @item noprint
4223 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
4224 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
4225
4226 @item pass
4227 @itemx noignore
4228 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
4229 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
4230 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
4231
4232 @item nopass
4233 @itemx ignore
4234 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
4235 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
4236 @end table
4237 @c @end group
4238
4239 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
4240 program until you
4241 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
4242 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
4243 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
4244 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
4245 program sees that signal when you continue.
4246
4247 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
4248 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
4249 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
4250 erroneous signals.
4251
4252 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
4253 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
4254 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
4255 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
4256 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
4257 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
4258 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
4259 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
4260 Program a Signal}.
4261
4262 @node Thread Stops
4263 @section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs
4264
4265 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
4266 Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set
4267 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
4268
4269 @table @code
4270 @cindex breakpoints and threads
4271 @cindex thread breakpoints
4272 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
4273 @item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
4274 @itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
4275 @var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
4276 writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
4277
4278 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
4279 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
4280 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. @var{threadno} is one of the
4281 numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
4282 column of the @samp{info threads} display.
4283
4284 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
4285 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
4286 program.
4287
4288 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
4289 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before the
4290 breakpoint condition, like this:
4291
4292 @smallexample
4293 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
4294 @end smallexample
4295
4296 @end table
4297
4298 @cindex stopped threads
4299 @cindex threads, stopped
4300 Whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
4301 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
4302 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
4303 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
4304 underfoot.
4305
4306 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
4307 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
4308 @cindex premature return from system calls
4309 There is an unfortunate side effect. If one thread stops for a
4310 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
4311 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
4312 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
4313 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
4314 stop execution.
4315
4316 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
4317 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
4318 style anyways.
4319
4320 For example, do not write code like this:
4321
4322 @smallexample
4323 sleep (10);
4324 @end smallexample
4325
4326 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
4327 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
4328
4329 Instead, write this:
4330
4331 @smallexample
4332 int unslept = 10;
4333 while (unslept > 0)
4334 unslept = sleep (unslept);
4335 @end smallexample
4336
4337 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
4338 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
4339 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
4340 @value{GDBN}.
4341
4342 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
4343 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
4344 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
4345 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
4346
4347 @cindex continuing threads
4348 @cindex threads, continuing
4349 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
4350 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
4351 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
4352
4353 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
4354 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
4355 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
4356 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
4357 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
4358 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
4359 stops.
4360
4361 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
4362 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
4363 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
4364 first thread completes whatever you requested.
4365
4366 On some OSes, you can lock the OS scheduler and thus allow only a single
4367 thread to run.
4368
4369 @table @code
4370 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
4371 @cindex scheduler locking mode
4372 @cindex lock scheduler
4373 Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
4374 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
4375 current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
4376 mode optimizes for single-stepping. It stops other threads from
4377 ``seizing the prompt'' by preempting the current thread while you are
4378 stepping. Other threads will only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
4379 when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
4380 function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
4381 like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
4382 thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, they will never steal the
4383 @value{GDBN} prompt away from the thread that you are debugging.
4384
4385 @item show scheduler-locking
4386 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
4387 @end table
4388
4389
4390 @node Stack
4391 @chapter Examining the Stack
4392
4393 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
4394 stopped and how it got there.
4395
4396 @cindex call stack
4397 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
4398 is generated.
4399 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
4400 the arguments of the call,
4401 and the local variables of the function being called.
4402 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
4403 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
4404 stack}.
4405
4406 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
4407 stack allow you to see all of this information.
4408
4409 @cindex selected frame
4410 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
4411 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
4412 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
4413 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
4414 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
4415 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
4416
4417 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
4418 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
4419 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}).
4420
4421 @menu
4422 * Frames:: Stack frames
4423 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
4424 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
4425 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
4426
4427 @end menu
4428
4429 @node Frames
4430 @section Stack Frames
4431
4432 @cindex frame, definition
4433 @cindex stack frame
4434 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
4435 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
4436 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
4437 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
4438 which the function is executing.
4439
4440 @cindex initial frame
4441 @cindex outermost frame
4442 @cindex innermost frame
4443 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
4444 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
4445 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
4446 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
4447 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
4448 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
4449 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
4450 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
4451
4452 @cindex frame pointer
4453 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
4454 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
4455 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
4456 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
4457 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
4458 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
4459
4460 @cindex frame number
4461 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
4462 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
4463 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
4464 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
4465 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
4466
4467 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
4468 @c underflow problems.
4469 @cindex frameless execution
4470 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
4471 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option
4472 @smallexample
4473 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
4474 @end smallexample
4475 generates functions without a frame.)
4476 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
4477 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
4478 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
4479 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
4480 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
4481 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
4482 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
4483
4484 @table @code
4485 @kindex frame@r{, command}
4486 @cindex current stack frame
4487 @item frame @var{args}
4488 The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
4489 and to print the stack frame you select. @var{args} may be either the
4490 address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
4491 @code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
4492
4493 @kindex select-frame
4494 @cindex selecting frame silently
4495 @item select-frame
4496 The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
4497 to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
4498 @code{frame}.
4499 @end table
4500
4501 @node Backtrace
4502 @section Backtraces
4503
4504 @cindex traceback
4505 @cindex call stack traces
4506 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
4507 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
4508 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
4509 stack.
4510
4511 @table @code
4512 @kindex backtrace
4513 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
4514 @item backtrace
4515 @itemx bt
4516 Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
4517 frames in the stack.
4518
4519 You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
4520 character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
4521
4522 @item backtrace @var{n}
4523 @itemx bt @var{n}
4524 Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
4525
4526 @item backtrace -@var{n}
4527 @itemx bt -@var{n}
4528 Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
4529
4530 @item backtrace full
4531 @itemx bt full
4532 @itemx bt full @var{n}
4533 @itemx bt full -@var{n}
4534 Print the values of the local variables also. @var{n} specifies the
4535 number of frames to print, as described above.
4536 @end table
4537
4538 @kindex where
4539 @kindex info stack
4540 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
4541 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
4542
4543 @cindex multiple threads, backtrace
4544 In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
4545 backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
4546 several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
4547 (@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
4548 apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
4549 the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
4550 multi-threaded program.
4551
4552 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
4553 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
4554 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
4555 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
4556 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
4557 line number.
4558
4559 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
4560 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
4561
4562 @smallexample
4563 @group
4564 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
4565 at builtin.c:993
4566 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600) at macro.c:242
4567 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
4568 at macro.c:71
4569 (More stack frames follow...)
4570 @end group
4571 @end smallexample
4572
4573 @noindent
4574 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
4575 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
4576 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
4577
4578 @cindex value optimized out, in backtrace
4579 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
4580 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
4581 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
4582 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
4583 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
4584 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
4585 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
4586 such a backtrace might look like:
4587
4588 @smallexample
4589 @group
4590 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
4591 at builtin.c:993
4592 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<value optimized out>) at macro.c:242
4593 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<value optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
4594 at macro.c:71
4595 (More stack frames follow...)
4596 @end group
4597 @end smallexample
4598
4599 @noindent
4600 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
4601 shown as @samp{<value optimized out>}.
4602
4603 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
4604 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
4605 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
4606
4607 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
4608 @cindex program entry point
4609 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
4610 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
4611 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
4612 @code{main}@footnote{
4613 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
4614 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
4615 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
4616 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
4617 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
4618 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
4619
4620 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
4621 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
4622
4623 @table @code
4624 @item set backtrace past-main
4625 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
4626 @kindex set backtrace
4627 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
4628
4629 @item set backtrace past-main off
4630 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
4631 default.
4632
4633 @item show backtrace past-main
4634 @kindex show backtrace
4635 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
4636
4637 @item set backtrace past-entry
4638 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
4639 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
4640 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
4641 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
4642
4643 @item set backtrace past-entry off
4644 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an
4645 application. This is the default.
4646
4647 @item show backtrace past-entry
4648 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
4649
4650 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
4651 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
4652 @cindex backtrace limit
4653 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of zero means
4654 unlimited.
4655
4656 @item show backtrace limit
4657 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
4658 @end table
4659
4660 @node Selection
4661 @section Selecting a Frame
4662
4663 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
4664 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
4665 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
4666 of the stack frame just selected.
4667
4668 @table @code
4669 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
4670 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
4671 @item frame @var{n}
4672 @itemx f @var{n}
4673 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
4674 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
4675 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
4676 @code{main}.
4677
4678 @item frame @var{addr}
4679 @itemx f @var{addr}
4680 Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
4681 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
4682 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
4683 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
4684 switches between them.
4685
4686 On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
4687 select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
4688
4689 On the MIPS and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
4690 pointer and a program counter.
4691
4692 On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
4693 pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
4694
4695 @kindex up
4696 @item up @var{n}
4697 Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
4698 advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
4699 that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one.
4700
4701 @kindex down
4702 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
4703 @item down @var{n}
4704 Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
4705 advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
4706 that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may
4707 abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
4708 @end table
4709
4710 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
4711 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
4712 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
4713 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
4714
4715 @need 1000
4716 For example:
4717
4718 @smallexample
4719 @group
4720 (@value{GDBP}) up
4721 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
4722 at env.c:10
4723 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
4724 @end group
4725 @end smallexample
4726
4727 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
4728 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
4729 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
4730 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
4731 @xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines},
4732 for details.
4733
4734 @table @code
4735 @kindex down-silently
4736 @kindex up-silently
4737 @item up-silently @var{n}
4738 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
4739 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
4740 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
4741 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
4742 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
4743 distracting.
4744 @end table
4745
4746 @node Frame Info
4747 @section Information About a Frame
4748
4749 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
4750 stack frame.
4751
4752 @table @code
4753 @item frame
4754 @itemx f
4755 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
4756 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
4757 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
4758 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
4759 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
4760
4761 @kindex info frame
4762 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
4763 @item info frame
4764 @itemx info f
4765 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
4766 including:
4767
4768 @itemize @bullet
4769 @item
4770 the address of the frame
4771 @item
4772 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
4773 @item
4774 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
4775 @item
4776 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
4777 @item
4778 the address of the frame's arguments
4779 @item
4780 the address of the frame's local variables
4781 @item
4782 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
4783 @item
4784 which registers were saved in the frame
4785 @end itemize
4786
4787 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
4788 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
4789 the usual conventions.
4790
4791 @item info frame @var{addr}
4792 @itemx info f @var{addr}
4793 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
4794 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
4795 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
4796 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
4797 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
4798
4799 @kindex info args
4800 @item info args
4801 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
4802
4803 @item info locals
4804 @kindex info locals
4805 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
4806 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
4807 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
4808
4809 @kindex info catch
4810 @cindex catch exceptions, list active handlers
4811 @cindex exception handlers, how to list
4812 @item info catch
4813 Print a list of all the exception handlers that are active in the
4814 current stack frame at the current point of execution. To see other
4815 exception handlers, visit the associated frame (using the @code{up},
4816 @code{down}, or @code{frame} commands); then type @code{info catch}.
4817 @xref{Set Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
4818
4819 @end table
4820
4821
4822 @node Source
4823 @chapter Examining Source Files
4824
4825 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
4826 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
4827 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
4828 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
4829 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
4830 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
4831 source files by explicit command.
4832
4833 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
4834 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
4835 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
4836
4837 @menu
4838 * List:: Printing source lines
4839 * Edit:: Editing source files
4840 * Search:: Searching source files
4841 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
4842 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
4843 @end menu
4844
4845 @node List
4846 @section Printing Source Lines
4847
4848 @kindex list
4849 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
4850 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
4851 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
4852 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to print.
4853
4854 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
4855
4856 @table @code
4857 @item list @var{linenum}
4858 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
4859 current source file.
4860
4861 @item list @var{function}
4862 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
4863 @var{function}.
4864
4865 @item list
4866 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
4867 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
4868 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
4869 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
4870 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
4871
4872 @item list -
4873 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4874 @end table
4875
4876 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
4877 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
4878 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
4879
4880 @table @code
4881 @kindex set listsize
4882 @item set listsize @var{count}
4883 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
4884 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
4885
4886 @kindex show listsize
4887 @item show listsize
4888 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
4889 @end table
4890
4891 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
4892 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
4893 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
4894 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
4895 each repetition moves up in the source file.
4896
4897 @cindex linespec
4898 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
4899 @dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
4900 of writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
4901 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
4902
4903 @table @code
4904 @item list @var{linespec}
4905 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
4906
4907 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
4908 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
4909 linespecs.
4910
4911 @item list ,@var{last}
4912 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
4913
4914 @item list @var{first},
4915 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
4916
4917 @item list +
4918 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
4919
4920 @item list -
4921 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4922
4923 @item list
4924 As described in the preceding table.
4925 @end table
4926
4927 Here are the ways of specifying a single source line---all the
4928 kinds of linespec.
4929
4930 @table @code
4931 @item @var{number}
4932 Specifies line @var{number} of the current source file.
4933 When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, this refers to
4934 the same source file as the first linespec.
4935
4936 @item +@var{offset}
4937 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines after the last line printed.
4938 When used as the second linespec in a @code{list} command that has
4939 two, this specifies the line @var{offset} lines down from the
4940 first linespec.
4941
4942 @item -@var{offset}
4943 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before the last line printed.
4944
4945 @item @var{filename}:@var{number}
4946 Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}.
4947
4948 @item @var{function}
4949 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
4950 For example: in C, this is the line with the open brace.
4951
4952 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
4953 Specifies the line of the open-brace that begins the body of the
4954 function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}. You only need the
4955 file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are
4956 identically named functions in different source files.
4957
4958 @item *@var{address}
4959 Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}.
4960 @var{address} may be any expression.
4961 @end table
4962
4963 @node Edit
4964 @section Editing Source Files
4965 @cindex editing source files
4966
4967 @kindex edit
4968 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
4969 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
4970 The editing program of your choice
4971 is invoked with the current line set to
4972 the active line in the program.
4973 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
4974 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program.
4975
4976 Here are the forms of the @code{edit} command most commonly used:
4977
4978 @table @code
4979 @item edit
4980 Edit the current source file at the active line number in the program.
4981
4982 @item edit @var{number}
4983 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
4984
4985 @item edit @var{function}
4986 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
4987
4988 @item edit @var{filename}:@var{number}
4989 Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}.
4990
4991 @item edit @var{filename}:@var{function}
4992 Specifies the line that begins the body of the
4993 function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}. You only need the
4994 file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are
4995 identically named functions in different source files.
4996
4997 @item edit *@var{address}
4998 Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}.
4999 @var{address} may be any expression.
5000 @end table
5001
5002 @subsection Choosing your Editor
5003 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
5004 @footnote{
5005 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
5006 following command-line syntax:
5007 @smallexample
5008 ex +@var{number} file
5009 @end smallexample
5010 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
5011 the file where to start editing.}.
5012 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
5013 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
5014 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
5015 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
5016 @smallexample
5017 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
5018 export EDITOR
5019 gdb @dots{}
5020 @end smallexample
5021 or in the @code{csh} shell,
5022 @smallexample
5023 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
5024 gdb @dots{}
5025 @end smallexample
5026
5027 @node Search
5028 @section Searching Source Files
5029 @cindex searching source files
5030
5031 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
5032 regular expression.
5033
5034 @table @code
5035 @kindex search
5036 @kindex forward-search
5037 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
5038 @itemx search @var{regexp}
5039 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
5040 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
5041 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
5042 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
5043 @code{fo}.
5044
5045 @kindex reverse-search
5046 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
5047 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
5048 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
5049 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
5050 this command as @code{rev}.
5051 @end table
5052
5053 @node Source Path
5054 @section Specifying Source Directories
5055
5056 @cindex source path
5057 @cindex directories for source files
5058 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
5059 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
5060 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
5061 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
5062 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
5063 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
5064 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
5065
5066 For example, suppose an executable references the file
5067 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
5068 @file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
5069 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
5070 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
5071 message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
5072 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
5073 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
5074 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
5075 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
5076 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
5077
5078 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
5079 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
5080 instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
5081 is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
5082 @file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
5083 that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
5084
5085 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
5086 source files.
5087
5088 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
5089 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
5090 each line is in the file.
5091
5092 @kindex directory
5093 @kindex dir
5094 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
5095 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
5096 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
5097
5098 The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
5099 script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
5100
5101 In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
5102 that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
5103 rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
5104 debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
5105 directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
5106 two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
5107 the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
5108 In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
5109 @var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
5110 of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
5111 source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
5112 name to look up the sources.
5113
5114 Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
5115 moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
5116 @value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
5117 @file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
5118 @file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
5119 of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
5120 substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
5121 (@pxref{set substitute-path}).
5122
5123 To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
5124 @var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
5125 For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
5126 @file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
5127 not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
5128 is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will
5129 not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
5130
5131 In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
5132 command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
5133 the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
5134 subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
5135 subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
5136 preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
5137 allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
5138 command.
5139
5140 @code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
5141 The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
5142 longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
5143 the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
5144 for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
5145 located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
5146 method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location.
5147
5148 @table @code
5149 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
5150 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
5151 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
5152 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
5153 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
5154 part of absolute file names) or
5155 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
5156 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
5157
5158 @kindex cdir
5159 @kindex cwd
5160 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
5161 @vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable}
5162 @cindex compilation directory
5163 @cindex current directory
5164 @cindex working directory
5165 @cindex directory, current
5166 @cindex directory, compilation
5167 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
5168 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
5169 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
5170 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
5171 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
5172 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
5173
5174 @item directory
5175 Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
5176
5177 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
5178 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
5179
5180 @item show directories
5181 @kindex show directories
5182 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
5183
5184 @anchor{set substitute-path}
5185 @item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
5186 @kindex set substitute-path
5187 Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
5188 current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
5189 @var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
5190
5191 For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
5192 @file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
5193
5194 @smallexample
5195 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/cross
5196 @end smallexample
5197
5198 @noindent
5199 will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/usr/src} with
5200 @samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
5201 @file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
5202
5203 In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
5204 the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
5205 defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
5206 the substitution.
5207
5208 For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
5209
5210 @smallexample
5211 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
5212 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
5213 @end smallexample
5214
5215 @noindent
5216 @value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
5217 @file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
5218 use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
5219 @file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
5220
5221
5222 @item unset substitute-path [path]
5223 @kindex unset substitute-path
5224 If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
5225 for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
5226 A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
5227
5228 If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
5229
5230 @item show substitute-path [path]
5231 @kindex show substitute-path
5232 If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
5233 which would rewrite that path, if any.
5234
5235 If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
5236 rules.
5237
5238 @end table
5239
5240 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
5241 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
5242 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
5243
5244 @enumerate
5245 @item
5246 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
5247
5248 @item
5249 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
5250 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
5251 directories in one command.
5252 @end enumerate
5253
5254 @node Machine Code
5255 @section Source and Machine Code
5256 @cindex source line and its code address
5257
5258 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
5259 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
5260 a range of addresses as machine instructions. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
5261 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
5262 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
5263 well as hex.
5264
5265 @table @code
5266 @kindex info line
5267 @item info line @var{linespec}
5268 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
5269 source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
5270 the ways understood by the @code{list} command (@pxref{List, ,Printing
5271 Source Lines}).
5272 @end table
5273
5274 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
5275 the object code for the first line of function
5276 @code{m4_changequote}:
5277
5278 @c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
5279 @c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
5280 @smallexample
5281 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
5282 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
5283 @end smallexample
5284
5285 @noindent
5286 @cindex code address and its source line
5287 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
5288 @var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
5289 @smallexample
5290 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
5291 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
5292 @end smallexample
5293
5294 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
5295 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
5296 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
5297 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
5298 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
5299 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
5300 ,Examining Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
5301 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
5302 Variables}).
5303
5304 @table @code
5305 @kindex disassemble
5306 @cindex assembly instructions
5307 @cindex instructions, assembly
5308 @cindex machine instructions
5309 @cindex listing machine instructions
5310 @item disassemble
5311 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
5312 instructions. The default memory range is the function surrounding the
5313 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
5314 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
5315 surrounding this value. Two arguments specify a range of addresses
5316 (first inclusive, second exclusive) to dump.
5317 @end table
5318
5319 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
5320 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
5321
5322 @smallexample
5323 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4 0x32e4
5324 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
5325 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
5326 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
5327 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
5328 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
5329 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
5330 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
5331 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
5332 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
5333 End of assembler dump.
5334 @end smallexample
5335
5336 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
5337 mnemonics or other syntax.
5338
5339 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
5340 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
5341 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
5342 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
5343 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
5344
5345 @table @code
5346 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
5347 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
5348 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
5349 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
5350 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
5351 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
5352
5353 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
5354 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
5355 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
5356 assemblers for x86-based targets.
5357
5358 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
5359 @item show disassembly-flavor
5360 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
5361 @end table
5362
5363
5364 @node Data
5365 @chapter Examining Data
5366
5367 @cindex printing data
5368 @cindex examining data
5369 @kindex print
5370 @kindex inspect
5371 @c "inspect" is not quite a synonym if you are using Epoch, which we do not
5372 @c document because it is nonstandard... Under Epoch it displays in a
5373 @c different window or something like that.
5374 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
5375 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
5376 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
5377 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
5378 Different Languages}).
5379
5380 @table @code
5381 @item print @var{expr}
5382 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
5383 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
5384 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
5385 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
5386 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
5387 Formats}.
5388
5389 @item print
5390 @itemx print /@var{f}
5391 @cindex reprint the last value
5392 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
5393 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}). This allows you to
5394 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
5395 @end table
5396
5397 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
5398 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
5399 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
5400
5401 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
5402 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
5403 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
5404 Table}.
5405
5406 @menu
5407 * Expressions:: Expressions
5408 * Variables:: Program variables
5409 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
5410 * Output Formats:: Output formats
5411 * Memory:: Examining memory
5412 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
5413 * Print Settings:: Print settings
5414 * Value History:: Value history
5415 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
5416 * Registers:: Registers
5417 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
5418 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
5419 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
5420 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
5421 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
5422 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
5423 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
5424 character set than GDB does
5425 * Caching Remote Data:: Data caching for remote targets
5426 @end menu
5427
5428 @node Expressions
5429 @section Expressions
5430
5431 @cindex expressions
5432 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
5433 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
5434 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
5435 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
5436 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
5437 you compiled your program to include this information; see
5438 @ref{Compilation}.
5439
5440 @cindex arrays in expressions
5441 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
5442 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
5443 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to build up an array in
5444 memory that is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
5445
5446 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
5447 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
5448 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
5449 languages.
5450
5451 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
5452 expressions regardless of your programming language.
5453
5454 @cindex casts, in expressions
5455 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
5456 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
5457 at that address in memory.
5458 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
5459
5460 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
5461 to programming languages:
5462
5463 @table @code
5464 @item @@
5465 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
5466 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information.
5467
5468 @item ::
5469 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
5470 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}.
5471
5472 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
5473 @cindex type casting memory
5474 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
5475 @cindex casts, to view memory
5476 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
5477 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
5478 memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
5479 pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
5480 a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
5481 normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
5482 @end table
5483
5484 @node Variables
5485 @section Program Variables
5486
5487 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
5488 in your program.
5489
5490 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
5491 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either:
5492
5493 @itemize @bullet
5494 @item
5495 global (or file-static)
5496 @end itemize
5497
5498 @noindent or
5499
5500 @itemize @bullet
5501 @item
5502 visible according to the scope rules of the
5503 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
5504 @end itemize
5505
5506 @noindent This means that in the function
5507
5508 @smallexample
5509 foo (a)
5510 int a;
5511 @{
5512 bar (a);
5513 @{
5514 int b = test ();
5515 bar (b);
5516 @}
5517 @}
5518 @end smallexample
5519
5520 @noindent
5521 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
5522 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
5523 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
5524 the block where @code{b} is declared.
5525
5526 @cindex variable name conflict
5527 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
5528 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
5529 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
5530 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
5531 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
5532 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file,
5533 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
5534
5535 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
5536 @ifnotinfo
5537 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
5538 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
5539 @end ifnotinfo
5540 @smallexample
5541 @var{file}::@var{variable}
5542 @var{function}::@var{variable}
5543 @end smallexample
5544
5545 @noindent
5546 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
5547 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
5548 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
5549 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
5550
5551 @smallexample
5552 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
5553 @end smallexample
5554
5555 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
5556 This use of @samp{::} is very rarely in conflict with the very similar
5557 use of the same notation in C@t{++}. @value{GDBN} also supports use of the C@t{++}
5558 scope resolution operator in @value{GDBN} expressions.
5559 @c FIXME: Um, so what happens in one of those rare cases where it's in
5560 @c conflict?? --mew
5561
5562 @cindex wrong values
5563 @cindex variable values, wrong
5564 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
5565 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
5566 @quotation
5567 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
5568 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
5569 scope, and just before exit.
5570 @end quotation
5571 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
5572 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
5573 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
5574 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
5575 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
5576 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
5577 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
5578 variable definitions may be gone.
5579
5580 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
5581 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
5582 when compiling.
5583
5584 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
5585 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
5586 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
5587 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
5588 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
5589 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
5590 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
5591
5592 @smallexample
5593 No symbol "foo" in current context.
5594 @end smallexample
5595
5596 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
5597 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
5598 formats. For example, @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler,
5599 usually supports the @option{-gstabs+} option. @option{-gstabs+}
5600 produces debug info in a format that is superior to formats such as
5601 COFF. You may be able to use DWARF 2 (@option{-gdwarf-2}), which is also
5602 an effective form for debug info. @xref{Debugging Options,,Options
5603 for Debugging Your Program or GCC, gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu}
5604 Compiler Collection (GCC)}.
5605 @xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug info formats
5606 that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
5607
5608 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
5609 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
5610 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
5611 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
5612
5613 Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified
5614 signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get
5615 printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or
5616 @code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN}
5617 defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign.
5618 For program code
5619
5620 @smallexample
5621 char var0[] = "A";
5622 signed char var1[] = "A";
5623 @end smallexample
5624
5625 You get during debugging
5626 @smallexample
5627 (gdb) print var0
5628 $1 = "A"
5629 (gdb) print var1
5630 $2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@}
5631 @end smallexample
5632
5633 @node Arrays
5634 @section Artificial Arrays
5635
5636 @cindex artificial array
5637 @cindex arrays
5638 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
5639 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
5640 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
5641 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
5642 program.
5643
5644 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
5645 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
5646 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
5647 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
5648 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
5649 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
5650 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
5651 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
5652 example. If a program says
5653
5654 @smallexample
5655 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
5656 @end smallexample
5657
5658 @noindent
5659 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
5660
5661 @smallexample
5662 p *array@@len
5663 @end smallexample
5664
5665 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
5666 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
5667 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
5668 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
5669 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out.
5670
5671 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
5672 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
5673 The value need not be in memory:
5674 @smallexample
5675 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
5676 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
5677 @end smallexample
5678
5679 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
5680 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
5681 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
5682 @smallexample
5683 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
5684 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
5685 @end smallexample
5686
5687 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
5688 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
5689 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
5690 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
5691 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
5692 Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
5693 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
5694 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
5695 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
5696 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
5697
5698 @smallexample
5699 set $i = 0
5700 p dtab[$i++]->fv
5701 @key{RET}
5702 @key{RET}
5703 @dots{}
5704 @end smallexample
5705
5706 @node Output Formats
5707 @section Output Formats
5708
5709 @cindex formatted output
5710 @cindex output formats
5711 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
5712 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
5713 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
5714 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
5715 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
5716
5717 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
5718 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
5719 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
5720 letters supported are:
5721
5722 @table @code
5723 @item x
5724 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
5725 hexadecimal.
5726
5727 @item d
5728 Print as integer in signed decimal.
5729
5730 @item u
5731 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
5732
5733 @item o
5734 Print as integer in octal.
5735
5736 @item t
5737 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
5738 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
5739 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
5740 see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.}
5741
5742 @item a
5743 @cindex unknown address, locating
5744 @cindex locate address
5745 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
5746 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
5747 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
5748
5749 @smallexample
5750 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
5751 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
5752 @end smallexample
5753
5754 @noindent
5755 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
5756 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
5757
5758 @item c
5759 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
5760 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
5761 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
5762 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
5763
5764 @item f
5765 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
5766 using typical floating point syntax.
5767 @end table
5768
5769 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
5770
5771 @smallexample
5772 p/x $pc
5773 @end smallexample
5774
5775 @noindent
5776 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
5777 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
5778
5779 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
5780 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
5781 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
5782
5783 @node Memory
5784 @section Examining Memory
5785
5786 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
5787 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
5788
5789 @cindex examining memory
5790 @table @code
5791 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
5792 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
5793 @itemx x @var{addr}
5794 @itemx x
5795 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
5796 @end table
5797
5798 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
5799 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
5800 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
5801 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
5802 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
5803
5804 @table @r
5805 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
5806 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
5807 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
5808 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
5809 @c 4.1.2.
5810
5811 @item @var{f}, the display format
5812 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
5813 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
5814 @samp{f}), and in addition @samp{s} (for null-terminated strings) and
5815 @samp{i} (for machine instructions). The default is @samp{x}
5816 (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes each time you use either
5817 @code{x} or @code{print}.
5818
5819 @item @var{u}, the unit size
5820 The unit size is any of
5821
5822 @table @code
5823 @item b
5824 Bytes.
5825 @item h
5826 Halfwords (two bytes).
5827 @item w
5828 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
5829 @item g
5830 Giant words (eight bytes).
5831 @end table
5832
5833 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
5834 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. (For the @samp{s} and
5835 @samp{i} formats, the unit size is ignored and is normally not written.)
5836
5837 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
5838 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
5839 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
5840 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
5841 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
5842 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
5843 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
5844 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
5845 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
5846 a value from memory).
5847 @end table
5848
5849 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
5850 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
5851 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
5852 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
5853 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
5854
5855 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
5856 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
5857 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
5858 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
5859 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
5860
5861 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
5862 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
5863 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
5864 including any operands. For convenience, especially when used with
5865 the @code{display} command, the @samp{i} format also prints branch delay
5866 slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified, which immediately
5867 follow the last instruction that is within the count. The command
5868 @code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of inspecting machine
5869 instructions; see @ref{Machine Code,,Source and Machine Code}.
5870
5871 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
5872 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
5873 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
5874 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
5875 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
5876 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
5877 for successive uses of @code{x}.
5878
5879 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
5880 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
5881 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
5882 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
5883 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
5884 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
5885 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
5886 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
5887 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
5888
5889 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
5890 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
5891 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
5892
5893 @cindex remote memory comparison
5894 @cindex verify remote memory image
5895 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
5896 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image in the
5897 remote machine's memory against the executable file you downloaded to
5898 the target. The @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such
5899 situations.
5900
5901 @table @code
5902 @kindex compare-sections
5903 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{]}
5904 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
5905 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
5906 the remote machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
5907 arguments, compares all loadable sections. This command's
5908 availability depends on the target's support for the @code{"qCRC"}
5909 remote request.
5910 @end table
5911
5912 @node Auto Display
5913 @section Automatic Display
5914 @cindex automatic display
5915 @cindex display of expressions
5916
5917 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
5918 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
5919 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
5920 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
5921 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
5922 The automatic display looks like this:
5923
5924 @smallexample
5925 2: foo = 38
5926 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
5927 @end smallexample
5928
5929 @noindent
5930 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
5931 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
5932 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
5933 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending on how elaborate your
5934 format specification is---it uses @code{x} if you specify a unit size,
5935 or one of the two formats (@samp{i} and @samp{s}) that are only
5936 supported by @code{x}; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
5937
5938 @table @code
5939 @kindex display
5940 @item display @var{expr}
5941 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
5942 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
5943
5944 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
5945
5946 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
5947 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
5948 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
5949 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
5950 @xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}.
5951
5952 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
5953 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
5954 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
5955 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
5956 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
5957 @end table
5958
5959 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
5960 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
5961 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
5962
5963 @table @code
5964 @kindex delete display
5965 @kindex undisplay
5966 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
5967 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
5968 Remove item numbers @var{dnums} from the list of expressions to display.
5969
5970 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
5971 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
5972
5973 @kindex disable display
5974 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
5975 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
5976 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
5977 enabled again later.
5978
5979 @kindex enable display
5980 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
5981 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
5982 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
5983
5984 @item display
5985 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
5986 done when your program stops.
5987
5988 @kindex info display
5989 @item info display
5990 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
5991 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
5992 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
5993 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
5994 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
5995 @end table
5996
5997 @cindex display disabled out of scope
5998 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
5999 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
6000 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
6001 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
6002 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
6003 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
6004 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
6005 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
6006 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
6007 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
6008
6009 @node Print Settings
6010 @section Print Settings
6011
6012 @cindex format options
6013 @cindex print settings
6014 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
6015 and symbols are printed.
6016
6017 @noindent
6018 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
6019
6020 @table @code
6021 @kindex set print
6022 @item set print address
6023 @itemx set print address on
6024 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
6025 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
6026 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
6027 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
6028 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
6029 @code{set print address on}:
6030
6031 @smallexample
6032 @group
6033 (@value{GDBP}) f
6034 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
6035 at input.c:530
6036 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
6037 @end group
6038 @end smallexample
6039
6040 @item set print address off
6041 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
6042 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
6043
6044 @smallexample
6045 @group
6046 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
6047 (@value{GDBP}) f
6048 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
6049 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
6050 @end group
6051 @end smallexample
6052
6053 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
6054 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
6055 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
6056 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
6057
6058 @kindex show print
6059 @item show print address
6060 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
6061 @end table
6062
6063 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
6064 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
6065 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
6066 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
6067 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
6068 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
6069 it prints a symbolic address:
6070
6071 @table @code
6072 @item set print symbol-filename on
6073 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
6074 @cindex symbol, source file and line
6075 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
6076 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
6077
6078 @item set print symbol-filename off
6079 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
6080 default.
6081
6082 @item show print symbol-filename
6083 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
6084 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
6085 @end table
6086
6087 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
6088 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
6089 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
6090
6091 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
6092 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
6093
6094 @table @code
6095 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
6096 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
6097 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
6098 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
6099 @var{max-offset}. The default is 0, which tells @value{GDBN}
6100 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes it.
6101
6102 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
6103 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
6104 symbolic address.
6105 @end table
6106
6107 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
6108 @cindex pointer, finding referent
6109 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
6110 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
6111 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
6112 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
6113 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
6114 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
6115
6116 @smallexample
6117 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
6118 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
6119 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
6120 @end smallexample
6121
6122 @quotation
6123 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
6124 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
6125 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
6126 @end quotation
6127
6128 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
6129
6130 @table @code
6131 @item set print array
6132 @itemx set print array on
6133 @cindex pretty print arrays
6134 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
6135 but uses more space. The default is off.
6136
6137 @item set print array off
6138 Return to compressed format for arrays.
6139
6140 @item show print array
6141 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
6142 arrays.
6143
6144 @cindex print array indexes
6145 @item set print array-indexes
6146 @itemx set print array-indexes on
6147 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
6148 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
6149 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
6150
6151 @item set print array-indexes off
6152 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
6153
6154 @item show print array-indexes
6155 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
6156 arrays.
6157
6158 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
6159 @cindex number of array elements to print
6160 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
6161 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
6162 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
6163 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
6164 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
6165 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
6166 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to zero means that the printing is unlimited.
6167
6168 @item show print elements
6169 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
6170 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
6171
6172 @item set print repeats
6173 @cindex repeated array elements
6174 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
6175 elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
6176 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
6177 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
6178 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
6179 themselves. Setting the threshold to zero will cause all elements to
6180 be individually printed. The default threshold is 10.
6181
6182 @item show print repeats
6183 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
6184 elements.
6185
6186 @item set print null-stop
6187 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
6188 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
6189 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
6190 contain only short strings.
6191 The default is off.
6192
6193 @item show print null-stop
6194 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
6195 @sc{null} character.
6196
6197 @item set print pretty on
6198 @cindex print structures in indented form
6199 @cindex indentation in structure display
6200 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
6201 per line, like this:
6202
6203 @smallexample
6204 @group
6205 $1 = @{
6206 next = 0x0,
6207 flags = @{
6208 sweet = 1,
6209 sour = 1
6210 @},
6211 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
6212 @}
6213 @end group
6214 @end smallexample
6215
6216 @item set print pretty off
6217 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
6218
6219 @smallexample
6220 @group
6221 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
6222 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
6223 @end group
6224 @end smallexample
6225
6226 @noindent
6227 This is the default format.
6228
6229 @item show print pretty
6230 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
6231
6232 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
6233 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
6234 @cindex octal escapes in strings
6235 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
6236 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
6237 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
6238 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
6239 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
6240
6241 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
6242 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
6243 international character sets, and is the default.
6244
6245 @item show print sevenbit-strings
6246 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
6247
6248 @item set print union on
6249 @cindex unions in structures, printing
6250 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
6251 and other unions. This is the default setting.
6252
6253 @item set print union off
6254 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
6255 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
6256 instead.
6257
6258 @item show print union
6259 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
6260 structures and other unions.
6261
6262 For example, given the declarations
6263
6264 @smallexample
6265 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
6266 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
6267 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
6268 Bug_forms;
6269
6270 struct thing @{
6271 Species it;
6272 union @{
6273 Tree_forms tree;
6274 Bug_forms bug;
6275 @} form;
6276 @};
6277
6278 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
6279 @end smallexample
6280
6281 @noindent
6282 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
6283
6284 @smallexample
6285 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
6286 @end smallexample
6287
6288 @noindent
6289 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
6290
6291 @smallexample
6292 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
6293 @end smallexample
6294
6295 @noindent
6296 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
6297 and in Pascal.
6298 @end table
6299
6300 @need 1000
6301 @noindent
6302 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
6303
6304 @table @code
6305 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
6306 @item set print demangle
6307 @itemx set print demangle on
6308 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
6309 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
6310 linkage. The default is on.
6311
6312 @item show print demangle
6313 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
6314
6315 @item set print asm-demangle
6316 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
6317 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
6318 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
6319 The default is off.
6320
6321 @item show print asm-demangle
6322 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
6323 or demangled form.
6324
6325 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
6326 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
6327 @kindex set demangle-style
6328 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
6329 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
6330 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
6331
6332 @table @code
6333 @item auto
6334 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
6335
6336 @item gnu
6337 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
6338 This is the default.
6339
6340 @item hp
6341 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
6342
6343 @item lucid
6344 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
6345
6346 @item arm
6347 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
6348 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
6349 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
6350 require further enhancement to permit that.
6351
6352 @end table
6353 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
6354
6355 @item show demangle-style
6356 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
6357
6358 @item set print object
6359 @itemx set print object on
6360 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
6361 @cindex display derived types
6362 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
6363 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
6364 the virtual function table.
6365
6366 @item set print object off
6367 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
6368 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
6369
6370 @item show print object
6371 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
6372
6373 @item set print static-members
6374 @itemx set print static-members on
6375 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
6376 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
6377
6378 @item set print static-members off
6379 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
6380
6381 @item show print static-members
6382 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
6383
6384 @item set print pascal_static-members
6385 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
6386 @cindex static members of Pascal objects
6387 @cindex Pascal objects, static members display
6388 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
6389
6390 @item set print pascal_static-members off
6391 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
6392
6393 @item show print pascal_static-members
6394 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
6395
6396 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
6397 @item set print vtbl
6398 @itemx set print vtbl on
6399 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
6400 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
6401 @cindex VTBL display
6402 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
6403 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
6404 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
6405
6406 @item set print vtbl off
6407 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
6408
6409 @item show print vtbl
6410 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
6411 @end table
6412
6413 @node Value History
6414 @section Value History
6415
6416 @cindex value history
6417 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
6418 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
6419 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
6420 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
6421 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
6422 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
6423 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
6424 symbol table.
6425
6426 @cindex @code{$}
6427 @cindex @code{$$}
6428 @cindex history number
6429 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
6430 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
6431 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
6432 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
6433 history number.
6434
6435 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
6436 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
6437 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
6438 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
6439 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
6440 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
6441 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
6442
6443 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
6444 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
6445
6446 @smallexample
6447 p *$
6448 @end smallexample
6449
6450 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
6451 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
6452
6453 @smallexample
6454 p *$.next
6455 @end smallexample
6456
6457 @noindent
6458 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
6459 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
6460
6461 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
6462 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
6463
6464 @smallexample
6465 print x
6466 set x=5
6467 @end smallexample
6468
6469 @noindent
6470 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
6471 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
6472
6473 @table @code
6474 @kindex show values
6475 @item show values
6476 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
6477 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
6478 values} does not change the history.
6479
6480 @item show values @var{n}
6481 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
6482
6483 @item show values +
6484 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
6485 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
6486 @end table
6487
6488 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
6489 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
6490
6491 @node Convenience Vars
6492 @section Convenience Variables
6493
6494 @cindex convenience variables
6495 @cindex user-defined variables
6496 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
6497 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
6498 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
6499 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
6500 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
6501
6502 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
6503 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
6504 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
6505 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
6506 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.)
6507
6508 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
6509 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
6510 For example:
6511
6512 @smallexample
6513 set $foo = *object_ptr
6514 @end smallexample
6515
6516 @noindent
6517 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
6518 @code{object_ptr}.
6519
6520 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
6521 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
6522 value with another assignment at any time.
6523
6524 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
6525 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
6526 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
6527 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
6528
6529 @table @code
6530 @kindex show convenience
6531 @cindex show all user variables
6532 @item show convenience
6533 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values.
6534 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
6535
6536 @kindex init-if-undefined
6537 @cindex convenience variables, initializing
6538 @item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
6539 Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
6540 for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
6541 to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
6542 convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
6543 override default values used in a command script.
6544
6545 If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
6546 any side-effects do not occur.
6547 @end table
6548
6549 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
6550 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
6551 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
6552
6553 @smallexample
6554 set $i = 0
6555 print bar[$i++]->contents
6556 @end smallexample
6557
6558 @noindent
6559 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
6560
6561 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
6562 values likely to be useful.
6563
6564 @table @code
6565 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
6566 @item $_
6567 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
6568 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). Other
6569 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
6570 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
6571 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
6572 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
6573 to the type of @code{$__}.
6574
6575 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
6576 @item $__
6577 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
6578 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
6579 to match the format in which the data was printed.
6580
6581 @item $_exitcode
6582 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
6583 The variable @code{$_exitcode} is automatically set to the exit code when
6584 the program being debugged terminates.
6585 @end table
6586
6587 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
6588 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
6589 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
6590
6591 @node Registers
6592 @section Registers
6593
6594 @cindex registers
6595 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
6596 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
6597 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
6598 your machine.
6599
6600 @table @code
6601 @kindex info registers
6602 @item info registers
6603 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
6604 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
6605
6606 @kindex info all-registers
6607 @cindex floating point registers
6608 @item info all-registers
6609 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
6610 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
6611
6612 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
6613 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
6614 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
6615 the selected stack frame. @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
6616 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
6617 @end table
6618
6619 @cindex stack pointer register
6620 @cindex program counter register
6621 @cindex process status register
6622 @cindex frame pointer register
6623 @cindex standard registers
6624 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
6625 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
6626 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
6627 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
6628 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
6629 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
6630 register that contains the processor status. For example,
6631 you could print the program counter in hex with
6632
6633 @smallexample
6634 p/x $pc
6635 @end smallexample
6636
6637 @noindent
6638 or print the instruction to be executed next with
6639
6640 @smallexample
6641 x/i $pc
6642 @end smallexample
6643
6644 @noindent
6645 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
6646 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
6647 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
6648 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
6649 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
6650 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
6651 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with
6652
6653 @smallexample
6654 set $sp += 4
6655 @end smallexample
6656
6657 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
6658 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
6659 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
6660 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
6661 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
6662 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
6663 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
6664
6665 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
6666 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
6667 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
6668 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
6669 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
6670 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
6671 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
6672
6673 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
6674 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
6675 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
6676 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
6677 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
6678 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
6679 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
6680 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
6681 prints the data in both formats.
6682
6683 @cindex SSE registers (x86)
6684 @cindex MMX registers (x86)
6685 Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
6686 in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
6687 have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
6688 together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
6689 registers in @code{struct} notation:
6690
6691 @smallexample
6692 (@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
6693 $1 = @{
6694 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
6695 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
6696 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
6697 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
6698 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
6699 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
6700 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
6701 @}
6702 @end smallexample
6703
6704 @noindent
6705 To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
6706 view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
6707 value to a @code{struct} member:
6708
6709 @smallexample
6710 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
6711 @end smallexample
6712
6713 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
6714 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). This means that you get the
6715 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
6716 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
6717 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
6718 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
6719
6720 However, @value{GDBN} must deduce where registers are saved, from the machine
6721 code generated by your compiler. If some registers are not saved, or if
6722 @value{GDBN} is unable to locate the saved registers, the selected stack
6723 frame makes no difference.
6724
6725 @node Floating Point Hardware
6726 @section Floating Point Hardware
6727 @cindex floating point
6728
6729 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
6730 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
6731
6732 @table @code
6733 @kindex info float
6734 @item info float
6735 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
6736 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
6737 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
6738 the ARM and x86 machines.
6739 @end table
6740
6741 @node Vector Unit
6742 @section Vector Unit
6743 @cindex vector unit
6744
6745 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
6746 more information about the status of the vector unit.
6747
6748 @table @code
6749 @kindex info vector
6750 @item info vector
6751 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
6752 layout vary depending on the hardware.
6753 @end table
6754
6755 @node OS Information
6756 @section Operating System Auxiliary Information
6757 @cindex OS information
6758
6759 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
6760 you debug your program.
6761
6762 @cindex @code{ptrace} system call
6763 @cindex @code{struct user} contents
6764 When @value{GDBN} runs on a @dfn{Posix system} (such as GNU or Unix
6765 machines), it interfaces with the inferior via the @code{ptrace}
6766 system call. The operating system creates a special sata structure,
6767 called @code{struct user}, for this interface. You can use the
6768 command @code{info udot} to display the contents of this data
6769 structure.
6770
6771 @table @code
6772 @item info udot
6773 @kindex info udot
6774 Display the contents of the @code{struct user} maintained by the OS
6775 kernel for the program being debugged. @value{GDBN} displays the
6776 contents of @code{struct user} as a list of hex numbers, similar to
6777 the @code{examine} command.
6778 @end table
6779
6780 @cindex auxiliary vector
6781 @cindex vector, auxiliary
6782 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
6783 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
6784 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
6785 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
6786 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
6787 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
6788 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
6789 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
6790 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
6791 support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
6792 @ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
6793
6794 @table @code
6795 @kindex info auxv
6796 @item info auxv
6797 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
6798 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
6799 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
6800 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
6801 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
6802 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
6803 an unrecognized tag.
6804 @end table
6805
6806
6807 @node Memory Region Attributes
6808 @section Memory Region Attributes
6809 @cindex memory region attributes
6810
6811 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
6812 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
6813 attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
6814 accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
6815 target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
6816 fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
6817 user can override the fetched regions.
6818
6819 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
6820 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
6821 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
6822 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
6823 all memory.
6824
6825 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
6826 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
6827
6828 @table @code
6829 @kindex mem
6830 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
6831 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
6832 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
6833 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
6834 case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address.
6835 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
6836
6837 @item mem auto
6838 Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
6839 regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
6840
6841 @kindex delete mem
6842 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
6843 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
6844 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
6845
6846 @kindex disable mem
6847 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
6848 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
6849 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
6850 It may be enabled again later.
6851
6852 @kindex enable mem
6853 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
6854 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
6855
6856 @kindex info mem
6857 @item info mem
6858 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
6859 for each region:
6860
6861 @table @emph
6862 @item Memory Region Number
6863 @item Enabled or Disabled.
6864 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
6865 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
6866
6867 @item Lo Address
6868 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
6869
6870 @item Hi Address
6871 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
6872
6873 @item Attributes
6874 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
6875 @end table
6876 @end table
6877
6878
6879 @subsection Attributes
6880
6881 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
6882 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
6883 write accesses to a memory region.
6884
6885 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
6886 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
6887 etc.@: from accessing memory.
6888
6889 @table @code
6890 @item ro
6891 Memory is read only.
6892 @item wo
6893 Memory is write only.
6894 @item rw
6895 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
6896 @end table
6897
6898 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
6899 The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
6900 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
6901 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
6902 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
6903
6904 @table @code
6905 @item 8
6906 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
6907 @item 16
6908 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
6909 @item 32
6910 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
6911 @item 64
6912 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
6913 @end table
6914
6915 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
6916 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
6917 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
6918 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
6919 @c
6920 @c @table @code
6921 @c @item hwbreak
6922 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
6923 @c @item swbreak (default)
6924 @c @end table
6925
6926 @subsubsection Data Cache
6927 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
6928 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
6929 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
6930 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
6931 registers.
6932
6933 @table @code
6934 @item cache
6935 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
6936 @item nocache
6937 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
6938 @end table
6939
6940 @subsection Memory Access Checking
6941 @value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
6942 not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
6943 regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
6944 better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
6945
6946 @table @code
6947 @kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
6948 @item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
6949 If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
6950 explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
6951 to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
6952 memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
6953 treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
6954 The default value is @code{off}.
6955 @kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
6956 @item show mem inaccessible-by-default
6957 Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
6958 @end table
6959
6960
6961 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
6962 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
6963 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
6964 @c
6965 @c @table @code
6966 @c @item verify
6967 @c @item noverify (default)
6968 @c @end table
6969
6970 @node Dump/Restore Files
6971 @section Copy Between Memory and a File
6972 @cindex dump/restore files
6973 @cindex append data to a file
6974 @cindex dump data to a file
6975 @cindex restore data from a file
6976
6977 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
6978 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
6979 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
6980 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
6981 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex, or
6982 Tektronix Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only append to binary
6983 files.
6984
6985 @table @code
6986
6987 @kindex dump
6988 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
6989 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
6990 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
6991 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
6992
6993 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
6994 @table @code
6995 @item binary
6996 Raw binary form.
6997 @item ihex
6998 Intel hex format.
6999 @item srec
7000 Motorola S-record format.
7001 @item tekhex
7002 Tektronix Hex format.
7003 @end table
7004
7005 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
7006 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
7007 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
7008 form.
7009
7010 @kindex append
7011 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
7012 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
7013 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
7014 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
7015 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
7016
7017 @kindex restore
7018 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
7019 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
7020 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
7021 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
7022 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
7023
7024 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
7025 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
7026 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
7027 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
7028 from that location.
7029
7030 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
7031 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
7032 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
7033 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
7034
7035 @end table
7036
7037 @node Core File Generation
7038 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
7039 @cindex dump core from inferior
7040
7041 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
7042 image of a running process and its process status (register values
7043 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
7044 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
7045 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
7046 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
7047 the post-mortem debugging mode.
7048
7049 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
7050 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
7051 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
7052
7053 @table @code
7054 @kindex gcore
7055 @kindex generate-core-file
7056 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
7057 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
7058 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
7059 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
7060 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
7061 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
7062
7063 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
7064 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, Unixware, and S390).
7065 @end table
7066
7067 @node Character Sets
7068 @section Character Sets
7069 @cindex character sets
7070 @cindex charset
7071 @cindex translating between character sets
7072 @cindex host character set
7073 @cindex target character set
7074
7075 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
7076 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
7077 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
7078 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
7079 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
7080 @dfn{target character set}.
7081
7082 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
7083 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
7084 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
7085 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
7086 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
7087 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
7088 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
7089 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
7090 character and string literals in expressions.
7091
7092 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
7093 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
7094 target-charset} command, described below.
7095
7096 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
7097 support:
7098
7099 @table @code
7100 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
7101 @kindex set target-charset
7102 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. We list the
7103 character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, but if you type
7104 @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} will
7105 list the target character sets it supports.
7106 @end table
7107
7108 @table @code
7109 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
7110 @kindex set host-charset
7111 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
7112
7113 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
7114 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
7115 @code{set host-charset} command.
7116
7117 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
7118 set. We list the character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, and
7119 indicate which can be host character sets, but if you type
7120 @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} will
7121 list the host character sets it supports.
7122
7123 @item set charset @var{charset}
7124 @kindex set charset
7125 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
7126 above, if you type @code{set charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
7127 @value{GDBN} will list the name of the character sets that can be used
7128 for both host and target.
7129
7130
7131 @item show charset
7132 @kindex show charset
7133 Show the names of the current host and target charsets.
7134
7135 @itemx show host-charset
7136 @kindex show host-charset
7137 Show the name of the current host charset.
7138
7139 @itemx show target-charset
7140 @kindex show target-charset
7141 Show the name of the current target charset.
7142
7143 @end table
7144
7145 @value{GDBN} currently includes support for the following character
7146 sets:
7147
7148 @table @code
7149
7150 @item ASCII
7151 @cindex ASCII character set
7152 Seven-bit U.S. @sc{ascii}. @value{GDBN} can use this as its host
7153 character set.
7154
7155 @item ISO-8859-1
7156 @cindex ISO 8859-1 character set
7157 @cindex ISO Latin 1 character set
7158 The ISO Latin 1 character set. This extends @sc{ascii} with accented
7159 characters needed for French, German, and Spanish. @value{GDBN} can use
7160 this as its host character set.
7161
7162 @item EBCDIC-US
7163 @itemx IBM1047
7164 @cindex EBCDIC character set
7165 @cindex IBM1047 character set
7166 Variants of the @sc{ebcdic} character set, used on some of IBM's
7167 mainframe operating systems. (@sc{gnu}/Linux on the S/390 uses U.S. @sc{ascii}.)
7168 @value{GDBN} cannot use these as its host character set.
7169
7170 @end table
7171
7172 Note that these are all single-byte character sets. More work inside
7173 @value{GDBN} is needed to support multi-byte or variable-width character
7174 encodings, like the UTF-8 and UCS-2 encodings of Unicode.
7175
7176 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
7177 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
7178 @file{charset-test.c}:
7179
7180 @smallexample
7181 #include <stdio.h>
7182
7183 char ascii_hello[]
7184 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
7185 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
7186 char ibm1047_hello[]
7187 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
7188 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
7189
7190 main ()
7191 @{
7192 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7193 @}
7194 @end smallexample
7195
7196 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
7197 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
7198 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
7199
7200 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
7201
7202 @smallexample
7203 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
7204 $ gdb -nw charset-test
7205 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
7206 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
7207 @dots{}
7208 (@value{GDBP})
7209 @end smallexample
7210
7211 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
7212 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
7213 strings:
7214
7215 @smallexample
7216 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
7217 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
7218 (@value{GDBP})
7219 @end smallexample
7220
7221 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
7222 initial character set:
7223 @smallexample
7224 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
7225 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
7226 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
7227 (@value{GDBP})
7228 @end smallexample
7229
7230 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
7231 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
7232 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
7233 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
7234 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
7235
7236 @smallexample
7237 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
7238 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
7239 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
7240 $2 = 72 'H'
7241 (@value{GDBP})
7242 @end smallexample
7243
7244 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
7245 literals you use in expressions:
7246
7247 @smallexample
7248 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
7249 $3 = 43 '+'
7250 (@value{GDBP})
7251 @end smallexample
7252
7253 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
7254 character.
7255
7256 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
7257 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
7258 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
7259
7260 @smallexample
7261 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
7262 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
7263 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
7264 $5 = 200 '\310'
7265 (@value{GDBP})
7266 @end smallexample
7267
7268 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
7269 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
7270
7271 @smallexample
7272 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
7273 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
7274 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
7275 @end smallexample
7276
7277 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
7278 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
7279 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
7280 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
7281 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
7282
7283 @smallexample
7284 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
7285 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
7286 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
7287 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
7288 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
7289 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
7290 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
7291 $7 = 72 '\110'
7292 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
7293 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
7294 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
7295 $9 = 200 'H'
7296 (@value{GDBP})
7297 @end smallexample
7298
7299 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
7300 string literals you use in expressions:
7301
7302 @smallexample
7303 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
7304 $10 = 78 '+'
7305 (@value{GDBP})
7306 @end smallexample
7307
7308 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
7309 character.
7310
7311 @node Caching Remote Data
7312 @section Caching Data of Remote Targets
7313 @cindex caching data of remote targets
7314
7315 @value{GDBN} can cache data exchanged between the debugger and a
7316 remote target (@pxref{Remote Debugging}). Such caching generally improves
7317 performance, because it reduces the overhead of the remote protocol by
7318 bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks. Unfortunately,
7319 @value{GDBN} does not currently know anything about volatile
7320 registers, and thus data caching will produce incorrect results when
7321 volatile registers are in use.
7322
7323 @table @code
7324 @kindex set remotecache
7325 @item set remotecache on
7326 @itemx set remotecache off
7327 Set caching state for remote targets. When @code{ON}, use data
7328 caching. By default, this option is @code{OFF}.
7329
7330 @kindex show remotecache
7331 @item show remotecache
7332 Show the current state of data caching for remote targets.
7333
7334 @kindex info dcache
7335 @item info dcache
7336 Print the information about the data cache performance. The
7337 information displayed includes: the dcache width and depth; and for
7338 each cache line, how many times it was referenced, and its data and
7339 state (dirty, bad, ok, etc.). This command is useful for debugging
7340 the data cache operation.
7341 @end table
7342
7343
7344 @node Macros
7345 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
7346
7347 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
7348 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
7349 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
7350 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
7351 where it was defined.
7352
7353 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
7354 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
7355 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
7356 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
7357
7358 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
7359 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
7360 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
7361 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
7362 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
7363 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
7364 see @ref{List}.
7365
7366 At the moment, @value{GDBN} does not support the @code{##}
7367 token-splicing operator, the @code{#} stringification operator, or
7368 variable-arity macros.
7369
7370 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
7371 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
7372 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
7373
7374 @table @code
7375
7376 @kindex macro expand
7377 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
7378 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
7379 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
7380 @item macro expand @var{expression}
7381 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
7382 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
7383 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
7384 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
7385 it can be any string of tokens.
7386
7387 @kindex macro exp1
7388 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
7389 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
7390 @cindex expand macro once
7391 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
7392 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
7393 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
7394 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
7395 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
7396 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
7397 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
7398 can be any string of tokens.
7399
7400 @kindex info macro
7401 @cindex macro definition, showing
7402 @cindex definition, showing a macro's
7403 @item info macro @var{macro}
7404 Show the definition of the macro named @var{macro}, and describe the
7405 source location where that definition was established.
7406
7407 @kindex macro define
7408 @cindex user-defined macros
7409 @cindex defining macros interactively
7410 @cindex macros, user-defined
7411 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
7412 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
7413 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Introduce a definition for a
7414 preprocessor macro named @var{macro}, invocations of which are replaced
7415 by the tokens given in @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this
7416 command defines an ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the
7417 second form defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments
7418 given in @var{arglist}.
7419
7420 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every expression
7421 evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the @command{macro
7422 undef} command, described below. The definition overrides all
7423 definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged, as
7424 well as any previous user-supplied definition.
7425
7426 @kindex macro undef
7427 @item macro undef @var{macro}
7428 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Remove any user-supplied
7429 definition for the macro named @var{macro}. This command only affects
7430 definitions provided with the @command{macro define} command, described
7431 above; it cannot remove definitions present in the program being
7432 debugged.
7433
7434 @kindex macro list
7435 @item macro list
7436 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} List all the macros
7437 defined using the @code{macro define} command.
7438 @end table
7439
7440 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
7441 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
7442 show our source files:
7443
7444 @smallexample
7445 $ cat sample.c
7446 #include <stdio.h>
7447 #include "sample.h"
7448
7449 #define M 42
7450 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
7451
7452 main ()
7453 @{
7454 #define N 28
7455 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7456 #undef N
7457 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
7458 #define N 1729
7459 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
7460 @}
7461 $ cat sample.h
7462 #define Q <
7463 $
7464 @end smallexample
7465
7466 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler, @value{NGCC}.
7467 We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3} flags to ensure the
7468 compiler includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
7469 information.
7470
7471 @smallexample
7472 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
7473 $
7474 @end smallexample
7475
7476 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
7477
7478 @smallexample
7479 $ gdb -nw sample
7480 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
7481 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
7482 GDB is free software, @dots{}
7483 (@value{GDBP})
7484 @end smallexample
7485
7486 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
7487 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
7488 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
7489
7490 @smallexample
7491 (@value{GDBP}) list main
7492 3
7493 4 #define M 42
7494 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
7495 6
7496 7 main ()
7497 8 @{
7498 9 #define N 28
7499 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7500 11 #undef N
7501 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
7502 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
7503 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
7504 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
7505 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
7506 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
7507 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
7508 #define Q <
7509 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
7510 expands to: (42 + 1)
7511 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
7512 expands to: once (M + 1)
7513 (@value{GDBP})
7514 @end smallexample
7515
7516 In the example above, note that @command{macro expand-once} expands only
7517 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
7518 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
7519 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
7520
7521 Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in
7522 force at the source line of the current stack frame:
7523
7524 @smallexample
7525 (@value{GDBP}) break main
7526 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
7527 (@value{GDBP}) run
7528 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
7529
7530 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
7531 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7532 (@value{GDBP})
7533 @end smallexample
7534
7535 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
7536
7537 @smallexample
7538 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
7539 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
7540 #define N 28
7541 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
7542 expands to: 28 < 42
7543 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
7544 $1 = 1
7545 (@value{GDBP})
7546 @end smallexample
7547
7548 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
7549 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
7550 thereof) in force at each point:
7551
7552 @smallexample
7553 (@value{GDBP}) next
7554 Hello, world!
7555 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
7556 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
7557 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
7558 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
7559 (@value{GDBP}) next
7560 We're so creative.
7561 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
7562 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
7563 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
7564 #define N 1729
7565 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
7566 expands to: 1729 < 42
7567 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
7568 $2 = 0
7569 (@value{GDBP})
7570 @end smallexample
7571
7572
7573 @node Tracepoints
7574 @chapter Tracepoints
7575 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
7576 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
7577
7578 @cindex tracepoints
7579 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
7580 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
7581 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
7582 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
7583 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
7584 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
7585 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
7586
7587 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
7588 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
7589 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
7590 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
7591 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
7592 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
7593 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
7594 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
7595 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
7596 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
7597 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
7598
7599 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
7600 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
7601 how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
7602 remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
7603 support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
7604 packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
7605 Packets}.
7606
7607 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
7608
7609 @menu
7610 * Set Tracepoints::
7611 * Analyze Collected Data::
7612 * Tracepoint Variables::
7613 @end menu
7614
7615 @node Set Tracepoints
7616 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
7617
7618 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
7619 tracepoints can be set. Like a breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), a
7620 tracepoint has a number assigned to it by @value{GDBN}. Like with
7621 breakpoints, tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from
7622 one. Many of the commands associated with tracepoints take the
7623 tracepoint number as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to
7624 work on.
7625
7626 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
7627 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
7628 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
7629 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
7630 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
7631 tracepoint was hit.
7632
7633 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
7634 conditions and actions.
7635
7636 @menu
7637 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
7638 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
7639 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
7640 * Tracepoint Actions::
7641 * Listing Tracepoints::
7642 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments::
7643 @end menu
7644
7645 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
7646 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
7647
7648 @table @code
7649 @cindex set tracepoint
7650 @kindex trace
7651 @item trace
7652 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
7653 Its argument can be a source line, a function name, or an address in
7654 the target program. @xref{Set Breaks}. The @code{trace} command
7655 defines a tracepoint, which is a point in the target program where the
7656 debugger will briefly stop, collect some data, and then allow the
7657 program to continue. Setting a tracepoint or changing its commands
7658 doesn't take effect until the next @code{tstart} command; thus, you
7659 cannot change the tracepoint attributes once a trace experiment is
7660 running.
7661
7662 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
7663
7664 @smallexample
7665 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
7666
7667 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
7668
7669 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
7670
7671 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
7672
7673 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
7674 @end smallexample
7675
7676 @noindent
7677 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
7678
7679 @vindex $tpnum
7680 @cindex last tracepoint number
7681 @cindex recent tracepoint number
7682 @cindex tracepoint number
7683 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
7684 of the most recently set tracepoint.
7685
7686 @kindex delete tracepoint
7687 @cindex tracepoint deletion
7688 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7689 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
7690 default is to delete all tracepoints.
7691
7692 Examples:
7693
7694 @smallexample
7695 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
7696
7697 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
7698 @end smallexample
7699
7700 @noindent
7701 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
7702 @end table
7703
7704 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
7705 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
7706
7707 @table @code
7708 @kindex disable tracepoint
7709 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7710 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
7711 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
7712 the next trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
7713 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
7714
7715 @kindex enable tracepoint
7716 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7717 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. The enabled
7718 tracepoints will become effective the next time a trace experiment is
7719 run.
7720 @end table
7721
7722 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
7723 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
7724
7725 @table @code
7726 @kindex passcount
7727 @cindex tracepoint pass count
7728 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
7729 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
7730 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
7731 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
7732 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
7733 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
7734 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
7735 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
7736 user.
7737
7738 Examples:
7739
7740 @smallexample
7741 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
7742 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
7743
7744 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
7745 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
7746 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
7747 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
7748 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
7749 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
7750 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
7751 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
7752 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
7753 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
7754 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
7755 @end smallexample
7756 @end table
7757
7758 @node Tracepoint Actions
7759 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
7760
7761 @table @code
7762 @kindex actions
7763 @cindex tracepoint actions
7764 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7765 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
7766 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
7767 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
7768 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
7769 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
7770 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
7771 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
7772 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect} and
7773 @code{while-stepping}.
7774
7775 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
7776 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
7777 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
7778
7779 @smallexample
7780 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
7781
7782 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
7783
7784 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
7785 @end smallexample
7786
7787 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
7788 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
7789 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
7790 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
7791 followed by the list of things to be collected while stepping. The
7792 @code{while-stepping} command is terminated by its own separate
7793 @code{end} command. Lastly, the action list is terminated by an
7794 @code{end} command.
7795
7796 @smallexample
7797 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
7798 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
7799 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
7800 > collect bar,baz
7801 > collect $regs
7802 > while-stepping 12
7803 > collect $fp, $sp
7804 > end
7805 end
7806 @end smallexample
7807
7808 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
7809 @item collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
7810 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
7811 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
7812 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
7813 special arguments are supported:
7814
7815 @table @code
7816 @item $regs
7817 collect all registers
7818
7819 @item $args
7820 collect all function arguments
7821
7822 @item $locals
7823 collect all local variables.
7824 @end table
7825
7826 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
7827 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
7828 arguments separated by commas: the effect is the same.
7829
7830 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
7831 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
7832
7833 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
7834 @item while-stepping @var{n}
7835 Perform @var{n} single-step traces after the tracepoint, collecting
7836 new data at each step. The @code{while-stepping} command is
7837 followed by the list of what to collect while stepping (followed by
7838 its own @code{end} command):
7839
7840 @smallexample
7841 > while-stepping 12
7842 > collect $regs, myglobal
7843 > end
7844 >
7845 @end smallexample
7846
7847 @noindent
7848 You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
7849 @code{stepping}.
7850 @end table
7851
7852 @node Listing Tracepoints
7853 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
7854
7855 @table @code
7856 @kindex info tracepoints
7857 @kindex info tp
7858 @cindex information about tracepoints
7859 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7860 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't specify
7861 a tracepoint number, displays information about all the tracepoints
7862 defined so far. For each tracepoint, the following information is
7863 shown:
7864
7865 @itemize @bullet
7866 @item
7867 its number
7868 @item
7869 whether it is enabled or disabled
7870 @item
7871 its address
7872 @item
7873 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
7874 @item
7875 its step count as given by the @code{while-stepping @var{n}} command
7876 @item
7877 where in the source files is the tracepoint set
7878 @item
7879 its action list as given by the @code{actions} command
7880 @end itemize
7881
7882 @smallexample
7883 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
7884 Num Enb Address PassC StepC What
7885 1 y 0x002117c4 0 0 <gdb_asm>
7886 2 y 0x0020dc64 0 0 in g_test at g_test.c:1375
7887 3 y 0x0020b1f4 0 0 in get_data at ../foo.c:41
7888 (@value{GDBP})
7889 @end smallexample
7890
7891 @noindent
7892 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
7893 @end table
7894
7895 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
7896 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
7897
7898 @table @code
7899 @kindex tstart
7900 @cindex start a new trace experiment
7901 @cindex collected data discarded
7902 @item tstart
7903 This command takes no arguments. It starts the trace experiment, and
7904 begins collecting data. This has the side effect of discarding all
7905 the data collected in the trace buffer during the previous trace
7906 experiment.
7907
7908 @kindex tstop
7909 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
7910 @item tstop
7911 This command takes no arguments. It ends the trace experiment, and
7912 stops collecting data.
7913
7914 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
7915 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
7916 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
7917
7918 @kindex tstatus
7919 @cindex status of trace data collection
7920 @cindex trace experiment, status of
7921 @item tstatus
7922 This command displays the status of the current trace data
7923 collection.
7924 @end table
7925
7926 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
7927
7928 @smallexample
7929 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
7930 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
7931 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
7932 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
7933 > while-stepping 11
7934 > collect $regs
7935 > end
7936 > end
7937 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
7938 [time passes @dots{}]
7939 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
7940 @end smallexample
7941
7942
7943 @node Analyze Collected Data
7944 @section Using the Collected Data
7945
7946 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
7947 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
7948 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
7949 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
7950 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
7951 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
7952 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
7953 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
7954 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
7955 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
7956 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
7957 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
7958 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
7959 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
7960 the buffer will fail.
7961
7962 @menu
7963 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
7964 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
7965 * save-tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
7966 @end menu
7967
7968 @node tfind
7969 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
7970
7971 @kindex tfind
7972 @cindex select trace snapshot
7973 @cindex find trace snapshot
7974 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
7975 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
7976 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
7977 snapshot is selected.
7978
7979 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
7980
7981 @table @code
7982 @item tfind start
7983 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
7984 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
7985
7986 @item tfind none
7987 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
7988
7989 @item tfind end
7990 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
7991
7992 @item tfind
7993 No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
7994
7995 @item tfind -
7996 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
7997 retracing earlier steps.
7998
7999 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
8000 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
8001 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
8002 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
8003 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
8004
8005 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
8006 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
8007 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
8008 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
8009 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
8010
8011 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
8012 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
8013 addresses.
8014
8015 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
8016 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
8017 @var{addr2}. @c FIXME: Is the range inclusive or exclusive?
8018
8019 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
8020 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
8021 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
8022 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
8023 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
8024 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
8025 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
8026 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
8027 @end table
8028
8029 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
8030 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
8031 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
8032 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
8033 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
8034 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
8035 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
8036 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
8037 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
8038 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
8039 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
8040 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
8041 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
8042 tracepoint as the current one.
8043
8044 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
8045 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
8046 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
8047 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
8048 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
8049
8050 @smallexample
8051 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
8052 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
8053 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
8054 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
8055 > tfind
8056 > end
8057
8058 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
8059 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
8060 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
8061 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
8062 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
8063 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
8064 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
8065 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
8066 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
8067 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
8068 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
8069 @end smallexample
8070
8071 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
8072 the buffer:
8073
8074 @smallexample
8075 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
8076 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
8077 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
8078 > tfind line
8079 > end
8080
8081 Frame 0, X = 1
8082 Frame 7, X = 2
8083 Frame 13, X = 255
8084 @end smallexample
8085
8086 @node tdump
8087 @subsection @code{tdump}
8088 @kindex tdump
8089 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
8090 @cindex tracepoint data, display
8091
8092 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
8093 the current trace snapshot.
8094
8095 @smallexample
8096 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
8097 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
8098 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
8099 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
8100 > end
8101
8102 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
8103
8104 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
8105 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
8106 at gdb_test.c:444
8107 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
8108
8109 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
8110 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
8111 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
8112 d1 0x18 24
8113 d2 0x80 128
8114 d3 0x33 51
8115 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
8116 d5 0x22 34
8117 d6 0xe0 224
8118 d7 0x380035 3670069
8119 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
8120 a1 0x3000668 50333288
8121 a2 0x100 256
8122 a3 0x322000 3284992
8123 a4 0x3000698 50333336
8124 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
8125 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
8126 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
8127 ps 0x0 0
8128 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
8129 fpcontrol 0x0 0
8130 fpstatus 0x0 0
8131 fpiaddr 0x0 0
8132 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
8133 p1 = (void *) 0x11
8134 p2 = (void *) 0x22
8135 p3 = (void *) 0x33
8136 p4 = (void *) 0x44
8137 p5 = (void *) 0x55
8138 p6 = (void *) 0x66
8139 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
8140
8141 (@value{GDBP})
8142 @end smallexample
8143
8144 @node save-tracepoints
8145 @subsection @code{save-tracepoints @var{filename}}
8146 @kindex save-tracepoints
8147 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
8148
8149 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
8150 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
8151 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
8152 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
8153 Files}).
8154
8155 @node Tracepoint Variables
8156 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
8157 @cindex tracepoint variables
8158 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
8159
8160 @table @code
8161 @vindex $trace_frame
8162 @item (int) $trace_frame
8163 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
8164 snapshot is selected.
8165
8166 @vindex $tracepoint
8167 @item (int) $tracepoint
8168 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
8169
8170 @vindex $trace_line
8171 @item (int) $trace_line
8172 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
8173
8174 @vindex $trace_file
8175 @item (char []) $trace_file
8176 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
8177
8178 @vindex $trace_func
8179 @item (char []) $trace_func
8180 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
8181 @end table
8182
8183 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
8184 use @code{output} instead.
8185
8186 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
8187 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
8188 data.
8189
8190 @smallexample
8191 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
8192
8193 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
8194 > output $trace_file
8195 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
8196 > tfind
8197 > end
8198 @end smallexample
8199
8200 @node Overlays
8201 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
8202 @cindex overlays
8203
8204 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
8205 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
8206 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
8207 use overlays.
8208
8209 @menu
8210 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
8211 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
8212 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
8213 mapped by asking the inferior.
8214 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
8215 @end menu
8216
8217 @node How Overlays Work
8218 @section How Overlays Work
8219 @cindex mapped overlays
8220 @cindex unmapped overlays
8221 @cindex load address, overlay's
8222 @cindex mapped address
8223 @cindex overlay area
8224
8225 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
8226 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
8227 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
8228 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
8229 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
8230
8231 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
8232 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
8233 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
8234 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
8235 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
8236 largest overlay as well.
8237
8238 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
8239 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
8240 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
8241 there.
8242
8243 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
8244 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
8245 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
8246
8247 @smallexample
8248 @group
8249 Data Instruction Larger
8250 Address Space Address Space Address Space
8251 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
8252 | | | | | |
8253 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
8254 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
8255 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
8256 | and heap | | | | | |
8257 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
8258 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
8259 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
8260 | | | | | |
8261 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
8262 address | | | | | |
8263 | overlay | <-' | | |
8264 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
8265 | | <---. | | load address
8266 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
8267 | | | |
8268 +-----------+ | |
8269 +-----------+
8270 | |
8271 +-----------+
8272
8273 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
8274 @end group
8275 @end smallexample
8276
8277 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
8278 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
8279 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
8280 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
8281 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
8282 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
8283 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
8284 program and the overlay area.
8285
8286 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
8287 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
8288 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
8289 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
8290 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
8291 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
8292 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
8293
8294 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
8295 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
8296 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
8297
8298 @itemize @bullet
8299
8300 @item
8301 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
8302 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
8303 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
8304 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
8305
8306 @item
8307 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
8308 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
8309 your program's performance.
8310
8311 @item
8312 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
8313 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
8314 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
8315 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
8316 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
8317 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
8318 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
8319
8320 @item
8321 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
8322 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
8323 instruction and data spaces.
8324
8325 @end itemize
8326
8327 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
8328 improved in many ways:
8329
8330 @itemize @bullet
8331
8332 @item
8333 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
8334 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
8335 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
8336 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
8337 area in the usual way.
8338
8339 @item
8340 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
8341 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
8342
8343 @item
8344 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
8345 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
8346 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
8347 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
8348 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
8349 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
8350 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
8351
8352 @end itemize
8353
8354
8355 @node Overlay Commands
8356 @section Overlay Commands
8357
8358 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
8359 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
8360 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
8361 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
8362 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
8363 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
8364
8365 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
8366 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
8367
8368 @table @code
8369 @item overlay off
8370 @kindex overlay
8371 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
8372 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
8373 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
8374 overlay support is disabled.
8375
8376 @item overlay manual
8377 @cindex manual overlay debugging
8378 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
8379 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
8380 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
8381 commands described below.
8382
8383 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
8384 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
8385 @cindex map an overlay
8386 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
8387 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
8388 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
8389 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
8390 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
8391 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
8392
8393 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
8394 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
8395 @cindex unmap an overlay
8396 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
8397 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
8398 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
8399 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
8400
8401 @item overlay auto
8402 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
8403 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
8404 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
8405 Overlay Debugging}.
8406
8407 @item overlay load-target
8408 @itemx overlay load
8409 @cindex reloading the overlay table
8410 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
8411 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
8412 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
8413 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
8414 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
8415
8416 @item overlay list-overlays
8417 @itemx overlay list
8418 @cindex listing mapped overlays
8419 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
8420 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
8421
8422 @end table
8423
8424 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
8425 of the function the address falls in:
8426
8427 @smallexample
8428 (@value{GDBP}) print main
8429 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
8430 @end smallexample
8431 @noindent
8432 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
8433 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
8434 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
8435 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
8436
8437 @smallexample
8438 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
8439 No sections are mapped.
8440 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
8441 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
8442 @end smallexample
8443 @noindent
8444 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
8445 name normally:
8446
8447 @smallexample
8448 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
8449 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
8450 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
8451 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
8452 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
8453 @end smallexample
8454
8455 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
8456 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
8457 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
8458 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
8459 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
8460
8461 @itemize @bullet
8462 @item
8463 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
8464 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
8465 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
8466 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
8467 @item
8468 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
8469 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
8470 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
8471 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
8472 breakpoints properly.
8473 @end itemize
8474
8475
8476 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
8477 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
8478 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
8479
8480 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
8481 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
8482 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
8483 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
8484 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
8485 current state of the overlays.
8486
8487 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
8488 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
8489
8490 @table @asis
8491
8492 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
8493 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
8494
8495 @smallexample
8496 struct
8497 @{
8498 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
8499 unsigned long vma;
8500
8501 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
8502 unsigned long size;
8503
8504 /* The overlay's load address. */
8505 unsigned long lma;
8506
8507 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
8508 zero otherwise. */
8509 unsigned long mapped;
8510 @}
8511 @end smallexample
8512
8513 @item @code{_novlys}:
8514 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
8515 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
8516
8517 @end table
8518
8519 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
8520 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
8521 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
8522 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
8523 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
8524 currently mapped.
8525
8526 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
8527 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
8528 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
8529 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
8530 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
8531 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
8532 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
8533 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
8534 are not being executed.
8535
8536 @node Overlay Sample Program
8537 @section Overlay Sample Program
8538 @cindex overlay example program
8539
8540 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
8541 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
8542 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
8543 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
8544 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
8545 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
8546 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
8547
8548 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
8549 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
8550 suite. The program consists of the following files from
8551 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
8552
8553 @table @file
8554 @item overlays.c
8555 The main program file.
8556 @item ovlymgr.c
8557 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
8558 @item foo.c
8559 @itemx bar.c
8560 @itemx baz.c
8561 @itemx grbx.c
8562 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
8563 @item d10v.ld
8564 @itemx m32r.ld
8565 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
8566 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
8567 @end table
8568
8569 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
8570 cross-compiler like this:
8571
8572 @smallexample
8573 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
8574 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
8575 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
8576 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
8577 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
8578 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
8579 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
8580 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
8581 @end smallexample
8582
8583 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
8584 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
8585 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
8586
8587
8588 @node Languages
8589 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
8590 @cindex languages
8591
8592 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
8593 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
8594 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
8595 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
8596 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
8597 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
8598
8599 @cindex working language
8600 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
8601 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
8602 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
8603 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
8604 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
8605 language}.
8606
8607 @menu
8608 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
8609 * Show:: Displaying the language
8610 * Checks:: Type and range checks
8611 * Supported Languages:: Supported languages
8612 * Unsupported Languages:: Unsupported languages
8613 @end menu
8614
8615 @node Setting
8616 @section Switching Between Source Languages
8617
8618 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
8619 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
8620 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
8621 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
8622 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
8623 are printed, etc.
8624
8625 In addition to the working language, every source file that
8626 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
8627 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
8628 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
8629 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
8630 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
8631 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
8632 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
8633 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
8634 Displaying the Language}.
8635
8636 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
8637 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
8638 another language. In that case, make the
8639 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
8640 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
8641 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
8642
8643 @menu
8644 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
8645 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
8646 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
8647 @end menu
8648
8649 @node Filenames
8650 @subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages
8651
8652 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
8653 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
8654
8655 @table @file
8656 @item .ada
8657 @itemx .ads
8658 @itemx .adb
8659 @itemx .a
8660 Ada source file.
8661
8662 @item .c
8663 C source file
8664
8665 @item .C
8666 @itemx .cc
8667 @itemx .cp
8668 @itemx .cpp
8669 @itemx .cxx
8670 @itemx .c++
8671 C@t{++} source file
8672
8673 @item .m
8674 Objective-C source file
8675
8676 @item .f
8677 @itemx .F
8678 Fortran source file
8679
8680 @item .mod
8681 Modula-2 source file
8682
8683 @item .s
8684 @itemx .S
8685 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
8686 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
8687 @end table
8688
8689 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
8690 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}.
8691
8692 @node Manually
8693 @subsection Setting the Working Language
8694
8695 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
8696 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
8697 your program.
8698
8699 @kindex set language
8700 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
8701 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
8702 a language, such as
8703 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
8704 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
8705
8706 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
8707 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
8708 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
8709 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
8710 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
8711 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
8712 command such as:
8713
8714 @smallexample
8715 print a = b + c
8716 @end smallexample
8717
8718 @noindent
8719 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
8720 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
8721 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
8722 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
8723
8724 @node Automatically
8725 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language
8726
8727 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
8728 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
8729 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
8730 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
8731 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
8732 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
8733 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
8734 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
8735 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
8736
8737 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
8738 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
8739 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
8740 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
8741 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
8742
8743 @node Show
8744 @section Displaying the Language
8745
8746 The following commands help you find out which language is the
8747 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
8748
8749 @table @code
8750 @item show language
8751 @kindex show language
8752 Display the current working language. This is the
8753 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
8754 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
8755
8756 @item info frame
8757 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
8758 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
8759 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
8760 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other
8761 information listed here.
8762
8763 @item info source
8764 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
8765 Display the source language of this source file.
8766 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
8767 information listed here.
8768 @end table
8769
8770 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
8771 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
8772 with a language explicitly:
8773
8774 @table @code
8775 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
8776 @kindex set extension-language
8777 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
8778 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
8779
8780 @item info extensions
8781 @kindex info extensions
8782 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
8783 @end table
8784
8785 @node Checks
8786 @section Type and Range Checking
8787
8788 @quotation
8789 @emph{Warning:} In this release, the @value{GDBN} commands for type and range
8790 checking are included, but they do not yet have any effect. This
8791 section documents the intended facilities.
8792 @end quotation
8793 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range code added
8794
8795 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
8796 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
8797 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators, and making
8798 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
8799 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
8800 by eliminating type mismatches, and providing active checks for range
8801 errors when your program is running.
8802
8803 @value{GDBN} can check for conditions like the above if you wish.
8804 Although @value{GDBN} does not check the statements in your program,
8805 it can check expressions entered directly into @value{GDBN} for
8806 evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example. As with the
8807 working language, @value{GDBN} can also decide whether or not to check
8808 automatically based on your program's source language.
8809 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default
8810 settings of supported languages.
8811
8812 @menu
8813 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
8814 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
8815 @end menu
8816
8817 @cindex type checking
8818 @cindex checks, type
8819 @node Type Checking
8820 @subsection An Overview of Type Checking
8821
8822 Some languages, such as Modula-2, are strongly typed, meaning that the
8823 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
8824 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
8825 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
8826
8827 @smallexample
8828 1 + 2 @result{} 3
8829 @exdent but
8830 @error{} 1 + 2.3
8831 @end smallexample
8832
8833 The second example fails because the @code{CARDINAL} 1 is not
8834 type-compatible with the @code{REAL} 2.3.
8835
8836 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell the
8837 @value{GDBN} type checker to skip checking;
8838 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
8839 or to only issue warnings when type mismatches occur,
8840 but evaluate the expression anyway. When you choose the last of
8841 these, @value{GDBN} evaluates expressions like the second example above, but
8842 also issues a warning.
8843
8844 Even if you turn type checking off, there may be other reasons
8845 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
8846 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
8847 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
8848 with the language in use, and usually arise from expressions, such as
8849 the one described above, which make little sense to evaluate anyway.
8850
8851 Each language defines to what degree it is strict about type. For
8852 instance, both Modula-2 and C require the arguments to arithmetical
8853 operators to be numbers. In C, enumerated types and pointers can be
8854 represented as numbers, so that they are valid arguments to mathematical
8855 operators. @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for further
8856 details on specific languages.
8857
8858 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the type checker:
8859
8860 @kindex set check type
8861 @kindex show check type
8862 @table @code
8863 @item set check type auto
8864 Set type checking on or off based on the current working language.
8865 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
8866 each language.
8867
8868 @item set check type on
8869 @itemx set check type off
8870 Set type checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
8871 current working language. Issue a warning if the setting does not
8872 match the language default. If any type mismatches occur in
8873 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
8874 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
8875
8876 @item set check type warn
8877 Cause the type checker to issue warnings, but to always attempt to
8878 evaluate the expression. Evaluating the expression may still
8879 be impossible for other reasons. For example, @value{GDBN} cannot add
8880 numbers and structures.
8881
8882 @item show type
8883 Show the current setting of the type checker, and whether or not @value{GDBN}
8884 is setting it automatically.
8885 @end table
8886
8887 @cindex range checking
8888 @cindex checks, range
8889 @node Range Checking
8890 @subsection An Overview of Range Checking
8891
8892 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
8893 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
8894 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
8895 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
8896 not exceed the bounds of the array.
8897
8898 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
8899 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
8900 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
8901 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
8902
8903 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
8904 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
8905 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
8906 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
8907 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
8908 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
8909
8910 @smallexample
8911 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
8912 @end smallexample
8913
8914 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
8915 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported Languages, ,
8916 Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages.
8917
8918 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
8919
8920 @kindex set check range
8921 @kindex show check range
8922 @table @code
8923 @item set check range auto
8924 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
8925 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
8926 each language.
8927
8928 @item set check range on
8929 @itemx set check range off
8930 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
8931 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
8932 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
8933 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
8934
8935 @item set check range warn
8936 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
8937 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
8938 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
8939 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
8940 systems).
8941
8942 @item show range
8943 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
8944 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
8945 @end table
8946
8947 @node Supported Languages
8948 @section Supported Languages
8949
8950 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, Objective-C, Fortran, Java, Pascal,
8951 assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
8952 @c This is false ...
8953 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
8954 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
8955 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
8956 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
8957 language.
8958
8959 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
8960 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
8961 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
8962 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
8963 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
8964 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
8965 language reference or tutorial.
8966
8967 @menu
8968 * C:: C and C@t{++}
8969 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
8970 * Fortran:: Fortran
8971 * Pascal:: Pascal
8972 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
8973 * Ada:: Ada
8974 @end menu
8975
8976 @node C
8977 @subsection C and C@t{++}
8978
8979 @cindex C and C@t{++}
8980 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
8981
8982 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
8983 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
8984 together.
8985
8986 @cindex C@t{++}
8987 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
8988 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
8989 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
8990 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
8991 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
8992 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
8993 compiler (@code{aCC}).
8994
8995 For best results when using @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, use the DWARF 2 debugging
8996 format; if it doesn't work on your system, try the stabs+ debugging
8997 format. You can select those formats explicitly with the @code{g++}
8998 command-line options @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-gstabs+}.
8999 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC,
9000 gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}.
9001
9002 @menu
9003 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
9004 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
9005 * C Plus Plus Expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
9006 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
9007 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
9008 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
9009 * Debugging C Plus Plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
9010 @end menu
9011
9012 @node C Operators
9013 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators
9014
9015 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
9016
9017 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
9018 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
9019 often defined on groups of types.
9020
9021 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
9022
9023 @itemize @bullet
9024
9025 @item
9026 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
9027 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
9028
9029 @item
9030 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
9031 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
9032
9033 @item
9034 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
9035
9036 @item
9037 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
9038
9039 @end itemize
9040
9041 @noindent
9042 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
9043 in order of increasing precedence:
9044
9045 @table @code
9046 @item ,
9047 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
9048 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
9049 expression being the last expression evaluated.
9050
9051 @item =
9052 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
9053 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
9054
9055 @item @var{op}=
9056 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
9057 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
9058 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.
9059 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
9060 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
9061
9062 @item ?:
9063 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
9064 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an
9065 integral type.
9066
9067 @item ||
9068 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
9069
9070 @item &&
9071 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
9072
9073 @item |
9074 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
9075
9076 @item ^
9077 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
9078
9079 @item &
9080 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
9081
9082 @item ==@r{, }!=
9083 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
9084 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
9085
9086 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
9087 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
9088 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
9089 and non-zero for true.
9090
9091 @item <<@r{, }>>
9092 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
9093
9094 @item @@
9095 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
9096
9097 @item +@r{, }-
9098 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
9099 pointer types.
9100
9101 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
9102 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
9103 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
9104 integral types.
9105
9106 @item ++@r{, }--
9107 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
9108 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
9109 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
9110 operation takes place.
9111
9112 @item *
9113 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
9114 @code{++}.
9115
9116 @item &
9117 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
9118
9119 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
9120 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
9121 (or, if you prefer, simply @samp{&&@var{ref}}) to examine the address
9122 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
9123 stored.
9124
9125 @item -
9126 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
9127 precedence as @code{++}.
9128
9129 @item !
9130 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
9131 @code{++}.
9132
9133 @item ~
9134 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
9135 @code{++}.
9136
9137
9138 @item .@r{, }->
9139 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
9140 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
9141 pointer based on the stored type information.
9142 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
9143
9144 @item .*@r{, }->*
9145 Dereferences of pointers to members.
9146
9147 @item []
9148 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
9149 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
9150
9151 @item ()
9152 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
9153
9154 @item ::
9155 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
9156 and @code{class} types.
9157
9158 @item ::
9159 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
9160 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
9161 above.
9162 @end table
9163
9164 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
9165 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
9166 predefined meaning.
9167
9168 @node C Constants
9169 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants
9170
9171 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
9172
9173 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
9174 following ways:
9175
9176 @itemize @bullet
9177 @item
9178 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
9179 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
9180 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
9181 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
9182 @code{long} value.
9183
9184 @item
9185 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
9186 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
9187 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
9188 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
9189 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
9190 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
9191 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
9192 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
9193 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
9194 constant.
9195
9196 @item
9197 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
9198 integral equivalents.
9199
9200 @item
9201 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
9202 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
9203 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
9204 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
9205 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
9206 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
9207 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
9208 @samp{\n} for newline.
9209
9210 @item
9211 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
9212 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
9213 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
9214 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
9215 characters.
9216
9217 @item
9218 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
9219 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
9220
9221 @item
9222 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
9223 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
9224 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
9225 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
9226 @end itemize
9227
9228 @node C Plus Plus Expressions
9229 @subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions
9230
9231 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
9232 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
9233
9234 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
9235 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
9236 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
9237 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
9238 @quotation
9239 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use the
9240 proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently, @value{GDBN}
9241 works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled with
9242 @value{NGCC} 2.95.3 or with @value{NGCC} 3.1 or newer, using the options
9243 @option{-gdwarf-2} or @option{-gstabs+}. DWARF 2 is preferred over
9244 stabs+. Most configurations of @value{NGCC} emit either DWARF 2 or
9245 stabs+ as their default debug format, so you usually don't need to
9246 specify a debug format explicitly. Other compilers and/or debug formats
9247 are likely to work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug
9248 C@t{++} code.
9249 @end quotation
9250
9251 @enumerate
9252
9253 @cindex member functions
9254 @item
9255 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
9256
9257 @smallexample
9258 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
9259 @end smallexample
9260
9261 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
9262 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
9263 @item
9264 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
9265 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
9266 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
9267 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}.
9268
9269 @cindex call overloaded functions
9270 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
9271 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
9272 @item
9273 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
9274 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
9275 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
9276 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
9277 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
9278 default arguments.
9279
9280 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
9281 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
9282 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
9283 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
9284 number of function arguments.
9285
9286 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
9287 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus,
9288 ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
9289
9290 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
9291 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
9292 @smallexample
9293 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
9294 @end smallexample
9295
9296 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
9297 see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}.
9298
9299 @cindex reference declarations
9300 @item
9301 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
9302 them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
9303 dereferenced.
9304
9305 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
9306 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
9307 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
9308 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
9309 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
9310
9311 @item
9312 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
9313 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
9314 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
9315 necessary, for example in an expression like
9316 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
9317 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
9318 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}).
9319 @end enumerate
9320
9321 In addition, when used with HP's C@t{++} compiler, @value{GDBN} supports
9322 calling virtual functions correctly, printing out virtual bases of
9323 objects, calling functions in a base subobject, casting objects, and
9324 invoking user-defined operators.
9325
9326 @node C Defaults
9327 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults
9328
9329 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
9330
9331 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set type and range checking automatically, they
9332 both default to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
9333 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
9334 selects the working language.
9335
9336 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
9337 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
9338 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
9339 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
9340 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language},
9341 for further details.
9342
9343 @c Type checking is (a) primarily motivated by Modula-2, and (b)
9344 @c unimplemented. If (b) changes, it might make sense to let this node
9345 @c appear even if Mod-2 does not, but meanwhile ignore it. roland 16jul93.
9346
9347 @node C Checks
9348 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks
9349
9350 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
9351
9352 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, type checking
9353 is not used. However, if you turn type checking on, @value{GDBN}
9354 considers two variables type equivalent if:
9355
9356 @itemize @bullet
9357 @item
9358 The two variables are structured and have the same structure, union, or
9359 enumerated tag.
9360
9361 @item
9362 The two variables have the same type name, or types that have been
9363 declared equivalent through @code{typedef}.
9364
9365 @ignore
9366 @c leaving this out because neither J Gilmore nor R Pesch understand it.
9367 @c FIXME--beers?
9368 @item
9369 The two @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} variables are
9370 declared in the same declaration. (Note: this may not be true for all C
9371 compilers.)
9372 @end ignore
9373 @end itemize
9374
9375 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
9376 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
9377 that is not itself an array.
9378
9379 @node Debugging C
9380 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
9381
9382 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
9383 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
9384 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
9385 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
9386
9387 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
9388 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
9389 ,Expressions}.
9390
9391 @node Debugging C Plus Plus
9392 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}
9393
9394 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
9395
9396 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
9397 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
9398
9399 @table @code
9400 @cindex break in overloaded functions
9401 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
9402 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
9403 @value{GDBN} breakpoint menus help you specify which function definition
9404 you want. @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint Menus}.
9405
9406 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
9407 @item rbreak @var{regex}
9408 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
9409 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
9410 classes.
9411 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
9412
9413 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
9414 @item catch throw
9415 @itemx catch catch
9416 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
9417 Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
9418
9419 @cindex inheritance
9420 @item ptype @var{typename}
9421 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
9422 @var{typename}.
9423 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
9424
9425 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
9426 @item set print demangle
9427 @itemx show print demangle
9428 @itemx set print asm-demangle
9429 @itemx show print asm-demangle
9430 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
9431 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
9432 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
9433
9434 @item set print object
9435 @itemx show print object
9436 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
9437 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
9438
9439 @item set print vtbl
9440 @itemx show print vtbl
9441 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
9442 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
9443 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
9444 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
9445
9446 @kindex set overload-resolution
9447 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
9448 @item set overload-resolution on
9449 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
9450 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
9451 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
9452 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus
9453 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details).
9454 If it cannot find a match, it emits a message.
9455
9456 @item set overload-resolution off
9457 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
9458 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
9459 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
9460 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
9461 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
9462 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
9463 argument types.
9464
9465 @kindex show overload-resolution
9466 @item show overload-resolution
9467 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
9468
9469 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
9470 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
9471 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
9472 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
9473 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
9474 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
9475 @xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this.
9476 @end table
9477
9478 @node Objective-C
9479 @subsection Objective-C
9480
9481 @cindex Objective-C
9482 This section provides information about some commands and command
9483 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
9484 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
9485 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
9486
9487 @menu
9488 * Method Names in Commands::
9489 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
9490 @end menu
9491
9492 @node Method Names in Commands
9493 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
9494
9495 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
9496 names as line specifications:
9497
9498 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
9499 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
9500 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
9501 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
9502 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
9503 @itemize
9504 @item @code{clear}
9505 @item @code{break}
9506 @item @code{info line}
9507 @item @code{jump}
9508 @item @code{list}
9509 @end itemize
9510
9511 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
9512
9513 @smallexample
9514 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
9515 @end smallexample
9516
9517 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
9518 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
9519 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
9520 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
9521 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
9522 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
9523 debugged, enter:
9524
9525 @smallexample
9526 break -[Fruit create]
9527 @end smallexample
9528
9529 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
9530 enter:
9531
9532 @smallexample
9533 list +[NSText initialize]
9534 @end smallexample
9535
9536 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
9537 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
9538 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
9539 is also possible to specify just a method name:
9540
9541 @smallexample
9542 break create
9543 @end smallexample
9544
9545 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
9546 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
9547 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
9548 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
9549 none apply.
9550
9551 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
9552 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
9553
9554 @smallexample
9555 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
9556 @end smallexample
9557
9558 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
9559 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
9560 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
9561 @kindex print-object
9562 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
9563
9564 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
9565
9566 @smallexample
9567 print -[@var{object} hash]
9568 @end smallexample
9569
9570 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
9571 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
9572 @noindent
9573 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
9574 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
9575 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
9576 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
9577 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
9578 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
9579
9580 @node Fortran
9581 @subsection Fortran
9582 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
9583
9584 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
9585 currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
9586
9587 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
9588 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
9589 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
9590 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
9591 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
9592 underscore.
9593
9594 @menu
9595 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
9596 * Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
9597 * Special Fortran Commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
9598 @end menu
9599
9600 @node Fortran Operators
9601 @subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions
9602
9603 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
9604
9605 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
9606 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
9607 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
9608
9609 @table @code
9610 @item **
9611 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
9612 of the second one.
9613
9614 @item :
9615 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
9616 represent a section of array.
9617 @end table
9618
9619 @node Fortran Defaults
9620 @subsubsection Fortran Defaults
9621
9622 @cindex Fortran Defaults
9623
9624 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
9625 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
9626 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
9627 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
9628
9629 @node Special Fortran Commands
9630 @subsubsection Special Fortran Commands
9631
9632 @cindex Special Fortran commands
9633
9634 @value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features,
9635 such as displaying common blocks.
9636
9637 @table @code
9638 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
9639 @kindex info common
9640 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
9641 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
9642 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
9643 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are
9644 printed.
9645 @end table
9646
9647 @node Pascal
9648 @subsection Pascal
9649
9650 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
9651 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
9652 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
9653 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
9654 syntax.
9655
9656 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
9657 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
9658 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
9659
9660 @node Modula-2
9661 @subsection Modula-2
9662
9663 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
9664
9665 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
9666 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
9667 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
9668 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
9669 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
9670 table.
9671
9672 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
9673 @menu
9674 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
9675 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
9676 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
9677 * M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
9678 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
9679 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
9680 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
9681 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
9682 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
9683 @end menu
9684
9685 @node M2 Operators
9686 @subsubsection Operators
9687 @cindex Modula-2 operators
9688
9689 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
9690 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
9691 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
9692 following definitions hold:
9693
9694 @itemize @bullet
9695
9696 @item
9697 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
9698 their subranges.
9699
9700 @item
9701 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
9702
9703 @item
9704 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
9705
9706 @item
9707 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
9708 @var{type}}.
9709
9710 @item
9711 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
9712
9713 @item
9714 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
9715
9716 @item
9717 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
9718 @end itemize
9719
9720 @noindent
9721 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
9722 increasing precedence:
9723
9724 @table @code
9725 @item ,
9726 Function argument or array index separator.
9727
9728 @item :=
9729 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
9730 @var{value}.
9731
9732 @item <@r{, }>
9733 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
9734 types.
9735
9736 @item <=@r{, }>=
9737 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
9738 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
9739 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
9740
9741 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
9742 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
9743 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
9744 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
9745 comment character.
9746
9747 @item IN
9748 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
9749 Same precedence as @code{<}.
9750
9751 @item OR
9752 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
9753
9754 @item AND@r{, }&
9755 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
9756
9757 @item @@
9758 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
9759
9760 @item +@r{, }-
9761 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
9762 and difference on set types.
9763
9764 @item *
9765 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
9766 on set types.
9767
9768 @item /
9769 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
9770 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
9771
9772 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
9773 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
9774 precedence as @code{*}.
9775
9776 @item -
9777 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
9778
9779 @item ^
9780 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
9781
9782 @item NOT
9783 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
9784 @code{^}.
9785
9786 @item .
9787 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
9788 precedence as @code{^}.
9789
9790 @item []
9791 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
9792
9793 @item ()
9794 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
9795 as @code{^}.
9796
9797 @item ::@r{, }.
9798 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
9799 @end table
9800
9801 @quotation
9802 @emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
9803 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
9804 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
9805 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
9806 @end quotation
9807
9808
9809 @node Built-In Func/Proc
9810 @subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures
9811 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
9812
9813 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
9814 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
9815
9816 @table @var
9817
9818 @item a
9819 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
9820
9821 @item c
9822 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
9823
9824 @item i
9825 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
9826
9827 @item m
9828 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
9829 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
9830 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
9831
9832 @item n
9833 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
9834
9835 @item r
9836 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
9837
9838 @item t
9839 represents a type.
9840
9841 @item v
9842 represents a variable.
9843
9844 @item x
9845 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
9846 explanation of the function for details.
9847 @end table
9848
9849 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
9850
9851 @table @code
9852 @item ABS(@var{n})
9853 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
9854
9855 @item CAP(@var{c})
9856 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
9857 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
9858
9859 @item CHR(@var{i})
9860 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
9861
9862 @item DEC(@var{v})
9863 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
9864
9865 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
9866 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
9867 new value.
9868
9869 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
9870 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
9871 set.
9872
9873 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
9874 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
9875
9876 @item HIGH(@var{a})
9877 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
9878
9879 @item INC(@var{v})
9880 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
9881
9882 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
9883 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
9884 new value.
9885
9886 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
9887 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
9888 there. Returns the new set.
9889
9890 @item MAX(@var{t})
9891 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
9892
9893 @item MIN(@var{t})
9894 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
9895
9896 @item ODD(@var{i})
9897 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
9898
9899 @item ORD(@var{x})
9900 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
9901 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting the
9902 @sc{ascii} character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
9903 integral, character and enumerated types.
9904
9905 @item SIZE(@var{x})
9906 Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
9907
9908 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
9909 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
9910
9911 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
9912 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
9913 @end table
9914
9915 @quotation
9916 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
9917 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
9918 an error.
9919 @end quotation
9920
9921 @cindex Modula-2 constants
9922 @node M2 Constants
9923 @subsubsection Constants
9924
9925 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
9926 ways:
9927
9928 @itemize @bullet
9929
9930 @item
9931 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
9932 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
9933 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
9934 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
9935
9936 @item
9937 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
9938 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
9939 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
9940 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
9941 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
9942 digits.
9943
9944 @item
9945 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
9946 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
9947 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
9948 followed by a @samp{C}.
9949
9950 @item
9951 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
9952 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
9953 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
9954 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
9955 sequences.
9956
9957 @item
9958 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
9959
9960 @item
9961 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
9962 @code{FALSE}.
9963
9964 @item
9965 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
9966
9967 @item
9968 Set constants are not yet supported.
9969 @end itemize
9970
9971 @node M2 Types
9972 @subsubsection Modula-2 Types
9973 @cindex Modula-2 types
9974
9975 Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
9976 syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
9977 types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
9978 print the contents of variables declared using these type.
9979 This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
9980 sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
9981
9982 The first example contains the following section of code:
9983
9984 @smallexample
9985 VAR
9986 s: SET OF CHAR ;
9987 r: [20..40] ;
9988 @end smallexample
9989
9990 @noindent
9991 and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
9992 @code{r} and @code{s}.
9993
9994 @smallexample
9995 (@value{GDBP}) print s
9996 @{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
9997 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
9998 SET OF CHAR
9999 (@value{GDBP}) print r
10000 21
10001 (@value{GDBP}) ptype r
10002 [20..40]
10003 @end smallexample
10004
10005 @noindent
10006 Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
10007
10008 @smallexample
10009 VAR
10010 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
10011 @end smallexample
10012
10013 @noindent
10014 then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
10015
10016 @smallexample
10017 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10018 type = SET ['A'..'Z']
10019 @end smallexample
10020
10021 @noindent
10022 Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
10023 expressions using the debugger.
10024
10025 The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
10026 and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
10027
10028 @smallexample
10029 VAR
10030 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
10031 @end smallexample
10032
10033 @smallexample
10034 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10035 ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
10036 @end smallexample
10037
10038 Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
10039 is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
10040 arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
10041 above. Unbounded arrays are also not yet recognized in @value{GDBN}.
10042
10043 Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
10044
10045 @smallexample
10046 TYPE
10047 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
10048 t = [blue..yellow] ;
10049 VAR
10050 s: t ;
10051 BEGIN
10052 s := blue ;
10053 @end smallexample
10054
10055 @noindent
10056 The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
10057 and value of a variable.
10058
10059 @smallexample
10060 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10061 $1 = blue
10062 (@value{GDBP}) ptype t
10063 type = [blue..yellow]
10064 @end smallexample
10065
10066 @noindent
10067 In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
10068 displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
10069 their @code{C} counterparts.
10070
10071 @smallexample
10072 VAR
10073 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
10074 BEGIN
10075 s[1] := 1 ;
10076 @end smallexample
10077
10078 @smallexample
10079 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10080 $1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
10081 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10082 type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
10083 @end smallexample
10084
10085 The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
10086 pointer types as shown in this example:
10087
10088 @smallexample
10089 VAR
10090 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
10091 BEGIN
10092 NEW(s) ;
10093 s^[1] := 1 ;
10094 @end smallexample
10095
10096 @noindent
10097 and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
10098
10099 @smallexample
10100 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10101 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
10102 @end smallexample
10103
10104 @value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
10105 Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
10106 types:
10107
10108 @smallexample
10109 TYPE
10110 foo = RECORD
10111 f1: CARDINAL ;
10112 f2: CHAR ;
10113 f3: myarray ;
10114 END ;
10115
10116 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
10117 myrange = [-2..2] ;
10118 VAR
10119 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
10120 @end smallexample
10121
10122 @noindent
10123 and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
10124 below.
10125
10126 @smallexample
10127 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10128 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
10129 f1 : CARDINAL;
10130 f2 : CHAR;
10131 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
10132 END
10133 @end smallexample
10134
10135 @node M2 Defaults
10136 @subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults
10137 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
10138
10139 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
10140 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
10141 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
10142 selected the working language.
10143
10144 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
10145 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
10146 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN}
10147 Infer the Source Language}, for further details.
10148
10149 @node Deviations
10150 @subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2
10151 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
10152
10153 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
10154 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
10155
10156 @itemize @bullet
10157 @item
10158 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
10159 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
10160 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
10161 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
10162 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
10163 returned a pointer.)
10164
10165 @item
10166 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
10167 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
10168 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
10169 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
10170
10171 @item
10172 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
10173 argument.
10174
10175 @item
10176 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
10177 @end itemize
10178
10179 @node M2 Checks
10180 @subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks
10181 @cindex Modula-2 checks
10182
10183 @quotation
10184 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
10185 range checking.
10186 @end quotation
10187 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
10188
10189 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
10190
10191 @itemize @bullet
10192 @item
10193 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
10194 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
10195
10196 @item
10197 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
10198 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
10199 @end itemize
10200
10201 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
10202 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
10203
10204 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
10205 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
10206
10207 @node M2 Scope
10208 @subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.}
10209 @cindex scope
10210 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
10211 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
10212 @ifinfo
10213 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
10214 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
10215 @end ifinfo
10216 @iftex
10217 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
10218 @end iftex
10219
10220 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
10221 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
10222 similar syntax:
10223
10224 @smallexample
10225
10226 @var{module} . @var{id}
10227 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
10228 @end smallexample
10229
10230 @noindent
10231 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
10232 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
10233 identifier within your program, except another module.
10234
10235 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
10236 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
10237 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
10238 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
10239
10240 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
10241 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
10242 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
10243 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
10244 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
10245 @var{module}.
10246
10247 @node GDB/M2
10248 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
10249
10250 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
10251 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
10252 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
10253 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
10254 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
10255 analogue in Modula-2.
10256
10257 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
10258 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
10259 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
10260 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
10261 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
10262 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
10263
10264 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
10265 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
10266 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
10267
10268 @node Ada
10269 @subsection Ada
10270 @cindex Ada
10271
10272 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
10273 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
10274 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
10275 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
10276 to be difficult.
10277
10278
10279 @cindex expressions in Ada
10280 @menu
10281 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
10282 and semantics supported by Ada mode
10283 in @value{GDBN}.
10284 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
10285 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
10286 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
10287 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
10288 @end menu
10289
10290 @node Ada Mode Intro
10291 @subsubsection Introduction
10292 @cindex Ada mode, general
10293
10294 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
10295 syntax, with some extensions.
10296 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
10297
10298 @itemize @bullet
10299 @item
10300 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
10301 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
10302 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
10303 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
10304
10305 @item
10306 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
10307 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
10308
10309 @item
10310 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
10311 @end itemize
10312
10313 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if there were
10314 implicit @code{with} and @code{use} clauses in effect for all user-written
10315 packages, making it unnecessary to fully qualify most names with
10316 their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes ambiguity,
10317 @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
10318
10319 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
10320 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
10321 was translated from an Ada source file.
10322
10323 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
10324 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
10325 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
10326 middle (to allow based literals).
10327
10328 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
10329 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
10330 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
10331 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
10332 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
10333 functions to procedures elsewhere.
10334
10335 @node Omissions from Ada
10336 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
10337 @cindex Ada, omissions from
10338
10339 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
10340
10341 @itemize @bullet
10342 @item
10343 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
10344
10345 @itemize @minus
10346 @item
10347 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
10348 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
10349
10350 @item
10351 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
10352
10353 @item
10354 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
10355
10356 @item
10357 @t{'Tag}.
10358
10359 @item
10360 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
10361 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
10362
10363 @item
10364 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
10365 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
10366
10367 @item
10368 @t{'Address}.
10369 @end itemize
10370
10371 @item
10372 The names in
10373 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
10374 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
10375 not currently available.
10376
10377 @item
10378 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
10379 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
10380 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
10381 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
10382 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
10383 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
10384 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
10385 indeterminate values.
10386
10387 @item
10388 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
10389 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
10390 are not implemented.
10391
10392 @item
10393 @cindex array aggregates (Ada)
10394 @cindex record aggregates (Ada)
10395 @cindex aggregates (Ada)
10396 There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
10397 permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
10398
10399 @smallexample
10400 set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
10401 set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
10402 set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
10403 set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
10404 set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
10405 set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
10406 @end smallexample
10407
10408 Changing a
10409 discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
10410 undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
10411 However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
10412 them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
10413 aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
10414 declared to have a type such as:
10415
10416 @smallexample
10417 type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
10418 Id : Integer;
10419 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
10420 end record;
10421 @end smallexample
10422
10423 you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
10424 assignments:
10425
10426 @smallexample
10427 set A_Rec.Len := 4
10428 set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
10429 @end smallexample
10430
10431 As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
10432 rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
10433 components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
10434 component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
10435 original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
10436 indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
10437 redundant component associations, although which component values are
10438 assigned in such cases is not defined.
10439
10440 @item
10441 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
10442
10443 @item
10444 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
10445 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in
10446 which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much
10447 looser in its rules for allowing type matches. As a result, some
10448 function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose
10449 the proper resolution.
10450
10451 @item
10452 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
10453
10454 @item
10455 Entry calls are not implemented.
10456
10457 @item
10458 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
10459 formats are not supported.
10460
10461 @item
10462 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
10463 @end itemize
10464
10465 @node Additions to Ada
10466 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
10467 @cindex Ada, deviations from
10468
10469 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
10470 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
10471
10472 @itemize @bullet
10473 @item
10474 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically
10475 a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer,
10476 then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the
10477 @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array. In
10478 Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is
10479 in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in
10480 Ada. However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in
10481 which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
10482
10483 @item
10484 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that
10485 appears in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name,
10486 you must typically surround it in single quotes.
10487
10488 @item
10489 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
10490 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
10491
10492 @item
10493 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
10494 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
10495 @end itemize
10496
10497 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright
10498 additions specific to Ada:
10499
10500 @itemize @bullet
10501 @item
10502 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
10503 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
10504
10505 @smallexample
10506 set x := y + 3
10507 print A(tmp := y + 1)
10508 @end smallexample
10509
10510 @item
10511 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
10512 the value of its right-hand operand.
10513 This allows, for example,
10514 complex conditional breaks:
10515
10516 @smallexample
10517 break f
10518 condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
10519 @end smallexample
10520
10521 @item
10522 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
10523 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
10524 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
10525 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
10526 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
10527 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
10528 in strings. For example,
10529 @smallexample
10530 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
10531 @end smallexample
10532 @noindent
10533 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF})
10534 after each period.
10535
10536 @item
10537 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
10538 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
10539 to write
10540
10541 @smallexample
10542 print 'max(x, y)
10543 @end smallexample
10544
10545 @item
10546 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
10547 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
10548 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound
10549 of 3 might print as
10550
10551 @smallexample
10552 (3 => 10, 17, 1)
10553 @end smallexample
10554
10555 @noindent
10556 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
10557 clause.
10558
10559 @item
10560 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
10561 multi-character subsequence of
10562 their names (an exact match gets preference).
10563 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
10564 in place of @t{a'length}.
10565
10566 @item
10567 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
10568 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
10569 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
10570 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
10571 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
10572 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
10573 For example,
10574 @smallexample
10575 @value{GDBP} print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
10576 @end smallexample
10577
10578 @item
10579 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
10580 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
10581 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
10582 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
10583 object.
10584
10585 @end itemize
10586
10587 @node Stopping Before Main Program
10588 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
10589
10590 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
10591 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
10592 before reaching the main procedure.
10593 As defined in the Ada Reference
10594 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
10595 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
10596 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
10597 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
10598
10599 @node Ada Glitches
10600 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
10601 @cindex Ada, problems
10602
10603 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
10604 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
10605 @value{GDBN},
10606 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
10607 and the GNU Ada compiler.
10608
10609 @itemize @bullet
10610 @item
10611 Currently, the debugger
10612 has insufficient information to determine whether certain pointers represent
10613 pointers to objects or the objects themselves.
10614 Thus, the user may have to tack an extra @code{.all} after an expression
10615 to get it printed properly.
10616
10617 @item
10618 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
10619 storage are invisible to the debugger.
10620
10621 @item
10622 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
10623 argument lists are treated as positional).
10624
10625 @item
10626 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
10627
10628 @item
10629 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
10630 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
10631 the host machine.
10632
10633 @item
10634 The type of the @t{'Address} attribute may not be @code{System.Address}.
10635
10636 @item
10637 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
10638 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
10639 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
10640 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
10641 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
10642 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
10643 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
10644 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
10645 you can usually resolve the confusion
10646 by qualifying the problematic names with package
10647 @code{Standard} explicitly.
10648 @end itemize
10649
10650 @node Unsupported Languages
10651 @section Unsupported Languages
10652
10653 @cindex unsupported languages
10654 @cindex minimal language
10655 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
10656 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
10657 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
10658 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
10659 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
10660 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
10661
10662 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
10663 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
10664 language.
10665
10666 @node Symbols
10667 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
10668
10669 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
10670 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
10671 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
10672 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
10673 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
10674 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the
10675 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
10676
10677 @cindex symbol names
10678 @cindex names of symbols
10679 @cindex quoting names
10680 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
10681 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
10682 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
10683 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}). File names
10684 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
10685 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
10686 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
10687 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
10688
10689 @smallexample
10690 p 'foo.c'::x
10691 @end smallexample
10692
10693 @noindent
10694 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
10695
10696 @table @code
10697 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
10698 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
10699 @kindex set case-sensitive
10700 @item set case-sensitive on
10701 @itemx set case-sensitive off
10702 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
10703 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
10704 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
10705 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
10706 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
10707 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
10708 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
10709 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
10710 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
10711 case-insensitive matches.
10712
10713 @kindex show case-sensitive
10714 @item show case-sensitive
10715 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
10716 lookups.
10717
10718 @kindex info address
10719 @cindex address of a symbol
10720 @item info address @var{symbol}
10721 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
10722 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
10723 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
10724 is always stored.
10725
10726 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
10727 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
10728 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
10729
10730 @kindex info symbol
10731 @cindex symbol from address
10732 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
10733 @item info symbol @var{addr}
10734 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
10735 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
10736 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
10737
10738 @smallexample
10739 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
10740 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
10741 @end smallexample
10742
10743 @noindent
10744 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
10745 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
10746
10747 @kindex whatis
10748 @item whatis [@var{arg}]
10749 Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression or
10750 a data type. With no argument, print the data type of @code{$}, the
10751 last value in the value history. If @var{arg} is an expression, it is
10752 not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
10753 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place. If
10754 @var{arg} is a type name, it may be the name of a type or typedef, or
10755 for C code it may have the form @samp{class @var{class-name}},
10756 @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union @var{union-tag}} or
10757 @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
10758 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
10759
10760 @kindex ptype
10761 @item ptype [@var{arg}]
10762 @code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
10763 detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
10764 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
10765
10766 For example, for this variable declaration:
10767
10768 @smallexample
10769 struct complex @{double real; double imag;@} v;
10770 @end smallexample
10771
10772 @noindent
10773 the two commands give this output:
10774
10775 @smallexample
10776 @group
10777 (@value{GDBP}) whatis v
10778 type = struct complex
10779 (@value{GDBP}) ptype v
10780 type = struct complex @{
10781 double real;
10782 double imag;
10783 @}
10784 @end group
10785 @end smallexample
10786
10787 @noindent
10788 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
10789 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
10790
10791 @cindex incomplete type
10792 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
10793 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
10794 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
10795 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
10796 given these declarations:
10797
10798 @smallexample
10799 struct foo;
10800 struct foo *fooptr;
10801 @end smallexample
10802
10803 @noindent
10804 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
10805
10806 @smallexample
10807 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
10808 $1 = <incomplete type>
10809 @end smallexample
10810
10811 @noindent
10812 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
10813 completely specified.
10814
10815 @kindex info types
10816 @item info types @var{regexp}
10817 @itemx info types
10818 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
10819 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
10820 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
10821 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
10822 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
10823 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
10824 name is @code{value}.
10825
10826 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
10827 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
10828 lists all source files where a type is defined.
10829
10830 @kindex info scope
10831 @cindex local variables
10832 @item info scope @var{location}
10833 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
10834 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
10835 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
10836 to the scope defined by that location. For example:
10837
10838 @smallexample
10839 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
10840 Scope for command_line_handler:
10841 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
10842 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
10843 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
10844 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
10845 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
10846 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
10847 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
10848 @end smallexample
10849
10850 @noindent
10851 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
10852 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
10853 collect}.
10854
10855 @kindex info source
10856 @item info source
10857 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
10858 the function containing the current point of execution:
10859 @itemize @bullet
10860 @item
10861 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
10862 @item
10863 the directory it was compiled in,
10864 @item
10865 its length, in lines,
10866 @item
10867 which programming language it is written in,
10868 @item
10869 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
10870 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
10871 @item
10872 whether the debugging information includes information about
10873 preprocessor macros.
10874 @end itemize
10875
10876
10877 @kindex info sources
10878 @item info sources
10879 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
10880 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
10881 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
10882
10883 @kindex info functions
10884 @item info functions
10885 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
10886
10887 @item info functions @var{regexp}
10888 Print the names and data types of all defined functions
10889 whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
10890 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
10891 include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
10892 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
10893 that conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
10894 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
10895
10896 @kindex info variables
10897 @item info variables
10898 Print the names and data types of all variables that are declared
10899 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
10900
10901 @item info variables @var{regexp}
10902 Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
10903 variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
10904 @var{regexp}.
10905
10906 @kindex info classes
10907 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
10908 @item info classes
10909 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
10910 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
10911 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
10912 expression.
10913
10914 @kindex info selectors
10915 @item info selectors
10916 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
10917 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
10918 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
10919 expression.
10920
10921 @ignore
10922 This was never implemented.
10923 @kindex info methods
10924 @item info methods
10925 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
10926 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
10927 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
10928 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
10929 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
10930 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
10931 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
10932 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
10933 @end ignore
10934
10935 @cindex reloading symbols
10936 Some systems allow individual object files that make up your program to
10937 be replaced without stopping and restarting your program. For example,
10938 in VxWorks you can simply recompile a defective object file and keep on
10939 running. If you are running on one of these systems, you can allow
10940 @value{GDBN} to reload the symbols for automatically relinked modules:
10941
10942 @table @code
10943 @kindex set symbol-reloading
10944 @item set symbol-reloading on
10945 Replace symbol definitions for the corresponding source file when an
10946 object file with a particular name is seen again.
10947
10948 @item set symbol-reloading off
10949 Do not replace symbol definitions when encountering object files of the
10950 same name more than once. This is the default state; if you are not
10951 running on a system that permits automatic relinking of modules, you
10952 should leave @code{symbol-reloading} off, since otherwise @value{GDBN}
10953 may discard symbols when linking large programs, that may contain
10954 several modules (from different directories or libraries) with the same
10955 name.
10956
10957 @kindex show symbol-reloading
10958 @item show symbol-reloading
10959 Show the current @code{on} or @code{off} setting.
10960 @end table
10961
10962 @cindex opaque data types
10963 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
10964 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
10965 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
10966 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
10967 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
10968 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
10969 another source file. The default is on.
10970
10971 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
10972 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
10973
10974 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
10975 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
10976 is printed as follows:
10977 @smallexample
10978 @{<no data fields>@}
10979 @end smallexample
10980
10981 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
10982 @item show opaque-type-resolution
10983 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
10984
10985 @kindex maint print symbols
10986 @cindex symbol dump
10987 @kindex maint print psymbols
10988 @cindex partial symbol dump
10989 @item maint print symbols @var{filename}
10990 @itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
10991 @itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
10992 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
10993 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
10994 symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
10995 symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
10996 collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
10997 only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
10998 command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
10999 use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
11000 symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
11001 files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
11002 @samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
11003 required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
11004 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how
11005 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
11006
11007 @kindex maint info symtabs
11008 @kindex maint info psymtabs
11009 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
11010 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
11011 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
11012 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
11013 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
11014 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
11015
11016 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
11017 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
11018 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
11019 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
11020 structure in more detail. For example:
11021
11022 @smallexample
11023 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
11024 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
11025 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
11026 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
11027 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
11028 readin no
11029 fullname (null)
11030 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
11031 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
11032 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
11033 dependencies (none)
11034 @}
11035 @}
11036 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
11037 (@value{GDBP})
11038 @end smallexample
11039 @noindent
11040 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
11041 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
11042 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
11043 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
11044 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
11045
11046 @smallexample
11047 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
11048 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
11049 line 1574.
11050 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
11051 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
11052 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
11053 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
11054 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
11055 dirname (null)
11056 fullname (null)
11057 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
11058 debugformat DWARF 2
11059 @}
11060 @}
11061 (@value{GDBP})
11062 @end smallexample
11063 @end table
11064
11065
11066 @node Altering
11067 @chapter Altering Execution
11068
11069 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
11070 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
11071 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
11072 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
11073 program.
11074
11075 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
11076 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
11077 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
11078
11079 @menu
11080 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
11081 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
11082 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
11083 * Returning:: Returning from a function
11084 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
11085 * Patching:: Patching your program
11086 @end menu
11087
11088 @node Assignment
11089 @section Assignment to Variables
11090
11091 @cindex assignment
11092 @cindex setting variables
11093 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
11094 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
11095
11096 @smallexample
11097 print x=4
11098 @end smallexample
11099
11100 @noindent
11101 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
11102 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
11103 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
11104 information on operators in supported languages.
11105
11106 @kindex set variable
11107 @cindex variables, setting
11108 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
11109 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
11110 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
11111 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
11112 ,Value History}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
11113
11114 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
11115 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
11116 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
11117 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
11118 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
11119 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
11120 command @code{set width}:
11121
11122 @smallexample
11123 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
11124 type = double
11125 (@value{GDBP}) p width
11126 $4 = 13
11127 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
11128 Invalid syntax in expression.
11129 @end smallexample
11130
11131 @noindent
11132 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
11133 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
11134
11135 @smallexample
11136 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
11137 @end smallexample
11138
11139 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
11140 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
11141 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
11142 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
11143 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
11144 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
11145
11146 @smallexample
11147 @group
11148 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
11149 type = double
11150 (@value{GDBP}) p g
11151 $1 = 1
11152 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
11153 (@value{GDBP}) p g
11154 $2 = 1
11155 (@value{GDBP}) r
11156 The program being debugged has been started already.
11157 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
11158 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
11159 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
11160 Invalid bfd target.
11161 (@value{GDBP}) show g
11162 The current BFD target is "=4".
11163 @end group
11164 @end smallexample
11165
11166 @noindent
11167 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
11168 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
11169 @code{g}, use
11170
11171 @smallexample
11172 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
11173 @end smallexample
11174
11175 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
11176 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
11177 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
11178 same length or shorter.
11179 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
11180 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
11181
11182 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
11183 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
11184 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
11185 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
11186 and representation in memory), and
11187
11188 @smallexample
11189 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
11190 @end smallexample
11191
11192 @noindent
11193 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
11194
11195 @node Jumping
11196 @section Continuing at a Different Address
11197
11198 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
11199 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
11200 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
11201
11202 @table @code
11203 @kindex jump
11204 @item jump @var{linespec}
11205 Resume execution at line @var{linespec}. Execution stops again
11206 immediately if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{List, ,Printing
11207 Source Lines}, for a description of the different forms of
11208 @var{linespec}. It is common practice to use the @code{tbreak} command
11209 in conjunction with @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
11210 Breakpoints}.
11211
11212 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
11213 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
11214 register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
11215 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
11216 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
11217 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
11218 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
11219 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
11220 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
11221
11222 @item jump *@var{address}
11223 Resume execution at the instruction at address @var{address}.
11224 @end table
11225
11226 @c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
11227 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
11228 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
11229 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
11230 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
11231 example,
11232
11233 @smallexample
11234 set $pc = 0x485
11235 @end smallexample
11236
11237 @noindent
11238 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
11239 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
11240 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}.
11241
11242 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
11243 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
11244 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
11245 detail.
11246
11247 @c @group
11248 @node Signaling
11249 @section Giving your Program a Signal
11250 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
11251
11252 @table @code
11253 @kindex signal
11254 @item signal @var{signal}
11255 Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
11256 signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
11257 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
11258 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
11259
11260 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
11261 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
11262 a signal and would ordinary see the signal when resumed with the
11263 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
11264 signal.
11265
11266 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
11267 after executing the command.
11268 @end table
11269 @c @end group
11270
11271 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
11272 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
11273 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
11274 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
11275 passes the signal directly to your program.
11276
11277
11278 @node Returning
11279 @section Returning from a Function
11280
11281 @table @code
11282 @cindex returning from a function
11283 @kindex return
11284 @item return
11285 @itemx return @var{expression}
11286 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
11287 command. If you give an
11288 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
11289 value.
11290 @end table
11291
11292 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
11293 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
11294 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
11295 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
11296
11297 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
11298 Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
11299 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
11300 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
11301 of functions.
11302
11303 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
11304 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
11305 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
11306 and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the
11307 selected stack frame returns naturally.
11308
11309 @node Calling
11310 @section Calling Program Functions
11311
11312 @table @code
11313 @cindex calling functions
11314 @cindex inferior functions, calling
11315 @item print @var{expr}
11316 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value.
11317 @var{expr} may include calls to functions in the program being
11318 debugged.
11319
11320 @kindex call
11321 @item call @var{expr}
11322 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
11323 returned values.
11324
11325 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
11326 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
11327 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
11328 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
11329 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
11330 value history.
11331 @end table
11332
11333 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
11334 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
11335 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
11336 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
11337
11338 @table @code
11339 @item set unwindonsignal
11340 @kindex set unwindonsignal
11341 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
11342 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
11343 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
11344 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
11345 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
11346 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
11347 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
11348 received.
11349
11350 @item show unwindonsignal
11351 @kindex show unwindonsignal
11352 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
11353 @value{GDBN}.
11354 @end table
11355
11356 @cindex weak alias functions
11357 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is actually a @dfn{weak alias}
11358 for another function. In such case, @value{GDBN} might not pick up
11359 the type information, including the types of the function arguments,
11360 which causes @value{GDBN} to call the inferior function incorrectly.
11361 As a result, the called function will function erroneously and may
11362 even crash. A solution to that is to use the name of the aliased
11363 function instead.
11364
11365 @node Patching
11366 @section Patching Programs
11367
11368 @cindex patching binaries
11369 @cindex writing into executables
11370 @cindex writing into corefiles
11371
11372 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
11373 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
11374 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
11375 patching your program's binary.
11376
11377 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
11378 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
11379 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
11380 repairs.
11381
11382 @table @code
11383 @kindex set write
11384 @item set write on
11385 @itemx set write off
11386 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
11387 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @samp{set write
11388 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
11389
11390 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
11391 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
11392 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
11393
11394 @item show write
11395 @kindex show write
11396 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
11397 as well as reading.
11398 @end table
11399
11400 @node GDB Files
11401 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
11402
11403 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
11404 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
11405 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
11406 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
11407
11408 @menu
11409 * Files:: Commands to specify files
11410 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
11411 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
11412 @end menu
11413
11414 @node Files
11415 @section Commands to Specify Files
11416
11417 @cindex symbol table
11418 @cindex core dump file
11419
11420 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
11421 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
11422 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
11423 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
11424
11425 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
11426 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
11427 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
11428 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver}
11429 Program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify
11430 new files are useful.
11431
11432 @table @code
11433 @cindex executable file
11434 @kindex file
11435 @item file @var{filename}
11436 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
11437 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
11438 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
11439 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
11440 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
11441 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
11442 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
11443 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
11444
11445 @cindex unlinked object files
11446 @cindex patching object files
11447 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
11448 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
11449 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
11450 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
11451 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
11452 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
11453 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
11454 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
11455
11456 @item file
11457 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
11458 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
11459
11460 @kindex exec-file
11461 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
11462 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
11463 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
11464 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
11465 discard information on the executable file.
11466
11467 @kindex symbol-file
11468 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
11469 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
11470 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
11471 table and program to run from the same file.
11472
11473 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
11474 program's symbol table.
11475
11476 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
11477 some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
11478 contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
11479 which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
11480 @value{GDBN}.
11481
11482 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
11483 executing it once.
11484
11485 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
11486 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
11487 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
11488 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
11489 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
11490 using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for
11491 optimized code.
11492
11493 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
11494 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
11495 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
11496 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
11497 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
11498
11499 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
11500 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
11501 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
11502 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
11503 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
11504 Warnings and Messages}.)
11505
11506 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
11507 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
11508 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
11509 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
11510 in stabs format.
11511
11512 @kindex readnow
11513 @cindex reading symbols immediately
11514 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
11515 @item symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
11516 @itemx file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
11517 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
11518 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
11519 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
11520 entire symbol table available.
11521
11522 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
11523 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
11524 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
11525 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
11526 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
11527 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
11528 @c files.
11529
11530 @kindex core-file
11531 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
11532 @itemx core
11533 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
11534 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
11535 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
11536 executable file itself for other parts.
11537
11538 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
11539 to be used.
11540
11541 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
11542 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
11543 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
11544 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
11545 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}).
11546
11547 @kindex add-symbol-file
11548 @cindex dynamic linking
11549 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
11550 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
11551 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{-s}@var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
11552 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
11553 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
11554 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
11555 into the program that is running. @var{address} should be the memory
11556 address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
11557 this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
11558 of @samp{@r{-s}@var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
11559 section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
11560 @var{address} as an expression.
11561
11562 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
11563 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
11564 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
11565 thus read keeps adding to the old. To discard all old symbol data
11566 instead, use the @code{symbol-file} command without any arguments.
11567
11568 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
11569 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
11570 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
11571 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
11572 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
11573 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
11574 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
11575 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
11576 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
11577
11578 @itemize @bullet
11579 @item
11580 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
11581 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
11582 @item
11583 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
11584 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
11585 @item
11586 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
11587 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
11588 @end itemize
11589
11590 @noindent
11591 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
11592 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
11593 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
11594 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
11595 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
11596 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
11597 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
11598 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
11599 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
11600 way.
11601
11602 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
11603
11604 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
11605 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
11606 @cindex load symbols from memory
11607 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
11608 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
11609 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
11610 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
11611 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
11612 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
11613 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
11614 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
11615 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
11616
11617 @kindex add-shared-symbol-files
11618 @kindex assf
11619 @item add-shared-symbol-files @var{library-file}
11620 @itemx assf @var{library-file}
11621 The @code{add-shared-symbol-files} command can currently be used only
11622 in the Cygwin build of @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows OS, where it is an
11623 alias for the @code{dll-symbols} command (@pxref{Cygwin Native}).
11624 @value{GDBN} automatically looks for shared libraries, however if
11625 @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can invoke
11626 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}. It takes one argument: the shared
11627 library's file name. @code{assf} is a shorthand alias for
11628 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}.
11629
11630 @kindex section
11631 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
11632 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
11633 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
11634 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
11635 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
11636 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
11637 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
11638 their addresses.
11639
11640 @kindex info files
11641 @kindex info target
11642 @item info files
11643 @itemx info target
11644 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
11645 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
11646 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
11647 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
11648 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
11649 current ones.
11650
11651 @kindex maint info sections
11652 @item maint info sections
11653 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
11654 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
11655 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
11656 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
11657 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
11658 may be arbitrarily combined):
11659
11660 @table @code
11661 @item ALLOBJ
11662 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
11663 @item @var{sections}
11664 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
11665 @item @var{section-flags}
11666 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
11667 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
11668 @table @code
11669 @item ALLOC
11670 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
11671 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
11672 @item LOAD
11673 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
11674 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
11675 @item RELOC
11676 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
11677 @item READONLY
11678 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
11679 @item CODE
11680 Section contains executable code only.
11681 @item DATA
11682 Section contains data only (no executable code).
11683 @item ROM
11684 Section will reside in ROM.
11685 @item CONSTRUCTOR
11686 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
11687 @item HAS_CONTENTS
11688 Section is not empty.
11689 @item NEVER_LOAD
11690 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
11691 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
11692 A notification to the linker that the section contains
11693 COFF shared library information.
11694 @item IS_COMMON
11695 Section contains common symbols.
11696 @end table
11697 @end table
11698 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
11699 @cindex read-only sections
11700 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
11701 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
11702 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
11703 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
11704 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
11705 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
11706 enhancement to debugging performance.
11707
11708 The default is off.
11709
11710 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
11711 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
11712 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
11713 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
11714
11715 @item show trust-readonly-sections
11716 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
11717 @end table
11718
11719 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
11720 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
11721 name and remembers it that way.
11722
11723 @cindex shared libraries
11724 @value{GDBN} supports GNU/Linux, MS-Windows, HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix,
11725 and IBM RS/6000 AIX shared libraries.
11726
11727 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
11728 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
11729 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
11730 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
11731 debugging a core file).
11732
11733 On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
11734 automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
11735
11736 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
11737 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
11738 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
11739
11740 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
11741 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
11742 particularly large or there are many of them.
11743
11744 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
11745 commands:
11746
11747 @table @code
11748 @kindex set auto-solib-add
11749 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
11750 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
11751 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
11752 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
11753 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
11754 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
11755 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
11756
11757 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
11758 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
11759 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
11760 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
11761 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
11762 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
11763 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
11764 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches
11765 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
11766
11767 @kindex show auto-solib-add
11768 @item show auto-solib-add
11769 Display the current autoloading mode.
11770 @end table
11771
11772 @cindex load shared library
11773 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
11774 command:
11775
11776 @table @code
11777 @kindex info sharedlibrary
11778 @kindex info share
11779 @item info share
11780 @itemx info sharedlibrary
11781 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded.
11782
11783 @kindex sharedlibrary
11784 @kindex share
11785 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
11786 @itemx share @var{regex}
11787 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
11788 Unix regular expression.
11789 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
11790 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
11791 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
11792 loaded.
11793
11794 @item nosharedlibrary
11795 @kindex nosharedlibrary
11796 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
11797 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
11798 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
11799 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
11800 discarded.
11801 @end table
11802
11803 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
11804 when any of shared library events happen. Use the @code{set
11805 stop-on-solib-events} command for this:
11806
11807 @table @code
11808 @item set stop-on-solib-events
11809 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
11810 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
11811 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
11812 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
11813 shared library.
11814
11815 @item show stop-on-solib-events
11816 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
11817 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
11818 library events happen.
11819 @end table
11820
11821 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
11822 configurations. A copy of the target's libraries need to be present on the
11823 host system; they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
11824 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
11825 not.
11826
11827 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
11828 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
11829 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
11830 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
11831 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
11832
11833 @table @code
11834 @cindex prefix for shared library file names
11835 @cindex system root, alternate
11836 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
11837 @kindex set sysroot
11838 @item set sysroot @var{path}
11839 Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any
11840 absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
11841 runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
11842 target program's memory. If you use @code{set sysroot} to find shared
11843 libraries, they need to be laid out in the same way that they are on
11844 the target, with e.g.@: a @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy
11845 under @var{path}.
11846
11847 The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
11848 sysroot}.
11849
11850 @cindex default system root
11851 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
11852 You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
11853 @samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside
11854 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
11855 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
11856 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
11857 location.
11858
11859 @kindex show sysroot
11860 @item show sysroot
11861 Display the current shared library prefix.
11862
11863 @kindex set solib-search-path
11864 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
11865 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
11866 directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path}
11867 is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
11868 path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to
11869 use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
11870 @samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
11871 finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
11872 it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading
11873 of shared library symbols.
11874
11875 @kindex show solib-search-path
11876 @item show solib-search-path
11877 Display the current shared library search path.
11878 @end table
11879
11880
11881 @node Separate Debug Files
11882 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
11883 @cindex separate debugging information files
11884 @cindex debugging information in separate files
11885 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
11886 @cindex debugging information directory, global
11887 @cindex global debugging information directory
11888
11889 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
11890 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
11891 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
11892 Since debugging information can be very large --- sometimes larger
11893 than the executable code itself --- some systems distribute debugging
11894 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
11895 install only when they need to debug a problem.
11896
11897 If an executable's debugging information has been extracted to a
11898 separate file, the executable should contain a @dfn{debug link} giving
11899 the name of the debugging information file (with no directory
11900 components), and a checksum of its contents. (The exact form of a
11901 debug link is described below.) If the full name of the directory
11902 containing the executable is @var{execdir}, and the executable has a
11903 debug link that specifies the name @var{debugfile}, then @value{GDBN}
11904 will automatically search for the debugging information file in three
11905 places:
11906
11907 @itemize @bullet
11908 @item
11909 the directory containing the executable file (that is, it will look
11910 for a file named @file{@var{execdir}/@var{debugfile}},
11911 @item
11912 a subdirectory of that directory named @file{.debug} (that is, the
11913 file @file{@var{execdir}/.debug/@var{debugfile}}, and
11914 @item
11915 a subdirectory of the global debug file directory that includes the
11916 executable's full path, and the name from the link (that is, the file
11917 @file{@var{globaldebugdir}/@var{execdir}/@var{debugfile}}, where
11918 @var{globaldebugdir} is the global debug file directory, and
11919 @var{execdir} has been turned into a relative path).
11920 @end itemize
11921 @noindent
11922 @value{GDBN} checks under each of these names for a debugging
11923 information file whose checksum matches that given in the link, and
11924 reads the debugging information from the first one it finds.
11925
11926 So, for example, if you ask @value{GDBN} to debug @file{/usr/bin/ls},
11927 which has a link containing the name @file{ls.debug}, and the global
11928 debug directory is @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look
11929 for debug information in @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug},
11930 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}, and
11931 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
11932
11933 You can set the global debugging info directory's name, and view the
11934 name @value{GDBN} is currently using.
11935
11936 @table @code
11937
11938 @kindex set debug-file-directory
11939 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directory}
11940 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
11941 information files to @var{directory}.
11942
11943 @kindex show debug-file-directory
11944 @item show debug-file-directory
11945 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
11946 information files.
11947
11948 @end table
11949
11950 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
11951 @cindex debug links
11952 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
11953 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
11954
11955 @itemize
11956 @item
11957 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
11958 a zero byte,
11959 @item
11960 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
11961 boundary within the section, and
11962 @item
11963 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
11964 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
11965 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
11966 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
11967 @end itemize
11968
11969 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
11970 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
11971 described above.
11972
11973 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
11974 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
11975 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
11976 should have the same names, addresses and sizes as the original file,
11977 but they need not contain any data --- much like a @code{.bss} section
11978 in an ordinary executable.
11979
11980 As of December 2002, there is no standard GNU utility to produce
11981 separated executable / debugging information file pairs. Ulrich
11982 Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53,
11983 contains a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command
11984 @kbd{strip foo -f foo.debug} removes the debugging information from
11985 the executable file @file{foo}, places it in the file
11986 @file{foo.debug}, and leaves behind a debug link in @file{foo}.
11987
11988 Since there are many different ways to compute CRC's (different
11989 polynomials, reversals, byte ordering, etc.), the simplest way to
11990 describe the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections is to give the
11991 complete code for a function that computes it:
11992
11993 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
11994 @smallexample
11995 unsigned long
11996 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
11997 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
11998 @{
11999 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
12000 @{
12001 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
12002 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
12003 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
12004 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
12005 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
12006 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
12007 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
12008 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
12009 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
12010 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
12011 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
12012 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
12013 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
12014 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
12015 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
12016 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
12017 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
12018 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
12019 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
12020 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
12021 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
12022 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
12023 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
12024 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
12025 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
12026 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
12027 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
12028 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
12029 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
12030 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
12031 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
12032 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
12033 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
12034 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
12035 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
12036 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
12037 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
12038 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
12039 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
12040 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
12041 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
12042 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
12043 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
12044 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
12045 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
12046 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
12047 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
12048 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
12049 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
12050 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
12051 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
12052 0x2d02ef8d
12053 @};
12054 unsigned char *end;
12055
12056 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
12057 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
12058 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
12059 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
12060 @}
12061 @end smallexample
12062
12063
12064 @node Symbol Errors
12065 @section Errors Reading Symbol Files
12066
12067 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
12068 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
12069 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
12070 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
12071 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
12072 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
12073 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
12074 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
12075 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
12076 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
12077 Messages}).
12078
12079 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
12080
12081 @table @code
12082 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
12083
12084 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
12085 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
12086 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
12087 in its outer scope blocks.
12088
12089 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
12090 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
12091 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
12092 function.
12093
12094 @item block at @var{address} out of order
12095
12096 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
12097 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
12098 do so.
12099
12100 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
12101 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
12102 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
12103 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
12104 Messages}.)
12105
12106 @item bad block start address patched
12107
12108 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
12109 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
12110 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
12111
12112 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
12113 starting on the previous source line.
12114
12115 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
12116
12117 @cindex foo
12118 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
12119 larger than the size of the string table.
12120
12121 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
12122 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
12123 with this name.
12124
12125 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
12126
12127 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
12128 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
12129 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
12130
12131 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
12132 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
12133 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
12134 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
12135 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
12136 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
12137
12138 @item stub type has NULL name
12139
12140 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
12141
12142 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
12143 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
12144 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
12145 it.
12146
12147 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
12148
12149 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
12150
12151 @end table
12152
12153 @node Targets
12154 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
12155
12156 @cindex debugging target
12157 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
12158
12159 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
12160 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
12161 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
12162 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
12163 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
12164 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
12165 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
12166 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}).
12167
12168 @cindex target architecture
12169 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
12170 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
12171 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
12172 command.
12173
12174 @table @code
12175 @kindex set architecture
12176 @kindex show architecture
12177 @item set architecture @var{arch}
12178 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
12179 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
12180 supported architectures.
12181
12182 @item show architecture
12183 Show the current target architecture.
12184
12185 @item set processor
12186 @itemx processor
12187 @kindex set processor
12188 @kindex show processor
12189 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
12190 and @code{show architecture}.
12191 @end table
12192
12193 @menu
12194 * Active Targets:: Active targets
12195 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
12196 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
12197 @end menu
12198
12199 @node Active Targets
12200 @section Active Targets
12201
12202 @cindex stacking targets
12203 @cindex active targets
12204 @cindex multiple targets
12205
12206 There are three classes of targets: processes, core files, and
12207 executable files. @value{GDBN} can work concurrently on up to three
12208 active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for example)
12209 start a process and inspect its activity without abandoning your work on
12210 a core file.
12211
12212 For example, if you execute @samp{gdb a.out}, then the executable file
12213 @code{a.out} is the only active target. If you designate a core file as
12214 well---presumably from a prior run that crashed and coredumped---then
12215 @value{GDBN} has two active targets and uses them in tandem, looking
12216 first in the corefile target, then in the executable file, to satisfy
12217 requests for memory addresses. (Typically, these two classes of target
12218 are complementary, since core files contain only a program's
12219 read-write memory---variables and so on---plus machine status, while
12220 executable files contain only the program text and initialized data.)
12221
12222 When you type @code{run}, your executable file becomes an active process
12223 target as well. When a process target is active, all @value{GDBN}
12224 commands requesting memory addresses refer to that target; addresses in
12225 an active core file or executable file target are obscured while the
12226 process target is active.
12227
12228 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new
12229 core file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify
12230 Files}). To specify as a target a process that is already running, use
12231 the @code{attach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running
12232 Process}).
12233
12234 @node Target Commands
12235 @section Commands for Managing Targets
12236
12237 @table @code
12238 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
12239 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
12240 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
12241 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
12242 protocol of the target machine.
12243
12244 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
12245 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
12246 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
12247
12248 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
12249 after executing the command.
12250
12251 @kindex help target
12252 @item help target
12253 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
12254 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
12255 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
12256
12257 @item help target @var{name}
12258 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
12259 select it.
12260
12261 @kindex set gnutarget
12262 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
12263 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
12264 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
12265 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
12266 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
12267 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
12268
12269 @quotation
12270 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
12271 you must know the actual BFD name.
12272 @end quotation
12273
12274 @noindent
12275 @xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}.
12276
12277 @kindex show gnutarget
12278 @item show gnutarget
12279 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
12280 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
12281 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
12282 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BDF target is "auto"}.
12283 @end table
12284
12285 @cindex common targets
12286 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
12287 configuration):
12288
12289 @table @code
12290 @kindex target
12291 @item target exec @var{program}
12292 @cindex executable file target
12293 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
12294 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
12295
12296 @item target core @var{filename}
12297 @cindex core dump file target
12298 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
12299 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
12300
12301 @item target remote @var{medium}
12302 @cindex remote target
12303 A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
12304 connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
12305 protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
12306
12307 For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
12308 machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
12309
12310 @smallexample
12311 target remote /dev/ttya
12312 @end smallexample
12313
12314 @code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
12315 useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
12316 system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
12317 clobbered by the download.
12318
12319 @item target sim
12320 @cindex built-in simulator target
12321 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
12322 In general,
12323 @smallexample
12324 target sim
12325 load
12326 run
12327 @end smallexample
12328 @noindent
12329 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
12330 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
12331 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
12332 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
12333 Processors}.
12334
12335 @end table
12336
12337 Some configurations may include these targets as well:
12338
12339 @table @code
12340
12341 @item target nrom @var{dev}
12342 @cindex NetROM ROM emulator target
12343 NetROM ROM emulator. This target only supports downloading.
12344
12345 @end table
12346
12347 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
12348 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
12349
12350 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
12351 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
12352 various aspects of this process.
12353
12354 @table @code
12355
12356 @item set hash
12357 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
12358 @cindex hash mark while downloading
12359 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
12360 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
12361 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
12362 monitor.
12363
12364 @item show hash
12365 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
12366 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
12367
12368 @item set debug monitor
12369 @kindex set debug monitor
12370 @cindex display remote monitor communications
12371 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
12372 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
12373
12374 @item show debug monitor
12375 @kindex show debug monitor
12376 Show the current status of displaying communications between
12377 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
12378 @end table
12379
12380 @table @code
12381
12382 @kindex load @var{filename}
12383 @item load @var{filename}
12384 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
12385 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
12386 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
12387 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
12388 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
12389 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
12390
12391 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
12392 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
12393 target is @dots{}}''
12394
12395 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
12396 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
12397 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
12398 specifies a fixed address.
12399 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
12400
12401 Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
12402 load programs into flash memory.
12403
12404 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
12405 @end table
12406
12407 @node Byte Order
12408 @section Choosing Target Byte Order
12409
12410 @cindex choosing target byte order
12411 @cindex target byte order
12412
12413 Some types of processors, such as the MIPS, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
12414 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
12415 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
12416 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
12417 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
12418 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
12419
12420 @table @code
12421 @kindex set endian
12422 @item set endian big
12423 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
12424
12425 @item set endian little
12426 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
12427
12428 @item set endian auto
12429 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
12430 executable.
12431
12432 @item show endian
12433 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
12434
12435 @end table
12436
12437 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
12438 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
12439 target system.
12440
12441
12442 @node Remote Debugging
12443 @chapter Debugging Remote Programs
12444 @cindex remote debugging
12445
12446 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
12447 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
12448 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
12449 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
12450 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
12451
12452 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
12453 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
12454 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
12455 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
12456 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
12457 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
12458
12459 Other remote targets may be available in your
12460 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
12461
12462 @menu
12463 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
12464 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
12465 * Remote Configuration:: Remote configuration
12466 * Remote Stub:: Implementing a remote stub
12467 @end menu
12468
12469 @node Connecting
12470 @section Connecting to a Remote Target
12471
12472 On the @value{GDBN} host machine, you will need an unstripped copy of
12473 your program, since @value{GDBN} needs symbol and debugging information.
12474 Start up @value{GDBN} as usual, using the name of the local copy of your
12475 program as the first argument.
12476
12477 @cindex @code{target remote}
12478 @value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, or
12479 over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
12480 each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
12481 program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
12482 @code{target remote} command establishes a connection to the target.
12483 Its arguments indicate which medium to use:
12484
12485 @table @code
12486
12487 @item target remote @var{serial-device}
12488 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
12489 Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
12490 to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
12491
12492 @smallexample
12493 target remote /dev/ttyb
12494 @end smallexample
12495
12496 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
12497 @w{@samp{--baud}} option, or use the @code{set remotebaud} command
12498 (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remotebaud}) before the
12499 @code{target} command.
12500
12501 @item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
12502 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
12503 @cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
12504 Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
12505 The @var{host} may be either a host name or a numeric @acronym{IP}
12506 address; @var{port} must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be
12507 the target machine itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or
12508 it might be a terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the
12509 target.
12510
12511 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
12512 @code{manyfarms}:
12513
12514 @smallexample
12515 target remote manyfarms:2828
12516 @end smallexample
12517
12518 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
12519 debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
12520 same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
12521 port 1234 on your local machine:
12522
12523 @smallexample
12524 target remote :1234
12525 @end smallexample
12526 @noindent
12527
12528 Note that the colon is still required here.
12529
12530 @item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
12531 @cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
12532 Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
12533 connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
12534
12535 @smallexample
12536 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
12537 @end smallexample
12538
12539 When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
12540 keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
12541 can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
12542 cause havoc with your debugging session.
12543
12544 @item target remote | @var{command}
12545 @cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
12546 Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
12547 pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
12548 by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
12549 protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
12550 standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
12551 that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
12552 using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
12553
12554 If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
12555 @value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
12556 program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
12557
12558 @end table
12559
12560 Once the connection has been established, you can use all the usual
12561 commands to examine and change data and to step and continue the
12562 remote program.
12563
12564 @cindex interrupting remote programs
12565 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
12566 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
12567 interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
12568 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
12569 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
12570 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
12571
12572 @smallexample
12573 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
12574 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
12575 @end smallexample
12576
12577 If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
12578 (If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
12579 remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
12580 goes back to waiting.
12581
12582 @table @code
12583 @kindex detach (remote)
12584 @item detach
12585 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
12586 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
12587 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
12588 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
12589 command, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to another target.
12590
12591 @kindex disconnect
12592 @item disconnect
12593 The @code{disconnect} command behaves like @code{detach}, except that
12594 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
12595 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
12596 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
12597 another target.
12598
12599 @cindex send command to remote monitor
12600 @cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
12601 @cindex add new commands for external monitor
12602 @kindex monitor
12603 @item monitor @var{cmd}
12604 This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
12605 remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
12606 sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
12607 can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
12608 and implement.
12609 @end table
12610
12611 @node Server
12612 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program
12613
12614 @kindex gdbserver
12615 @cindex remote connection without stubs
12616 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
12617 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
12618 @code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
12619
12620 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
12621 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
12622 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
12623 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
12624 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
12625 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
12626 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
12627 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
12628 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
12629 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
12630 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
12631 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
12632 choice for debugging.
12633
12634 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
12635 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
12636 protocol.
12637
12638 @table @emph
12639 @item On the target machine,
12640 you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
12641 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
12642 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
12643 system does all the symbol handling.
12644
12645 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
12646 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
12647 syntax is:
12648
12649 @smallexample
12650 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
12651 @end smallexample
12652
12653 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line) or a TCP
12654 hostname and portnumber. For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
12655 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
12656 @file{/dev/com1}:
12657
12658 @smallexample
12659 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
12660 @end smallexample
12661
12662 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
12663 with it.
12664
12665 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
12666
12667 @smallexample
12668 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
12669 @end smallexample
12670
12671 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
12672 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
12673 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
12674 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
12675 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
12676 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
12677 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
12678 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
12679 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
12680 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
12681 @code{target remote} command.
12682
12683 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
12684 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
12685
12686 @smallexample
12687 target> gdbserver @var{comm} --attach @var{pid}
12688 @end smallexample
12689
12690 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't necessary
12691 to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
12692
12693 @pindex pidof
12694 @cindex attach to a program by name
12695 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
12696 @code{pidof} utility:
12697
12698 @smallexample
12699 target> gdbserver @var{comm} --attach `pidof @var{program}`
12700 @end smallexample
12701
12702 In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
12703 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
12704 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
12705
12706 @item On the host machine,
12707 first make sure you have the necessary symbol files. Load symbols for
12708 your application using the @code{file} command before you connect. Use
12709 @code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN}
12710 was compiled with the correct sysroot using @code{--with-system-root}).
12711
12712 The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
12713 and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
12714 system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
12715 are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
12716 during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
12717 files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
12718 programs.
12719
12720 Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
12721 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
12722 the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
12723 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
12724 @samp{Connection refused}. You don't need to use the @code{load}
12725 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{gdbserver}, since the program is
12726 already on the target.
12727
12728 @end table
12729
12730 @subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver}
12731 @cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver}
12732
12733 During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the
12734 @code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}.
12735 Here are the available commands; they are only of interest when
12736 debugging @value{GDBN} or @code{gdbserver}.
12737
12738 @table @code
12739 @item monitor help
12740 List the available monitor commands.
12741
12742 @item monitor set debug 0
12743 @itemx monitor set debug 1
12744 Disable or enable general debugging messages.
12745
12746 @item monitor set remote-debug 0
12747 @itemx monitor set remote-debug 1
12748 Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote
12749 protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}).
12750
12751 @end table
12752
12753 @node Remote Configuration
12754 @section Remote Configuration
12755
12756 @kindex set remote
12757 @kindex show remote
12758 This section documents the configuration options available when
12759 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
12760 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
12761 system-call-allowed}.
12762
12763 @table @code
12764 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
12765 @cindex address size for remote targets
12766 @cindex bits in remote address
12767 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
12768 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
12769 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
12770 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
12771
12772 @item show remoteaddresssize
12773 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
12774
12775 @item set remotebaud @var{n}
12776 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
12777 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
12778 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
12779 remote targets.
12780
12781 @item show remotebaud
12782 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
12783
12784 @item set remotebreak
12785 @cindex interrupt remote programs
12786 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
12787 @anchor{set remotebreak}
12788 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
12789 when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
12790 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
12791 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
12792 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
12793
12794 @item show remotebreak
12795 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
12796 interrupt the remote program.
12797
12798 @item set remoteflow on
12799 @itemx set remoteflow off
12800 @kindex set remoteflow
12801 Enable or disable hardware flow control (@code{RTS}/@code{CTS})
12802 on the serial port used to communicate to the remote target.
12803
12804 @item show remoteflow
12805 @kindex show remoteflow
12806 Show the current setting of hardware flow control.
12807
12808 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
12809 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
12810 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
12811 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
12812 @code{ascii}.
12813
12814 @item show remotelogbase
12815 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
12816 protocol.
12817
12818 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
12819 @cindex record serial communications on file
12820 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
12821 default is not to record at all.
12822
12823 @item show remotelogfile.
12824 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
12825 serial communications.
12826
12827 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
12828 @cindex timeout for serial communications
12829 @cindex remote timeout
12830 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
12831 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
12832
12833 @item show remotetimeout
12834 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
12835 responses.
12836
12837 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
12838 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
12839 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
12840 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
12841 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
12842 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
12843 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or
12844 watchpoints. A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited.
12845 @end table
12846
12847 @cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
12848 The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
12849 your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
12850 can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
12851 packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
12852 packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
12853 or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
12854 all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
12855 see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
12856
12857 During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
12858 If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
12859 in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
12860 @value{GDBN} developers.
12861
12862 For each packet @var{name}, the command to enable or disable the
12863 packet is @code{set remote @var{name}-packet}. The available settings
12864 are:
12865
12866 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.32 0.25
12867 @item Command Name
12868 @tab Remote Packet
12869 @tab Related Features
12870
12871 @item @code{fetch-register}
12872 @tab @code{p}
12873 @tab @code{info registers}
12874
12875 @item @code{set-register}
12876 @tab @code{P}
12877 @tab @code{set}
12878
12879 @item @code{binary-download}
12880 @tab @code{X}
12881 @tab @code{load}, @code{set}
12882
12883 @item @code{read-aux-vector}
12884 @tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
12885 @tab @code{info auxv}
12886
12887 @item @code{symbol-lookup}
12888 @tab @code{qSymbol}
12889 @tab Detecting multiple threads
12890
12891 @item @code{verbose-resume}
12892 @tab @code{vCont}
12893 @tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
12894
12895 @item @code{software-breakpoint}
12896 @tab @code{Z0}
12897 @tab @code{break}
12898
12899 @item @code{hardware-breakpoint}
12900 @tab @code{Z1}
12901 @tab @code{hbreak}
12902
12903 @item @code{write-watchpoint}
12904 @tab @code{Z2}
12905 @tab @code{watch}
12906
12907 @item @code{read-watchpoint}
12908 @tab @code{Z3}
12909 @tab @code{rwatch}
12910
12911 @item @code{access-watchpoint}
12912 @tab @code{Z4}
12913 @tab @code{awatch}
12914
12915 @item @code{target-features}
12916 @tab @code{qXfer:features:read}
12917 @tab @code{set architecture}
12918
12919 @item @code{library-info}
12920 @tab @code{qXfer:libraries:read}
12921 @tab @code{info sharedlibrary}
12922
12923 @item @code{memory-map}
12924 @tab @code{qXfer:memory-map:read}
12925 @tab @code{info mem}
12926
12927 @item @code{read-spu-object}
12928 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:read}
12929 @tab @code{info spu}
12930
12931 @item @code{write-spu-object}
12932 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:write}
12933 @tab @code{info spu}
12934
12935 @item @code{get-thread-local-@*storage-address}
12936 @tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
12937 @tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
12938
12939 @item @code{supported-packets}
12940 @tab @code{qSupported}
12941 @tab Remote communications parameters
12942
12943 @item @code{pass-signals}
12944 @tab @code{QPassSignals}
12945 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
12946
12947 @end multitable
12948
12949 @node Remote Stub
12950 @section Implementing a Remote Stub
12951
12952 @cindex debugging stub, example
12953 @cindex remote stub, example
12954 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
12955 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
12956 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
12957 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
12958 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
12959 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
12960 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
12961 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
12962
12963 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
12964 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
12965 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
12966 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
12967 program, you need:
12968
12969 @enumerate
12970 @item
12971 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
12972 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
12973 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
12974
12975 @item
12976 A C subroutine library to support your program's
12977 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
12978
12979 @item
12980 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
12981 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
12982 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
12983 documentation.
12984 @end enumerate
12985
12986 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
12987 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
12988 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
12989
12990 @table @emph
12991 @item On the host,
12992 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
12993 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
12994 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
12995
12996 @item On the target,
12997 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
12998 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
12999 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
13000
13001 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
13002 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
13003 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details.
13004 @end table
13005
13006 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
13007 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
13008 @sc{sparc} boards.
13009
13010 @cindex remote serial stub list
13011 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
13012
13013 @table @code
13014
13015 @item i386-stub.c
13016 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
13017 @cindex Intel
13018 @cindex i386
13019 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
13020
13021 @item m68k-stub.c
13022 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
13023 @cindex Motorola 680x0
13024 @cindex m680x0
13025 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
13026
13027 @item sh-stub.c
13028 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
13029 @cindex Renesas
13030 @cindex SH
13031 For Renesas SH architectures.
13032
13033 @item sparc-stub.c
13034 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
13035 @cindex Sparc
13036 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
13037
13038 @item sparcl-stub.c
13039 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
13040 @cindex Fujitsu
13041 @cindex SparcLite
13042 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
13043
13044 @end table
13045
13046 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
13047 recently added stubs.
13048
13049 @menu
13050 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
13051 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
13052 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
13053 @end menu
13054
13055 @node Stub Contents
13056 @subsection What the Stub Can Do for You
13057
13058 @cindex remote serial stub
13059 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
13060 subroutines:
13061
13062 @table @code
13063 @item set_debug_traps
13064 @findex set_debug_traps
13065 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
13066 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
13067 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly near the
13068 beginning of your program.
13069
13070 @item handle_exception
13071 @findex handle_exception
13072 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
13073 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
13074 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
13075 run when a trap is triggered.
13076
13077 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
13078 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
13079 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
13080 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
13081 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
13082 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
13083 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
13084 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
13085 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
13086 machine.
13087
13088 @item breakpoint
13089 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
13090 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
13091 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
13092 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
13093 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
13094 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
13095 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
13096 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
13097 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
13098 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
13099 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
13100
13101 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
13102 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
13103 start of your debugging session.
13104 @end table
13105
13106 @node Bootstrapping
13107 @subsection What You Must Do for the Stub
13108
13109 @cindex remote stub, support routines
13110 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
13111 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
13112 debugging target machine.
13113
13114 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
13115 serial port.
13116
13117 @table @code
13118 @item int getDebugChar()
13119 @findex getDebugChar
13120 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
13121 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
13122 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
13123
13124 @item void putDebugChar(int)
13125 @findex putDebugChar
13126 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
13127 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
13128 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
13129 @end table
13130
13131 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
13132 @cindex interrupting remote targets
13133 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
13134 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
13135 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
13136 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
13137 remote system to stop.
13138
13139 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
13140 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
13141 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
13142 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
13143
13144 Other routines you need to supply are:
13145
13146 @table @code
13147 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
13148 @findex exceptionHandler
13149 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
13150 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
13151 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
13152 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
13153 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
13154 @var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
13155 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
13156 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
13157 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
13158 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
13159 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
13160 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
13161 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
13162
13163 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
13164 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
13165 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
13166 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
13167 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
13168
13169 @item void flush_i_cache()
13170 @findex flush_i_cache
13171 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
13172 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
13173 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
13174
13175 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
13176 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
13177 @end table
13178
13179 @noindent
13180 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
13181
13182 @table @code
13183 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
13184 @findex memset
13185 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
13186 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
13187 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
13188 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
13189 @end table
13190
13191 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
13192 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
13193 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
13194 subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code.
13195
13196
13197 @node Debug Session
13198 @subsection Putting it All Together
13199
13200 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
13201 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
13202 steps.
13203
13204 @enumerate
13205 @item
13206 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
13207 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}):
13208 @display
13209 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
13210 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
13211 @end display
13212
13213 @item
13214 Insert these lines near the top of your program:
13215
13216 @smallexample
13217 set_debug_traps();
13218 breakpoint();
13219 @end smallexample
13220
13221 @item
13222 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
13223 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
13224
13225 @smallexample
13226 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
13227 @end smallexample
13228
13229 @noindent
13230 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
13231 function in your program, that function is called when
13232 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
13233 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
13234 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
13235
13236 @item
13237 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
13238 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
13239
13240 @item
13241 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
13242 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
13243
13244 @item
13245 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
13246 @c document that. FIXME.
13247 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
13248 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
13249
13250 @item
13251 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
13252 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
13253
13254 @end enumerate
13255
13256 @node Configurations
13257 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
13258
13259 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
13260 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
13261 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
13262
13263 There are three major categories of configurations: native
13264 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
13265 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
13266 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
13267 are quite different from each other.
13268
13269 @menu
13270 * Native::
13271 * Embedded OS::
13272 * Embedded Processors::
13273 * Architectures::
13274 @end menu
13275
13276 @node Native
13277 @section Native
13278
13279 This section describes details specific to particular native
13280 configurations.
13281
13282 @menu
13283 * HP-UX:: HP-UX
13284 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
13285 * SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
13286 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
13287 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
13288 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
13289 * Neutrino:: Features specific to QNX Neutrino
13290 @end menu
13291
13292 @node HP-UX
13293 @subsection HP-UX
13294
13295 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
13296 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
13297 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
13298
13299
13300 @node BSD libkvm Interface
13301 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
13302
13303 @cindex libkvm
13304 @cindex kernel memory image
13305 @cindex kernel crash dump
13306
13307 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
13308 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
13309 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
13310 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
13311 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
13312 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
13313 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
13314 @code{kvm} target:
13315
13316 @smallexample
13317 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
13318 @end smallexample
13319
13320 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
13321 argument:
13322
13323 @smallexample
13324 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
13325 @end smallexample
13326
13327 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
13328 available:
13329
13330 @table @code
13331 @kindex kvm
13332 @item kvm pcb
13333 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
13334
13335 @item kvm proc
13336 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
13337 modern FreeBSD systems.
13338 @end table
13339
13340 @node SVR4 Process Information
13341 @subsection SVR4 Process Information
13342 @cindex /proc
13343 @cindex examine process image
13344 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
13345
13346 Many versions of SVR4 and compatible systems provide a facility called
13347 @samp{/proc} that can be used to examine the image of a running
13348 process using file-system subroutines. If @value{GDBN} is configured
13349 for an operating system with this facility, the command @code{info
13350 proc} is available to report information about the process running
13351 your program, or about any process running on your system. @code{info
13352 proc} works only on SVR4 systems that include the @code{procfs} code.
13353 This includes, as of this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, OSF/1 (Digital
13354 Unix), Solaris, Irix, and Unixware, but not HP-UX, for example.
13355
13356 @table @code
13357 @kindex info proc
13358 @cindex process ID
13359 @item info proc
13360 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
13361 Summarize available information about any running process. If a
13362 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
13363 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
13364 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
13365 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
13366 executable file's absolute file name.
13367
13368 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
13369 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
13370 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
13371 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
13372 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
13373 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
13374
13375 @item info proc mappings
13376 @cindex memory address space mappings
13377 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in the program, with
13378 information on whether the process has read, write, or execute access
13379 rights to each range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, each memory range
13380 includes the object file which is mapped to that range, instead of the
13381 memory access rights to that range.
13382
13383 @item info proc stat
13384 @itemx info proc status
13385 @cindex process detailed status information
13386 These subcommands are specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. They show
13387 the process-related information, including the user ID and group ID;
13388 how many threads are there in the process; its virtual memory usage;
13389 the signals that are pending, blocked, and ignored; its TTY; its
13390 consumption of system and user time; its stack size; its @samp{nice}
13391 value; etc. For more information, see the @samp{proc} man page
13392 (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
13393
13394 @item info proc all
13395 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
13396 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
13397
13398 @ignore
13399 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
13400 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
13401 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
13402 @kindex info proc times
13403 @item info proc times
13404 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
13405 its children.
13406
13407 @kindex info proc id
13408 @item info proc id
13409 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
13410 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
13411 @end ignore
13412
13413 @item set procfs-trace
13414 @kindex set procfs-trace
13415 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
13416 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
13417
13418 @item show procfs-trace
13419 @kindex show procfs-trace
13420 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
13421
13422 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
13423 @kindex set procfs-file
13424 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
13425 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
13426 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
13427 standard output.
13428
13429 @item show procfs-file
13430 @kindex show procfs-file
13431 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
13432
13433 @item proc-trace-entry
13434 @itemx proc-trace-exit
13435 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
13436 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
13437 @kindex proc-trace-entry
13438 @kindex proc-trace-exit
13439 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
13440 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
13441 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
13442 from the @code{syscall} interface.
13443
13444 @item info pidlist
13445 @kindex info pidlist
13446 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
13447 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
13448 processes and all the threads within each process.
13449
13450 @item info meminfo
13451 @kindex info meminfo
13452 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
13453 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
13454 @end table
13455
13456 @node DJGPP Native
13457 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
13458 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
13459 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
13460 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
13461
13462 @cindex DPMI
13463 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
13464 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
13465 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
13466 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
13467
13468 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
13469 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
13470 subsection describes those commands.
13471
13472 @table @code
13473 @kindex info dos
13474 @item info dos
13475 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
13476 information about the target system and important OS structures.
13477
13478 @kindex sysinfo
13479 @cindex MS-DOS system info
13480 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
13481 @item info dos sysinfo
13482 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
13483 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
13484 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
13485
13486 @cindex GDT
13487 @cindex LDT
13488 @cindex IDT
13489 @cindex segment descriptor tables
13490 @cindex descriptor tables display
13491 @item info dos gdt
13492 @itemx info dos ldt
13493 @itemx info dos idt
13494 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
13495 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
13496 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
13497 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
13498 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
13499 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
13500 rights.
13501
13502 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
13503 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
13504 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
13505 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
13506 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
13507
13508 @cindex garbled pointers
13509 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
13510 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
13511 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
13512 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
13513 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
13514 debugged program's data segment:
13515
13516 @smallexample
13517 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
13518 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
13519 @end smallexample
13520
13521 @noindent
13522 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
13523 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
13524
13525 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
13526 @item info dos pde
13527 @itemx info dos pte
13528 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
13529 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
13530 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
13531 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
13532 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
13533 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
13534 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
13535 that is currently in use.
13536
13537 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
13538 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
13539 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
13540 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
13541 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
13542 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
13543 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
13544
13545 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
13546 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
13547 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
13548 controller.
13549
13550 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
13551
13552 @cindex physical address from linear address
13553 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
13554 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
13555 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
13556 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
13557 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
13558 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
13559 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
13560
13561 @smallexample
13562 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
13563 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
13564 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
13565 @end smallexample
13566
13567 @noindent
13568 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
13569 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
13570 attributes of that page.
13571
13572 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
13573 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
13574 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
13575 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
13576 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
13577 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
13578
13579 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
13580 transfer buffer:
13581
13582 @smallexample
13583 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
13584 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
13585 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
13586 @end smallexample
13587
13588 @noindent
13589 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
13590 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
13591 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
13592 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
13593 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
13594
13595 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
13596 @end table
13597
13598 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
13599 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
13600 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
13601 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
13602
13603 @table @code
13604 @kindex set com1base
13605 @kindex set com1irq
13606 @kindex set com2base
13607 @kindex set com2irq
13608 @kindex set com3base
13609 @kindex set com3irq
13610 @kindex set com4base
13611 @kindex set com4irq
13612 @item set com1base @var{addr}
13613 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
13614 port.
13615
13616 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
13617 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
13618 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
13619
13620 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
13621 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
13622 other 3 COM ports.
13623
13624 @kindex show com1base
13625 @kindex show com1irq
13626 @kindex show com2base
13627 @kindex show com2irq
13628 @kindex show com3base
13629 @kindex show com3irq
13630 @kindex show com4base
13631 @kindex show com4irq
13632 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
13633 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
13634 lines used by the COM ports.
13635
13636 @item info serial
13637 @kindex info serial
13638 @cindex DOS serial port status
13639 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
13640 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
13641 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
13642 counts of various errors encountered so far.
13643 @end table
13644
13645
13646 @node Cygwin Native
13647 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables
13648 @cindex MS Windows debugging
13649 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
13650 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
13651
13652 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
13653 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information. There are various
13654 additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in this section.
13655 Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is described in
13656 @ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}.
13657
13658 @table @code
13659 @kindex info w32
13660 @item info w32
13661 This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print
13662 information about the target system and important OS structures.
13663
13664 @item info w32 selector
13665 This command displays information returned by
13666 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
13667 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
13668 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
13669 Without argument, this command displays information
13670 about the six segment registers.
13671
13672 @kindex info dll
13673 @item info dll
13674 This is a Cygwin-specific alias of @code{info shared}.
13675
13676 @kindex dll-symbols
13677 @item dll-symbols
13678 This command loads symbols from a dll similarly to
13679 add-sym command but without the need to specify a base address.
13680
13681 @kindex set cygwin-exceptions
13682 @cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
13683 @cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
13684 @item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
13685 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
13686 happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
13687 @value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
13688 exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
13689 ``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
13690 Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
13691 @value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
13692
13693 @kindex show cygwin-exceptions
13694 @item show cygwin-exceptions
13695 Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
13696 inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
13697
13698 @kindex set new-console
13699 @item set new-console @var{mode}
13700 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
13701 be started in a new console on next start.
13702 If @var{mode} is @code{off}i, the debuggee will
13703 be started in the same console as the debugger.
13704
13705 @kindex show new-console
13706 @item show new-console
13707 Displays whether a new console is used
13708 when the debuggee is started.
13709
13710 @kindex set new-group
13711 @item set new-group @var{mode}
13712 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
13713 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
13714 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
13715 @samp{Ctrl-C}.
13716
13717 @kindex show new-group
13718 @item show new-group
13719 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
13720
13721 @kindex set debugevents
13722 @item set debugevents
13723 This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
13724 to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
13725 signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
13726 unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
13727 Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
13728
13729 @kindex set debugexec
13730 @item set debugexec
13731 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
13732 (such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
13733
13734 @kindex set debugexceptions
13735 @item set debugexceptions
13736 This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
13737 debuggee seen by the debugger.
13738
13739 @kindex set debugmemory
13740 @item set debugmemory
13741 This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
13742 and writes by the debugger.
13743
13744 @kindex set shell
13745 @item set shell
13746 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
13747 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
13748
13749 @kindex show shell
13750 @item show shell
13751 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
13752
13753 @end table
13754
13755 @menu
13756 * Non-debug DLL Symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
13757 @end menu
13758
13759 @node Non-debug DLL Symbols
13760 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols
13761 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
13762 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
13763
13764 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
13765 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
13766 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
13767 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
13768 information contained in the DLL's export table. This section
13769 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
13770 ``minimal symbols''.
13771
13772 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
13773 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
13774 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
13775 program run once to completion. It is also possible to force
13776 @value{GDBN} to load a particular DLL before starting the executable ---
13777 see the shared library information in @ref{Files}, or the
13778 @code{dll-symbols} command in @ref{Cygwin Native}. Currently,
13779 explicitly loading symbols from a DLL with no debugging information will
13780 cause the symbol names to be duplicated in @value{GDBN}'s lookup table,
13781 which may adversely affect symbol lookup performance.
13782
13783 @subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes
13784
13785 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
13786 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
13787 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
13788 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
13789 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
13790 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
13791 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
13792 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
13793 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
13794
13795 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
13796 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
13797 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
13798 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
13799 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols}
13800 (@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
13801
13802 @smallexample
13803 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
13804 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
13805
13806 Non-debugging symbols:
13807 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
13808 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
13809 @end smallexample
13810
13811 @smallexample
13812 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
13813 All functions matching regular expression "!":
13814
13815 Non-debugging symbols:
13816 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
13817 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
13818 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
13819 [etc...]
13820 @end smallexample
13821
13822 @subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols
13823
13824 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
13825 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
13826 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
13827 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
13828 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
13829 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
13830 a function within a DLL without a running program.
13831
13832 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
13833 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
13834 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
13835 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
13836 problem:
13837
13838 @smallexample
13839 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
13840 $1 = 268572168
13841 @end smallexample
13842
13843 @smallexample
13844 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
13845 0x10021610: "\230y\""
13846 @end smallexample
13847
13848 And two possible solutions:
13849
13850 @smallexample
13851 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
13852 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
13853 @end smallexample
13854
13855 @smallexample
13856 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
13857 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
13858 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
13859 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
13860 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
13861 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
13862 @end smallexample
13863
13864 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
13865 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
13866 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
13867 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
13868 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
13869
13870 @smallexample
13871 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
13872 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
13873 @end smallexample
13874
13875 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
13876 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
13877 safe.
13878
13879 @node Hurd Native
13880 @subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems
13881 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
13882
13883 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
13884 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
13885
13886 @table @code
13887 @item set signals
13888 @itemx set sigs
13889 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
13890 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
13891 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
13892 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
13893 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
13894 @code{signals}.
13895
13896 @item show signals
13897 @itemx show sigs
13898 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
13899 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
13900 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
13901
13902 @item set signal-thread
13903 @itemx set sigthread
13904 @kindex set signal-thread
13905 @kindex set sigthread
13906 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
13907 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
13908 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
13909 signal-thread}.
13910
13911 @item show signal-thread
13912 @itemx show sigthread
13913 @kindex show signal-thread
13914 @kindex show sigthread
13915 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
13916 delivered a signal.
13917
13918 @item set stopped
13919 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
13920 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
13921 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
13922 continued by delivering a signal to it.
13923
13924 @item show stopped
13925 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
13926 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
13927 stopped.
13928
13929 @item set exceptions
13930 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
13931 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
13932 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
13933 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
13934 trapping on.
13935
13936 @item show exceptions
13937 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
13938 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
13939
13940 @item set task pause
13941 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
13942 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
13943 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
13944 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
13945 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
13946 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
13947 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
13948 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
13949 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
13950
13951 @item show task pause
13952 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
13953 Show the current state of task suspension.
13954
13955 @item set task detach-suspend-count
13956 @cindex task suspend count
13957 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13958 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
13959 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
13960
13961 @item show task detach-suspend-count
13962 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
13963
13964 @item set task exception-port
13965 @itemx set task excp
13966 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13967 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
13968 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
13969 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
13970
13971 @item set noninvasive
13972 @cindex noninvasive task options
13973 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
13974 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
13975 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
13976 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
13977
13978 @item info send-rights
13979 @itemx info receive-rights
13980 @itemx info port-rights
13981 @itemx info port-sets
13982 @itemx info dead-names
13983 @itemx info ports
13984 @itemx info psets
13985 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13986 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13987 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13988 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13989 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13990 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
13991 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
13992 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
13993 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
13994
13995 @item set thread pause
13996 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
13997 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13998 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
13999 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
14000 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
14001 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
14002 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
14003 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
14004 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
14005 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
14006 only the current thread.
14007
14008 @item show thread pause
14009 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
14010 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
14011
14012 @item set thread run
14013 This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
14014
14015 @item show thread run
14016 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
14017
14018 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
14019 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14020 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14021 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
14022 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
14023 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
14024 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
14025
14026 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
14027 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
14028 detaching.
14029
14030 @item set thread exception-port
14031 @itemx set thread excp
14032 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
14033 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
14034 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
14035
14036 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
14037 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
14038 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
14039 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
14040
14041 @item set thread default
14042 @itemx show thread default
14043 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14044 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
14045 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
14046 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
14047 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
14048 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
14049 the non-default commands.
14050 @end table
14051
14052
14053 @node Neutrino
14054 @subsection QNX Neutrino
14055 @cindex QNX Neutrino
14056
14057 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the QNX
14058 Neutrino target:
14059
14060 @table @code
14061 @item set debug nto-debug
14062 @kindex set debug nto-debug
14063 When set to on, enables debugging messages specific to the QNX
14064 Neutrino support.
14065
14066 @item show debug nto-debug
14067 @kindex show debug nto-debug
14068 Show the current state of QNX Neutrino messages.
14069 @end table
14070
14071
14072 @node Embedded OS
14073 @section Embedded Operating Systems
14074
14075 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
14076 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
14077 architectures.
14078
14079 @menu
14080 * VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
14081 @end menu
14082
14083 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
14084 various real-time operating systems.
14085
14086 @node VxWorks
14087 @subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
14088
14089 @cindex VxWorks
14090
14091 @table @code
14092
14093 @kindex target vxworks
14094 @item target vxworks @var{machinename}
14095 A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
14096 is the target system's machine name or IP address.
14097
14098 @end table
14099
14100 On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
14101 current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
14102
14103 @value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
14104 VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
14105 the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
14106 both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
14107 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
14108 installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
14109 @value{GDBN} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
14110
14111 @table @code
14112 @item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
14113 @kindex vxworks-timeout
14114 All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
14115 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
14116 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
14117 your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
14118 of a thin network line.
14119 @end table
14120
14121 The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
14122 this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
14123 procedures.
14124
14125 @findex INCLUDE_RDB
14126 To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
14127 to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
14128 library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
14129 VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
14130 kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
14131 source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
14132 information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
14133 manual.
14134 @c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
14135
14136 Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
14137 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
14138 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or
14139 @code{vxgdb}, depending on your installation).
14140
14141 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
14142
14143 @smallexample
14144 (vxgdb)
14145 @end smallexample
14146
14147 @menu
14148 * VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
14149 * VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
14150 * VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
14151 @end menu
14152
14153 @node VxWorks Connection
14154 @subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
14155
14156 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
14157 network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
14158
14159 @smallexample
14160 (vxgdb) target vxworks tt
14161 @end smallexample
14162
14163 @need 750
14164 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
14165
14166 @smallexample
14167 Attaching remote machine across net...
14168 Connected to tt.
14169 @end smallexample
14170
14171 @need 1000
14172 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
14173 loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
14174 these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
14175 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}); if it fails
14176 to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
14177
14178 @smallexample
14179 prog.o: No such file or directory.
14180 @end smallexample
14181
14182 When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
14183 the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
14184 command again.
14185
14186 @node VxWorks Download
14187 @subsubsection VxWorks Download
14188
14189 @cindex download to VxWorks
14190 If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
14191 object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
14192 @code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
14193 incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
14194 command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
14195 to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
14196 table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
14197 the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
14198 filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
14199 Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
14200 to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
14201 the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
14202 @file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
14203 and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
14204 program, type this on VxWorks:
14205
14206 @smallexample
14207 -> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
14208 @end smallexample
14209
14210 @noindent
14211 Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
14212
14213 @smallexample
14214 (vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
14215 (vxgdb) load prog.o
14216 @end smallexample
14217
14218 @value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
14219
14220 @smallexample
14221 Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
14222 @end smallexample
14223
14224 You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
14225 after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
14226 this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
14227 auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
14228 history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
14229 debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
14230 table.)
14231
14232 @node VxWorks Attach
14233 @subsubsection Running Tasks
14234
14235 @cindex running VxWorks tasks
14236 You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
14237 follows:
14238
14239 @smallexample
14240 (vxgdb) attach @var{task}
14241 @end smallexample
14242
14243 @noindent
14244 where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
14245 or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
14246 the time of attachment.
14247
14248 @node Embedded Processors
14249 @section Embedded Processors
14250
14251 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
14252 configurations.
14253
14254 @cindex send command to simulator
14255 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
14256 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
14257
14258 @table @code
14259 @item sim @var{command}
14260 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
14261 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
14262 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
14263 acceptable commands.
14264 @end table
14265
14266
14267 @menu
14268 * ARM:: ARM RDI
14269 * M32R/D:: Renesas M32R/D
14270 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
14271 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
14272 * OpenRISC 1000:: OpenRisc 1000
14273 * PA:: HP PA Embedded
14274 * PowerPC:: PowerPC
14275 * Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
14276 * Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
14277 * Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
14278 * AVR:: Atmel AVR
14279 * CRIS:: CRIS
14280 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
14281 @end menu
14282
14283 @node ARM
14284 @subsection ARM
14285 @cindex ARM RDI
14286
14287 @table @code
14288 @kindex target rdi
14289 @item target rdi @var{dev}
14290 ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
14291 use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
14292 monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
14293
14294 @kindex target rdp
14295 @item target rdp @var{dev}
14296 ARM Demon monitor.
14297
14298 @end table
14299
14300 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
14301
14302 @table @code
14303 @item set arm disassembler
14304 @kindex set arm
14305 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
14306 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
14307
14308 @item show arm disassembler
14309 @kindex show arm
14310 Show the current disassembly style.
14311
14312 @item set arm apcs32
14313 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
14314 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
14315
14316 @item show arm apcs32
14317 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
14318
14319 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
14320 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
14321 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
14322
14323 @table @code
14324 @item auto
14325 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
14326 @item softfpa
14327 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
14328 processors.
14329 @item fpa
14330 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
14331 @item softvfp
14332 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
14333 @item vfp
14334 VFP co-processor.
14335 @end table
14336
14337 @item show arm fpu
14338 Show the current type of the FPU.
14339
14340 @item set arm abi
14341 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
14342
14343 @item show arm abi
14344 Show the currently used ABI.
14345
14346 @item set debug arm
14347 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
14348 target support subsystem.
14349
14350 @item show debug arm
14351 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
14352 @end table
14353
14354 The following commands are available when an ARM target is debugged
14355 using the RDI interface:
14356
14357 @table @code
14358 @item rdilogfile @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
14359 @kindex rdilogfile
14360 @cindex ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) logging
14361 Set the filename for the ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) packet log.
14362 With an argument, sets the log file to the specified @var{file}. With
14363 no argument, show the current log file name. The default log file is
14364 @file{rdi.log}.
14365
14366 @item rdilogenable @r{[}@var{arg}@r{]}
14367 @kindex rdilogenable
14368 Control logging of ADP packets. With an argument of 1 or @code{"yes"}
14369 enables logging, with an argument 0 or @code{"no"} disables it. With
14370 no arguments displays the current setting. When logging is enabled,
14371 ADP packets exchanged between @value{GDBN} and the RDI target device
14372 are logged to a file.
14373
14374 @item set rdiromatzero
14375 @kindex set rdiromatzero
14376 @cindex ROM at zero address, RDI
14377 Tell @value{GDBN} whether the target has ROM at address 0. If on,
14378 vector catching is disabled, so that zero address can be used. If off
14379 (the default), vector catching is enabled. For this command to take
14380 effect, it needs to be invoked prior to the @code{target rdi} command.
14381
14382 @item show rdiromatzero
14383 @kindex show rdiromatzero
14384 Show the current setting of ROM at zero address.
14385
14386 @item set rdiheartbeat
14387 @kindex set rdiheartbeat
14388 @cindex RDI heartbeat
14389 Enable or disable RDI heartbeat packets. It is not recommended to
14390 turn on this option, since it confuses ARM and EPI JTAG interface, as
14391 well as the Angel monitor.
14392
14393 @item show rdiheartbeat
14394 @kindex show rdiheartbeat
14395 Show the setting of RDI heartbeat packets.
14396 @end table
14397
14398
14399 @node M32R/D
14400 @subsection Renesas M32R/D and M32R/SDI
14401
14402 @table @code
14403 @kindex target m32r
14404 @item target m32r @var{dev}
14405 Renesas M32R/D ROM monitor.
14406
14407 @kindex target m32rsdi
14408 @item target m32rsdi @var{dev}
14409 Renesas M32R SDI server, connected via parallel port to the board.
14410 @end table
14411
14412 The following @value{GDBN} commands are specific to the M32R monitor:
14413
14414 @table @code
14415 @item set download-path @var{path}
14416 @kindex set download-path
14417 @cindex find downloadable @sc{srec} files (M32R)
14418 Set the default path for finding downloadable @sc{srec} files.
14419
14420 @item show download-path
14421 @kindex show download-path
14422 Show the default path for downloadable @sc{srec} files.
14423
14424 @item set board-address @var{addr}
14425 @kindex set board-address
14426 @cindex M32-EVA target board address
14427 Set the IP address for the M32R-EVA target board.
14428
14429 @item show board-address
14430 @kindex show board-address
14431 Show the current IP address of the target board.
14432
14433 @item set server-address @var{addr}
14434 @kindex set server-address
14435 @cindex download server address (M32R)
14436 Set the IP address for the download server, which is the @value{GDBN}'s
14437 host machine.
14438
14439 @item show server-address
14440 @kindex show server-address
14441 Display the IP address of the download server.
14442
14443 @item upload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
14444 @kindex upload@r{, M32R}
14445 Upload the specified @sc{srec} @var{file} via the monitor's Ethernet
14446 upload capability. If no @var{file} argument is given, the current
14447 executable file is uploaded.
14448
14449 @item tload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
14450 @kindex tload@r{, M32R}
14451 Test the @code{upload} command.
14452 @end table
14453
14454 The following commands are available for M32R/SDI:
14455
14456 @table @code
14457 @item sdireset
14458 @kindex sdireset
14459 @cindex reset SDI connection, M32R
14460 This command resets the SDI connection.
14461
14462 @item sdistatus
14463 @kindex sdistatus
14464 This command shows the SDI connection status.
14465
14466 @item debug_chaos
14467 @kindex debug_chaos
14468 @cindex M32R/Chaos debugging
14469 Instructs the remote that M32R/Chaos debugging is to be used.
14470
14471 @item use_debug_dma
14472 @kindex use_debug_dma
14473 Instructs the remote to use the DEBUG_DMA method of accessing memory.
14474
14475 @item use_mon_code
14476 @kindex use_mon_code
14477 Instructs the remote to use the MON_CODE method of accessing memory.
14478
14479 @item use_ib_break
14480 @kindex use_ib_break
14481 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by IB break.
14482
14483 @item use_dbt_break
14484 @kindex use_dbt_break
14485 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by DBT.
14486 @end table
14487
14488 @node M68K
14489 @subsection M68k
14490
14491 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and a
14492 target command for the following ROM monitor.
14493
14494 @table @code
14495
14496 @kindex target dbug
14497 @item target dbug @var{dev}
14498 dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
14499
14500 @end table
14501
14502 @node MIPS Embedded
14503 @subsection MIPS Embedded
14504
14505 @cindex MIPS boards
14506 @value{GDBN} can use the MIPS remote debugging protocol to talk to a
14507 MIPS board attached to a serial line. This is available when
14508 you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.
14509
14510 @need 1000
14511 Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
14512
14513 @table @code
14514 @item target mips @var{port}
14515 @kindex target mips @var{port}
14516 To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
14517 name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
14518 command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
14519 the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
14520 been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
14521 download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
14522
14523 For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
14524 port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
14525 debugger:
14526
14527 @smallexample
14528 host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
14529 @value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
14530 (@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
14531 (@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
14532 (@value{GDBP}) run
14533 @end smallexample
14534
14535 @item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
14536 On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
14537 connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
14538 concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
14539 @samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
14540
14541 @item target pmon @var{port}
14542 @kindex target pmon @var{port}
14543 PMON ROM monitor.
14544
14545 @item target ddb @var{port}
14546 @kindex target ddb @var{port}
14547 NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
14548
14549 @item target lsi @var{port}
14550 @kindex target lsi @var{port}
14551 LSI variant of PMON.
14552
14553 @kindex target r3900
14554 @item target r3900 @var{dev}
14555 Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
14556
14557 @kindex target array
14558 @item target array @var{dev}
14559 Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
14560
14561 @end table
14562
14563
14564 @noindent
14565 @value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for MIPS targets:
14566
14567 @table @code
14568 @item set mipsfpu double
14569 @itemx set mipsfpu single
14570 @itemx set mipsfpu none
14571 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
14572 @itemx show mipsfpu
14573 @kindex set mipsfpu
14574 @kindex show mipsfpu
14575 @cindex MIPS remote floating point
14576 @cindex floating point, MIPS remote
14577 If your target board does not support the MIPS floating point
14578 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
14579 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
14580 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
14581 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
14582 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
14583 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
14584 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
14585 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
14586 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
14587 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
14588
14589 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
14590 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
14591 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
14592
14593 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
14594 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
14595
14596 @item set timeout @var{seconds}
14597 @itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
14598 @itemx show timeout
14599 @itemx show retransmit-timeout
14600 @cindex @code{timeout}, MIPS protocol
14601 @cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, MIPS protocol
14602 @kindex set timeout
14603 @kindex show timeout
14604 @kindex set retransmit-timeout
14605 @kindex show retransmit-timeout
14606 You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the MIPS
14607 remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
14608 default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
14609 waiting for an acknowledgement of a packet with the @code{set
14610 retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
14611 You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
14612 retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
14613 @value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.)
14614
14615 The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
14616 is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
14617 forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
14618 to run before stopping.
14619
14620 @item set syn-garbage-limit @var{num}
14621 @kindex set syn-garbage-limit@r{, MIPS remote}
14622 @cindex synchronize with remote MIPS target
14623 Limit the maximum number of characters @value{GDBN} should ignore when
14624 it tries to synchronize with the remote target. The default is 10
14625 characters. Setting the limit to -1 means there's no limit.
14626
14627 @item show syn-garbage-limit
14628 @kindex show syn-garbage-limit@r{, MIPS remote}
14629 Show the current limit on the number of characters to ignore when
14630 trying to synchronize with the remote system.
14631
14632 @item set monitor-prompt @var{prompt}
14633 @kindex set monitor-prompt@r{, MIPS remote}
14634 @cindex remote monitor prompt
14635 Tell @value{GDBN} to expect the specified @var{prompt} string from the
14636 remote monitor. The default depends on the target:
14637 @table @asis
14638 @item pmon target
14639 @samp{PMON}
14640 @item ddb target
14641 @samp{NEC010}
14642 @item lsi target
14643 @samp{PMON>}
14644 @end table
14645
14646 @item show monitor-prompt
14647 @kindex show monitor-prompt@r{, MIPS remote}
14648 Show the current strings @value{GDBN} expects as the prompt from the
14649 remote monitor.
14650
14651 @item set monitor-warnings
14652 @kindex set monitor-warnings@r{, MIPS remote}
14653 Enable or disable monitor warnings about hardware breakpoints. This
14654 has effect only for the @code{lsi} target. When on, @value{GDBN} will
14655 display warning messages whose codes are returned by the @code{lsi}
14656 PMON monitor for breakpoint commands.
14657
14658 @item show monitor-warnings
14659 @kindex show monitor-warnings@r{, MIPS remote}
14660 Show the current setting of printing monitor warnings.
14661
14662 @item pmon @var{command}
14663 @kindex pmon@r{, MIPS remote}
14664 @cindex send PMON command
14665 This command allows sending an arbitrary @var{command} string to the
14666 monitor. The monitor must be in debug mode for this to work.
14667 @end table
14668
14669 @node OpenRISC 1000
14670 @subsection OpenRISC 1000
14671 @cindex OpenRISC 1000
14672
14673 @cindex or1k boards
14674 See OR1k Architecture document (@uref{www.opencores.org}) for more information
14675 about platform and commands.
14676
14677 @table @code
14678
14679 @kindex target jtag
14680 @item target jtag jtag://@var{host}:@var{port}
14681
14682 Connects to remote JTAG server.
14683 JTAG remote server can be either an or1ksim or JTAG server,
14684 connected via parallel port to the board.
14685
14686 Example: @code{target jtag jtag://localhost:9999}
14687
14688 @kindex or1ksim
14689 @item or1ksim @var{command}
14690 If connected to @code{or1ksim} OpenRISC 1000 Architectural
14691 Simulator, proprietary commands can be executed.
14692
14693 @kindex info or1k spr
14694 @item info or1k spr
14695 Displays spr groups.
14696
14697 @item info or1k spr @var{group}
14698 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno}
14699 Displays register names in selected group.
14700
14701 @item info or1k spr @var{group} @var{register}
14702 @itemx info or1k spr @var{register}
14703 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno}
14704 @itemx info or1k spr @var{registerno}
14705 Shows information about specified spr register.
14706
14707 @kindex spr
14708 @item spr @var{group} @var{register} @var{value}
14709 @itemx spr @var{register @var{value}}
14710 @itemx spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno @var{value}}
14711 @itemx spr @var{registerno @var{value}}
14712 Writes @var{value} to specified spr register.
14713 @end table
14714
14715 Some implementations of OpenRISC 1000 Architecture also have hardware trace.
14716 It is very similar to @value{GDBN} trace, except it does not interfere with normal
14717 program execution and is thus much faster. Hardware breakpoints/watchpoint
14718 triggers can be set using:
14719 @table @code
14720 @item $LEA/$LDATA
14721 Load effective address/data
14722 @item $SEA/$SDATA
14723 Store effective address/data
14724 @item $AEA/$ADATA
14725 Access effective address ($SEA or $LEA) or data ($SDATA/$LDATA)
14726 @item $FETCH
14727 Fetch data
14728 @end table
14729
14730 When triggered, it can capture low level data, like: @code{PC}, @code{LSEA},
14731 @code{LDATA}, @code{SDATA}, @code{READSPR}, @code{WRITESPR}, @code{INSTR}.
14732
14733 @code{htrace} commands:
14734 @cindex OpenRISC 1000 htrace
14735 @table @code
14736 @kindex hwatch
14737 @item hwatch @var{conditional}
14738 Set hardware watchpoint on combination of Load/Store Effective Address(es)
14739 or Data. For example:
14740
14741 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
14742
14743 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
14744
14745 @kindex htrace
14746 @item htrace info
14747 Display information about current HW trace configuration.
14748
14749 @item htrace trigger @var{conditional}
14750 Set starting criteria for HW trace.
14751
14752 @item htrace qualifier @var{conditional}
14753 Set acquisition qualifier for HW trace.
14754
14755 @item htrace stop @var{conditional}
14756 Set HW trace stopping criteria.
14757
14758 @item htrace record [@var{data}]*
14759 Selects the data to be recorded, when qualifier is met and HW trace was
14760 triggered.
14761
14762 @item htrace enable
14763 @itemx htrace disable
14764 Enables/disables the HW trace.
14765
14766 @item htrace rewind [@var{filename}]
14767 Clears currently recorded trace data.
14768
14769 If filename is specified, new trace file is made and any newly collected data
14770 will be written there.
14771
14772 @item htrace print [@var{start} [@var{len}]]
14773 Prints trace buffer, using current record configuration.
14774
14775 @item htrace mode continuous
14776 Set continuous trace mode.
14777
14778 @item htrace mode suspend
14779 Set suspend trace mode.
14780
14781 @end table
14782
14783 @node PowerPC
14784 @subsection PowerPC
14785
14786 @table @code
14787 @kindex target dink32
14788 @item target dink32 @var{dev}
14789 DINK32 ROM monitor.
14790
14791 @kindex target ppcbug
14792 @item target ppcbug @var{dev}
14793 @kindex target ppcbug1
14794 @item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
14795 PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
14796
14797 @kindex target sds
14798 @item target sds @var{dev}
14799 SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
14800 @end table
14801
14802 @cindex SDS protocol
14803 The following commands specific to the SDS protocol are supported
14804 by@value{GDBN}:
14805
14806 @table @code
14807 @item set sdstimeout @var{nsec}
14808 @kindex set sdstimeout
14809 Set the timeout for SDS protocol reads to be @var{nsec} seconds. The
14810 default is 2 seconds.
14811
14812 @item show sdstimeout
14813 @kindex show sdstimeout
14814 Show the current value of the SDS timeout.
14815
14816 @item sds @var{command}
14817 @kindex sds@r{, a command}
14818 Send the specified @var{command} string to the SDS monitor.
14819 @end table
14820
14821
14822 @node PA
14823 @subsection HP PA Embedded
14824
14825 @table @code
14826
14827 @kindex target op50n
14828 @item target op50n @var{dev}
14829 OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
14830
14831 @kindex target w89k
14832 @item target w89k @var{dev}
14833 W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
14834
14835 @end table
14836
14837 @node Sparclet
14838 @subsection Tsqware Sparclet
14839
14840 @cindex Sparclet
14841
14842 @value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
14843 Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
14844 @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
14845 both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
14846 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
14847
14848 @table @code
14849 @item remotetimeout @var{args}
14850 @kindex remotetimeout
14851 @value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
14852 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
14853 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
14854 @end table
14855
14856 @cindex compiling, on Sparclet
14857 When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
14858 information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
14859 load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
14860 @samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
14861
14862 @smallexample
14863 sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
14864 @end smallexample
14865
14866 You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
14867
14868 @smallexample
14869 sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
14870 @end smallexample
14871
14872 @cindex running, on Sparclet
14873 Once you have set
14874 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
14875 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
14876 (or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
14877
14878 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
14879
14880 @smallexample
14881 (gdbslet)
14882 @end smallexample
14883
14884 @menu
14885 * Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
14886 * Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
14887 * Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
14888 * Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
14889 @end menu
14890
14891 @node Sparclet File
14892 @subsubsection Setting File to Debug
14893
14894 The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
14895
14896 @smallexample
14897 (gdbslet) file prog
14898 @end smallexample
14899
14900 @need 1000
14901 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
14902 @value{GDBN} locates
14903 the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
14904 path.
14905 If the file was compiled with debug information (option @samp{-g}), source
14906 files will be searched as well.
14907 @value{GDBN} locates
14908 the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
14909 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}).
14910 If it fails
14911 to find a file, it displays a message such as:
14912
14913 @smallexample
14914 prog: No such file or directory.
14915 @end smallexample
14916
14917 When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
14918 the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
14919 @code{target} command again.
14920
14921 @node Sparclet Connection
14922 @subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
14923
14924 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
14925 To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
14926
14927 @smallexample
14928 (gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
14929 Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
14930 main () at ../prog.c:3
14931 @end smallexample
14932
14933 @need 750
14934 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
14935
14936 @smallexample
14937 Connected to ttya.
14938 @end smallexample
14939
14940 @node Sparclet Download
14941 @subsubsection Sparclet Download
14942
14943 @cindex download to Sparclet
14944 Once connected to the Sparclet target,
14945 you can use the @value{GDBN}
14946 @code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
14947 The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
14948 command.
14949 Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
14950 address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
14951 offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
14952 of each of the file's sections.
14953 For instance, if the program
14954 @file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
14955 and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
14956
14957 @smallexample
14958 (gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
14959 Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
14960 @end smallexample
14961
14962 If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
14963 to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
14964 to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
14965
14966 @node Sparclet Execution
14967 @subsubsection Running and Debugging
14968
14969 @cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
14970 You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
14971 commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
14972 manual for the list of commands.
14973
14974 @smallexample
14975 (gdbslet) b main
14976 Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
14977 (gdbslet) run
14978 Starting program: prog
14979 Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
14980 3 char *symarg = 0;
14981 (gdbslet) step
14982 4 char *execarg = "hello!";
14983 (gdbslet)
14984 @end smallexample
14985
14986 @node Sparclite
14987 @subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
14988
14989 @table @code
14990
14991 @kindex target sparclite
14992 @item target sparclite @var{dev}
14993 Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
14994 You must use an additional command to debug the program.
14995 For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
14996 remote protocol.
14997
14998 @end table
14999
15000 @node Z8000
15001 @subsection Zilog Z8000
15002
15003 @cindex Z8000
15004 @cindex simulator, Z8000
15005 @cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
15006
15007 When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
15008 a Z8000 simulator.
15009
15010 For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
15011 unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
15012 segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
15013 appropriate by inspecting the object code.
15014
15015 @table @code
15016 @item target sim @var{args}
15017 @kindex sim
15018 @kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
15019 Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
15020 options, specify them via @var{args}.
15021 @end table
15022
15023 @noindent
15024 After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
15025 CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
15026 @code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
15027 to run your program, and so on.
15028
15029 As well as making available all the usual machine registers
15030 (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
15031 additional items of information as specially named registers:
15032
15033 @table @code
15034
15035 @item cycles
15036 Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
15037
15038 @item insts
15039 Counts instructions run in the simulator.
15040
15041 @item time
15042 Execution time in 60ths of a second.
15043
15044 @end table
15045
15046 You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
15047 conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
15048 conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
15049 simulated clock ticks.
15050
15051 @node AVR
15052 @subsection Atmel AVR
15053 @cindex AVR
15054
15055 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
15056 following AVR-specific commands:
15057
15058 @table @code
15059 @item info io_registers
15060 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
15061 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
15062 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
15063 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
15064 @end table
15065
15066 @node CRIS
15067 @subsection CRIS
15068 @cindex CRIS
15069
15070 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
15071 following CRIS-specific commands:
15072
15073 @table @code
15074 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
15075 @cindex CRIS version
15076 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
15077 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
15078 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
15079
15080 @item show cris-version
15081 Show the current CRIS version.
15082
15083 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
15084 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
15085 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
15086 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
15087 @code{R59}.
15088
15089 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
15090 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
15091
15092 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
15093 @cindex CRIS mode
15094 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
15095 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
15096 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
15097
15098 @item show cris-mode
15099 Show the current CRIS mode.
15100 @end table
15101
15102 @node Super-H
15103 @subsection Renesas Super-H
15104 @cindex Super-H
15105
15106 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
15107 commands:
15108
15109 @table @code
15110 @item regs
15111 @kindex regs@r{, Super-H}
15112 Show the values of all Super-H registers.
15113 @end table
15114
15115
15116 @node Architectures
15117 @section Architectures
15118
15119 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
15120 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
15121
15122 @menu
15123 * i386::
15124 * A29K::
15125 * Alpha::
15126 * MIPS::
15127 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
15128 * SPU:: Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
15129 @end menu
15130
15131 @node i386
15132 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues
15133
15134 @table @code
15135 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
15136 @kindex set struct-convention
15137 @cindex struct return convention
15138 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
15139 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
15140 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
15141 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
15142 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
15143 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
15144 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
15145 be returned in a register.
15146
15147 @item show struct-convention
15148 @kindex show struct-convention
15149 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
15150 from functions.
15151 @end table
15152
15153 @node A29K
15154 @subsection A29K
15155
15156 @table @code
15157
15158 @kindex set rstack_high_address
15159 @cindex AMD 29K register stack
15160 @cindex register stack, AMD29K
15161 @item set rstack_high_address @var{address}
15162 On AMD 29000 family processors, registers are saved in a separate
15163 @dfn{register stack}. There is no way for @value{GDBN} to determine the
15164 extent of this stack. Normally, @value{GDBN} just assumes that the
15165 stack is ``large enough''. This may result in @value{GDBN} referencing
15166 memory locations that do not exist. If necessary, you can get around
15167 this problem by specifying the ending address of the register stack with
15168 the @code{set rstack_high_address} command. The argument should be an
15169 address, which you probably want to precede with @samp{0x} to specify in
15170 hexadecimal.
15171
15172 @kindex show rstack_high_address
15173 @item show rstack_high_address
15174 Display the current limit of the register stack, on AMD 29000 family
15175 processors.
15176
15177 @end table
15178
15179 @node Alpha
15180 @subsection Alpha
15181
15182 See the following section.
15183
15184 @node MIPS
15185 @subsection MIPS
15186
15187 @cindex stack on Alpha
15188 @cindex stack on MIPS
15189 @cindex Alpha stack
15190 @cindex MIPS stack
15191 Alpha- and MIPS-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
15192 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
15193 find the beginning of a function.
15194
15195 @cindex response time, MIPS debugging
15196 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
15197 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
15198 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
15199 commands:
15200
15201 @table @code
15202 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, MIPS)
15203 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
15204 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
15205 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
15206 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
15207 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
15208 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
15209 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
15210
15211 @item show heuristic-fence-post
15212 Display the current limit.
15213 @end table
15214
15215 @noindent
15216 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
15217 for debugging programs on Alpha or MIPS processors.
15218
15219 Several MIPS-specific commands are available when debugging MIPS
15220 programs:
15221
15222 @table @code
15223 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
15224 @kindex set mips abi
15225 @cindex set ABI for MIPS
15226 Tell @value{GDBN} which MIPS ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
15227 values of @var{arg} are:
15228
15229 @table @samp
15230 @item auto
15231 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
15232 default).
15233 @item o32
15234 @item o64
15235 @item n32
15236 @item n64
15237 @item eabi32
15238 @item eabi64
15239 @item auto
15240 @end table
15241
15242 @item show mips abi
15243 @kindex show mips abi
15244 Show the MIPS ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
15245
15246 @item set mipsfpu
15247 @itemx show mipsfpu
15248 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
15249
15250 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
15251 @kindex set mips mask-address
15252 @cindex MIPS addresses, masking
15253 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
15254 MIPS addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
15255 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
15256 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
15257
15258 @item show mips mask-address
15259 @kindex show mips mask-address
15260 Show whether the upper 32 bits of MIPS addresses are masked off or
15261 not.
15262
15263 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
15264 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
15265 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit MIPS targets that
15266 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old MIPS 64 target
15267 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
15268 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
15269
15270 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
15271 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
15272 Show the current setting of compatibility with older MIPS 64 targets.
15273
15274 @item set debug mips
15275 @kindex set debug mips
15276 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the MIPS-specific
15277 target code in @value{GDBN}.
15278
15279 @item show debug mips
15280 @kindex show debug mips
15281 Show the current setting of MIPS debugging messages.
15282 @end table
15283
15284
15285 @node HPPA
15286 @subsection HPPA
15287 @cindex HPPA support
15288
15289 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the
15290 following special commands:
15291
15292 @table @code
15293 @item set debug hppa
15294 @kindex set debug hppa
15295 This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging
15296 messages are to be displayed.
15297
15298 @item show debug hppa
15299 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
15300
15301 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
15302 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
15303 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
15304 given @var{address}.
15305
15306 @end table
15307
15308
15309 @node SPU
15310 @subsection Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
15311 @cindex Cell Broadband Engine
15312 @cindex SPU
15313
15314 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture,
15315 it provides the following special commands:
15316
15317 @table @code
15318 @item info spu event
15319 @kindex info spu
15320 Display SPU event facility status. Shows current event mask
15321 and pending event status.
15322
15323 @item info spu signal
15324 Display SPU signal notification facility status. Shows pending
15325 signal-control word and signal notification mode of both signal
15326 notification channels.
15327
15328 @item info spu mailbox
15329 Display SPU mailbox facility status. Shows all pending entries,
15330 in order of processing, in each of the SPU Write Outbound,
15331 SPU Write Outbound Interrupt, and SPU Read Inbound mailboxes.
15332
15333 @item info spu dma
15334 Display MFC DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
15335 DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
15336 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
15337
15338 @item info spu proxydma
15339 Display MFC Proxy-DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
15340 Proxy-DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
15341 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
15342
15343 @end table
15344
15345
15346 @node Controlling GDB
15347 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
15348
15349 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
15350 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
15351 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. Other settings are
15352 described here.
15353
15354 @menu
15355 * Prompt:: Prompt
15356 * Editing:: Command editing
15357 * Command History:: Command history
15358 * Screen Size:: Screen size
15359 * Numbers:: Numbers
15360 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
15361 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
15362 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
15363 @end menu
15364
15365 @node Prompt
15366 @section Prompt
15367
15368 @cindex prompt
15369
15370 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
15371 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
15372 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
15373 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
15374 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
15375 which one you are talking to.
15376
15377 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
15378 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
15379 or a prompt that does not.
15380
15381 @table @code
15382 @kindex set prompt
15383 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
15384 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
15385
15386 @kindex show prompt
15387 @item show prompt
15388 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
15389 @end table
15390
15391 @node Editing
15392 @section Command Editing
15393 @cindex readline
15394 @cindex command line editing
15395
15396 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
15397 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
15398 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
15399 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
15400 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
15401 debugging sessions.
15402
15403 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
15404 command @code{set}.
15405
15406 @table @code
15407 @kindex set editing
15408 @cindex editing
15409 @item set editing
15410 @itemx set editing on
15411 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
15412
15413 @item set editing off
15414 Disable command line editing.
15415
15416 @kindex show editing
15417 @item show editing
15418 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
15419 @end table
15420
15421 @xref{Command Line Editing}, for more details about the Readline
15422 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
15423 encouraged to read that chapter.
15424
15425 @node Command History
15426 @section Command History
15427 @cindex command history
15428
15429 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
15430 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
15431 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
15432 history facility.
15433
15434 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
15435 package, to provide the history facility. @xref{Using History
15436 Interactively}, for the detailed description of the History library.
15437
15438 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
15439 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }. This
15440 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
15441 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
15442 pressed on a line by itself.
15443
15444 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
15445 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
15446 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
15447 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
15448
15449 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
15450 history.
15451
15452 @table @code
15453 @cindex history substitution
15454 @cindex history file
15455 @kindex set history filename
15456 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
15457 @item set history filename @var{fname}
15458 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
15459 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
15460 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
15461 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
15462 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
15463 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
15464 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
15465 is not set.
15466
15467 @cindex save command history
15468 @kindex set history save
15469 @item set history save
15470 @itemx set history save on
15471 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
15472 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
15473
15474 @item set history save off
15475 Stop recording command history in a file.
15476
15477 @cindex history size
15478 @kindex set history size
15479 @cindex @env{HISTSIZE}, environment variable
15480 @item set history size @var{size}
15481 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
15482 This defaults to the value of the environment variable
15483 @code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set.
15484 @end table
15485
15486 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
15487 @xref{Event Designators}, for more details.
15488
15489 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
15490 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
15491 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
15492 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
15493 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
15494 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
15495 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
15496 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
15497
15498 The commands to control history expansion are:
15499
15500 @table @code
15501 @item set history expansion on
15502 @itemx set history expansion
15503 @kindex set history expansion
15504 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
15505
15506 @item set history expansion off
15507 Disable history expansion.
15508
15509 @c @group
15510 @kindex show history
15511 @item show history
15512 @itemx show history filename
15513 @itemx show history save
15514 @itemx show history size
15515 @itemx show history expansion
15516 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
15517 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
15518 @c @end group
15519 @end table
15520
15521 @table @code
15522 @kindex show commands
15523 @cindex show last commands
15524 @cindex display command history
15525 @item show commands
15526 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
15527
15528 @item show commands @var{n}
15529 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
15530
15531 @item show commands +
15532 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
15533 @end table
15534
15535 @node Screen Size
15536 @section Screen Size
15537 @cindex size of screen
15538 @cindex pauses in output
15539
15540 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
15541 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
15542 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
15543 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
15544 to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
15545 determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
15546 printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
15547 rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
15548
15549 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
15550 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
15551 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
15552 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
15553 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
15554 width} commands:
15555
15556 @table @code
15557 @kindex set height
15558 @kindex set width
15559 @kindex show width
15560 @kindex show height
15561 @item set height @var{lpp}
15562 @itemx show height
15563 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
15564 @itemx show width
15565 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
15566 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
15567 commands display the current settings.
15568
15569 If you specify a height of zero lines, @value{GDBN} does not pause during
15570 output no matter how long the output is. This is useful if output is to a
15571 file or to an editor buffer.
15572
15573 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN}
15574 from wrapping its output.
15575
15576 @item set pagination on
15577 @itemx set pagination off
15578 @kindex set pagination
15579 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
15580 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height 0}.
15581
15582 @item show pagination
15583 @kindex show pagination
15584 Show the current pagination mode.
15585 @end table
15586
15587 @node Numbers
15588 @section Numbers
15589 @cindex number representation
15590 @cindex entering numbers
15591
15592 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
15593 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
15594 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
15595 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
15596 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
15597 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
15598 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
15599 both input and output with the commands described below.
15600
15601 @table @code
15602 @kindex set input-radix
15603 @item set input-radix @var{base}
15604 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
15605 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
15606 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
15607 example, any of
15608
15609 @smallexample
15610 set input-radix 012
15611 set input-radix 10.
15612 set input-radix 0xa
15613 @end smallexample
15614
15615 @noindent
15616 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
15617 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
15618 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
15619 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
15620 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
15621 change the radix.
15622
15623 @kindex set output-radix
15624 @item set output-radix @var{base}
15625 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
15626 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
15627 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
15628
15629 @kindex show input-radix
15630 @item show input-radix
15631 Display the current default base for numeric input.
15632
15633 @kindex show output-radix
15634 @item show output-radix
15635 Display the current default base for numeric display.
15636
15637 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
15638 @itemx show radix
15639 @kindex set radix
15640 @kindex show radix
15641 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
15642 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
15643 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
15644 default value of 10.
15645
15646 @end table
15647
15648 @node ABI
15649 @section Configuring the Current ABI
15650
15651 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
15652 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
15653 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
15654 current ABI.
15655
15656 @cindex OS ABI
15657 @kindex set osabi
15658 @kindex show osabi
15659
15660 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
15661 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
15662 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
15663 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
15664 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
15665 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
15666 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
15667 platform provides.
15668
15669 @table @code
15670 @item show osabi
15671 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
15672
15673 @item set osabi
15674 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
15675
15676 @item set osabi @var{abi}
15677 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
15678 @end table
15679
15680 @cindex float promotion
15681
15682 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
15683 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
15684 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
15685 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
15686 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
15687 @code{double} and then passed.
15688
15689 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
15690 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
15691 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
15692
15693 @table @code
15694 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
15695 @item set coerce-float-to-double
15696 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
15697 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
15698 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
15699
15700 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
15701 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
15702 functions.
15703
15704 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
15705 @item show coerce-float-to-double
15706 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
15707 @end table
15708
15709 @kindex set cp-abi
15710 @kindex show cp-abi
15711 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
15712 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
15713 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
15714 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
15715 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
15716 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
15717 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
15718 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
15719 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
15720 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
15721 ``auto''.
15722
15723 @table @code
15724 @item show cp-abi
15725 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
15726
15727 @item set cp-abi
15728 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
15729
15730 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
15731 @itemx set cp-abi auto
15732 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
15733 @end table
15734
15735 @node Messages/Warnings
15736 @section Optional Warnings and Messages
15737
15738 @cindex verbose operation
15739 @cindex optional warnings
15740 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
15741 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
15742 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
15743 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
15744
15745 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
15746 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
15747 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
15748
15749 @table @code
15750 @kindex set verbose
15751 @item set verbose on
15752 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
15753
15754 @item set verbose off
15755 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
15756
15757 @kindex show verbose
15758 @item show verbose
15759 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
15760 @end table
15761
15762 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
15763 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
15764 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading
15765 Symbol Files}).
15766
15767 @table @code
15768
15769 @kindex set complaints
15770 @item set complaints @var{limit}
15771 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
15772 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
15773 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
15774 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
15775
15776 @kindex show complaints
15777 @item show complaints
15778 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
15779
15780 @end table
15781
15782 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
15783 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
15784 you try to run a program which is already running:
15785
15786 @smallexample
15787 (@value{GDBP}) run
15788 The program being debugged has been started already.
15789 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
15790 @end smallexample
15791
15792 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
15793 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
15794
15795 @table @code
15796
15797 @kindex set confirm
15798 @cindex flinching
15799 @cindex confirmation
15800 @cindex stupid questions
15801 @item set confirm off
15802 Disables confirmation requests.
15803
15804 @item set confirm on
15805 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
15806
15807 @kindex show confirm
15808 @item show confirm
15809 Displays state of confirmation requests.
15810
15811 @end table
15812
15813 @cindex command tracing
15814 If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
15815 useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
15816 printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
15817 quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
15818
15819 @table @code
15820 @kindex set trace-commands
15821 @cindex command scripts, debugging
15822 @item set trace-commands on
15823 Enable command tracing.
15824 @item set trace-commands off
15825 Disable command tracing.
15826 @item show trace-commands
15827 Display the current state of command tracing.
15828 @end table
15829
15830 @node Debugging Output
15831 @section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings
15832 @cindex optional debugging messages
15833
15834 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
15835 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
15836 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
15837 section documents those commands.
15838
15839 @table @code
15840 @kindex set exec-done-display
15841 @item set exec-done-display
15842 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
15843 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
15844 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
15845 @kindex show exec-done-display
15846 @item show exec-done-display
15847 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
15848 notification.
15849 @kindex set debug
15850 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
15851 @cindex architecture debugging info
15852 @item set debug arch
15853 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
15854 @kindex show debug
15855 @item show debug arch
15856 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
15857 @item set debug aix-thread
15858 @cindex AIX threads
15859 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
15860 module.
15861 @item show debug aix-thread
15862 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
15863 @item set debug event
15864 @cindex event debugging info
15865 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
15866 default is off.
15867 @item show debug event
15868 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
15869 info.
15870 @item set debug expression
15871 @cindex expression debugging info
15872 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
15873 expression parsing. The default is off.
15874 @item show debug expression
15875 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
15876 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
15877 @item set debug frame
15878 @cindex frame debugging info
15879 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
15880 default is off.
15881 @item show debug frame
15882 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
15883 info.
15884 @item set debug infrun
15885 @cindex inferior debugging info
15886 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
15887 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
15888 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
15889 @item show debug infrun
15890 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
15891 @item set debug lin-lwp
15892 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
15893 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
15894 Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
15895 @item show debug lin-lwp
15896 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
15897 @item set debug observer
15898 @cindex observer debugging info
15899 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
15900 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
15901 @item show debug observer
15902 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
15903 @item set debug overload
15904 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
15905 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
15906 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
15907 is off.
15908 @item show debug overload
15909 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
15910 debugging info.
15911 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
15912 @cindex serial connections, debugging
15913 @cindex debug remote protocol
15914 @cindex remote protocol debugging
15915 @cindex display remote packets
15916 @item set debug remote
15917 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
15918 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
15919 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
15920 @item show debug remote
15921 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
15922 @item set debug serial
15923 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
15924 default is off.
15925 @item show debug serial
15926 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
15927 info.
15928 @item set debug solib-frv
15929 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
15930 Turns on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
15931 @item show debug solib-frv
15932 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
15933 messages.
15934 @item set debug target
15935 @cindex target debugging info
15936 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
15937 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
15938 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
15939 value of large memory transfers. Changes to this flag do not take effect
15940 until the next time you connect to a target or use the @code{run} command.
15941 @item show debug target
15942 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
15943 info.
15944 @item set debugvarobj
15945 @cindex variable object debugging info
15946 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
15947 info. The default is off.
15948 @item show debugvarobj
15949 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
15950 debugging info.
15951 @item set debug xml
15952 @cindex XML parser debugging
15953 Turns on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
15954 @item show debug xml
15955 Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
15956 @end table
15957
15958 @node Sequences
15959 @chapter Canned Sequences of Commands
15960
15961 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
15962 Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
15963 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
15964 files.
15965
15966 @menu
15967 * Define:: How to define your own commands
15968 * Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
15969 * Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
15970 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
15971 @end menu
15972
15973 @node Define
15974 @section User-defined Commands
15975
15976 @cindex user-defined command
15977 @cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
15978 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
15979 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
15980 @code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
15981 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
15982 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
15983
15984 @smallexample
15985 define adder
15986 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
15987 end
15988 @end smallexample
15989
15990 @noindent
15991 To execute the command use:
15992
15993 @smallexample
15994 adder 1 2 3
15995 @end smallexample
15996
15997 @noindent
15998 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
15999 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
16000 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
16001 functions calls.
16002
16003 @cindex argument count in user-defined commands
16004 @cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
16005 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
16006 been passed. This expands to a number in the range 0@dots{}10.
16007
16008 @smallexample
16009 define adder
16010 if $argc == 2
16011 print $arg0 + $arg1
16012 end
16013 if $argc == 3
16014 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
16015 end
16016 end
16017 @end smallexample
16018
16019 @table @code
16020
16021 @kindex define
16022 @item define @var{commandname}
16023 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
16024 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
16025
16026 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
16027 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
16028 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
16029
16030 @kindex document
16031 @kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
16032 @item document @var{commandname}
16033 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
16034 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
16035 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
16036 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
16037 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
16038 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
16039
16040 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
16041 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
16042 does not change the documentation.
16043
16044 @kindex dont-repeat
16045 @cindex don't repeat command
16046 @item dont-repeat
16047 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
16048 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
16049 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
16050
16051 @kindex help user-defined
16052 @item help user-defined
16053 List all user-defined commands, with the first line of the documentation
16054 (if any) for each.
16055
16056 @kindex show user
16057 @item show user
16058 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
16059 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
16060 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
16061 definitions for all user-defined commands.
16062
16063 @cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
16064 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
16065 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
16066 @item show max-user-call-depth
16067 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
16068 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
16069 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an
16070 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
16071 @end table
16072
16073 In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
16074 use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
16075
16076 When user-defined commands are executed, the
16077 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
16078 stops execution of the user-defined command.
16079
16080 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
16081 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
16082 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
16083 messages when used in a user-defined command.
16084
16085 @node Hooks
16086 @section User-defined Command Hooks
16087 @cindex command hooks
16088 @cindex hooks, for commands
16089 @cindex hooks, pre-command
16090
16091 @kindex hook
16092 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
16093 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
16094 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
16095 before that command.
16096
16097 @cindex hooks, post-command
16098 @kindex hookpost
16099 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
16100 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
16101 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
16102 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
16103 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
16104
16105 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
16106 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
16107
16108 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
16109 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
16110
16111 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
16112 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
16113 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
16114 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
16115 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
16116
16117 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
16118 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
16119 you could define:
16120
16121 @smallexample
16122 define hook-stop
16123 handle SIGALRM nopass
16124 end
16125
16126 define hook-run
16127 handle SIGALRM pass
16128 end
16129
16130 define hook-continue
16131 handle SIGALRM pass
16132 end
16133 @end smallexample
16134
16135 As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo}
16136 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
16137 you could define:
16138
16139 @smallexample
16140 define hook-echo
16141 echo <<<---
16142 end
16143
16144 define hookpost-echo
16145 echo --->>>\n
16146 end
16147
16148 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
16149 <<<---Hello World--->>>
16150 (@value{GDBP})
16151
16152 @end smallexample
16153
16154 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
16155 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
16156 name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
16157 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
16158 @c or not?
16159 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
16160 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
16161 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
16162
16163 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
16164 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
16165
16166 @node Command Files
16167 @section Command Files
16168
16169 @cindex command files
16170 @cindex scripting commands
16171 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
16172 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
16173 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
16174 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
16175 terminal.
16176
16177 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
16178 command:
16179
16180 @table @code
16181 @kindex source
16182 @cindex execute commands from a file
16183 @item source [@code{-v}] @var{filename}
16184 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
16185 @end table
16186
16187 The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
16188 unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
16189 @emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
16190 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
16191 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
16192
16193 @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename} in the current directory and then
16194 on the search path (specified with the @samp{directory} command).
16195
16196 If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
16197 each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
16198 @var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
16199
16200 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
16201 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
16202 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
16203 when called from command files.
16204
16205 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
16206 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
16207 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
16208 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
16209 the next command.
16210
16211 @smallexample
16212 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
16213 @end smallexample
16214
16215 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
16216 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
16217 would be directed to @file{log}.
16218
16219 Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
16220 commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
16221 complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
16222 variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
16223 built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
16224 deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
16225 complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
16226 conditionally, etc.
16227
16228 @table @code
16229 @kindex if
16230 @kindex else
16231 @item if
16232 @itemx else
16233 This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
16234 commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
16235 expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
16236 are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
16237 There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
16238 of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
16239 end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
16240
16241 @kindex while
16242 @item while
16243 This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
16244 @code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
16245 to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
16246 line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
16247 @dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
16248 executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
16249
16250 @kindex loop_break
16251 @item loop_break
16252 This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
16253 Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
16254 line.
16255
16256 @kindex loop_continue
16257 @item loop_continue
16258 This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
16259 in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
16260 branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
16261 the controlling expression.
16262
16263 @kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
16264 @item end
16265 Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
16266 @code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
16267 @end table
16268
16269
16270 @node Output
16271 @section Commands for Controlled Output
16272
16273 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
16274 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
16275 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
16276 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
16277 want.
16278
16279 @table @code
16280 @kindex echo
16281 @item echo @var{text}
16282 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
16283 @c because it is not in ANSI.
16284 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
16285 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
16286 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
16287 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
16288 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
16289 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
16290 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
16291 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
16292 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
16293
16294 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
16295 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
16296
16297 @smallexample
16298 echo This is some text\n\
16299 which is continued\n\
16300 onto several lines.\n
16301 @end smallexample
16302
16303 produces the same output as
16304
16305 @smallexample
16306 echo This is some text\n
16307 echo which is continued\n
16308 echo onto several lines.\n
16309 @end smallexample
16310
16311 @kindex output
16312 @item output @var{expression}
16313 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
16314 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
16315 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
16316 on expressions.
16317
16318 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
16319 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
16320 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
16321 Formats}, for more information.
16322
16323 @kindex printf
16324 @item printf @var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
16325 Print the values of the @var{expressions} under the control of
16326 @var{string}. The @var{expressions} are separated by commas and may be
16327 either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as specified by
16328 @var{string}, exactly as if your program were to execute the C
16329 subroutine
16330 @c FIXME: the above implies that at least all ANSI C formats are
16331 @c supported, but it isn't true: %E and %G don't work (or so it seems).
16332 @c Either this is a bug, or the manual should document what formats are
16333 @c supported.
16334
16335 @smallexample
16336 printf (@var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
16337 @end smallexample
16338
16339 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
16340
16341 @smallexample
16342 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
16343 @end smallexample
16344
16345 The only backslash-escape sequences that you can use in the format
16346 string are the simple ones that consist of backslash followed by a
16347 letter.
16348 @end table
16349
16350 @node Interpreters
16351 @chapter Command Interpreters
16352 @cindex command interpreters
16353
16354 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
16355 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
16356 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
16357
16358 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
16359 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
16360 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
16361 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
16362
16363 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
16364 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
16365 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
16366 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
16367
16368 @table @code
16369 @item console
16370 @cindex console interpreter
16371 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
16372 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
16373 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
16374
16375 @item mi
16376 @cindex mi interpreter
16377 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
16378 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
16379 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
16380 Interface}.
16381
16382 @item mi2
16383 @cindex mi2 interpreter
16384 The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
16385
16386 @item mi1
16387 @cindex mi1 interpreter
16388 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
16389
16390 @end table
16391
16392 @cindex invoke another interpreter
16393 The interpreter being used by @value{GDBN} may not be dynamically
16394 switched at runtime. Although possible, this could lead to a very
16395 precarious situation. Consider an IDE using @sc{gdb/mi}. If a user
16396 enters the command "interpreter-set console" in a console view,
16397 @value{GDBN} would switch to using the console interpreter, rendering
16398 the IDE inoperable!
16399
16400 @kindex interpreter-exec
16401 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, you may execute
16402 commands in any interpreter from the current interpreter using the appropriate
16403 command. If you are running the console interpreter, simply use the
16404 @code{interpreter-exec} command:
16405
16406 @smallexample
16407 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
16408 @end smallexample
16409
16410 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
16411 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
16412
16413 @node TUI
16414 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
16415 @cindex TUI
16416 @cindex Text User Interface
16417
16418 @menu
16419 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
16420 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
16421 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
16422 * TUI Commands:: TUI-specific commands
16423 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
16424 @end menu
16425
16426 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface (TUI) is a terminal
16427 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
16428 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
16429 commands in separate text windows. The TUI mode is supported only
16430 on platforms where a suitable version of the @code{curses} library
16431 is available.
16432
16433 @pindex @value{GDBTUI}
16434 The TUI mode is enabled by default when you invoke @value{GDBN} as
16435 either @samp{@value{GDBTUI}} or @samp{@value{GDBP} -tui}.
16436 You can also switch in and out of TUI mode while @value{GDBN} runs by
16437 using various TUI commands and key bindings, such as @kbd{C-x C-a}.
16438 @xref{TUI Keys, ,TUI Key Bindings}.
16439
16440 @node TUI Overview
16441 @section TUI Overview
16442
16443 In TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text windows:
16444
16445 @table @emph
16446 @item command
16447 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
16448 prompt and the @value{GDBN} output. The @value{GDBN} input is still
16449 managed using readline.
16450
16451 @item source
16452 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
16453 line and active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
16454
16455 @item assembly
16456 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
16457
16458 @item register
16459 This window shows the processor registers. Registers are highlighted
16460 when their values change.
16461 @end table
16462
16463 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
16464 by highlighting the current line and marking it with a @samp{>} marker.
16465 Breakpoints are indicated with two markers. The first marker
16466 indicates the breakpoint type:
16467
16468 @table @code
16469 @item B
16470 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
16471
16472 @item b
16473 Breakpoint which was never hit.
16474
16475 @item H
16476 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
16477
16478 @item h
16479 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
16480 @end table
16481
16482 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
16483
16484 @table @code
16485 @item +
16486 Breakpoint is enabled.
16487
16488 @item -
16489 Breakpoint is disabled.
16490 @end table
16491
16492 The source, assembly and register windows are updated when the current
16493 thread changes, when the frame changes, or when the program counter
16494 changes.
16495
16496 These windows are not all visible at the same time. The command
16497 window is always visible. The others can be arranged in several
16498 layouts:
16499
16500 @itemize @bullet
16501 @item
16502 source only,
16503
16504 @item
16505 assembly only,
16506
16507 @item
16508 source and assembly,
16509
16510 @item
16511 source and registers, or
16512
16513 @item
16514 assembly and registers.
16515 @end itemize
16516
16517 A status line above the command window shows the following information:
16518
16519 @table @emph
16520 @item target
16521 Indicates the current @value{GDBN} target.
16522 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
16523
16524 @item process
16525 Gives the current process or thread number.
16526 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
16527
16528 @item function
16529 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
16530 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
16531 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter,
16532 the string @code{??} is displayed.
16533
16534 @item line
16535 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
16536 When the current line number is not known, the string @code{??} is displayed.
16537
16538 @item pc
16539 Indicates the current program counter address.
16540 @end table
16541
16542 @node TUI Keys
16543 @section TUI Key Bindings
16544 @cindex TUI key bindings
16545
16546 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
16547 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}). The following key bindings
16548 are installed for both TUI mode and the @value{GDBN} standard mode.
16549
16550 @table @kbd
16551 @kindex C-x C-a
16552 @item C-x C-a
16553 @kindex C-x a
16554 @itemx C-x a
16555 @kindex C-x A
16556 @itemx C-x A
16557 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When leaving the TUI mode,
16558 the curses window management stops and @value{GDBN} operates using
16559 its standard mode, writing on the terminal directly. When reentering
16560 the TUI mode, control is given back to the curses windows.
16561 The screen is then refreshed.
16562
16563 @kindex C-x 1
16564 @item C-x 1
16565 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
16566 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
16567 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
16568
16569 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
16570
16571 @kindex C-x 2
16572 @item C-x 2
16573 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
16574 layout already has two windows, the next layout with two windows is used.
16575 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
16576 previous layout and the new one.
16577
16578 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
16579
16580 @kindex C-x o
16581 @item C-x o
16582 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
16583 (like scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window. This command
16584 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
16585
16586 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
16587
16588 @kindex C-x s
16589 @item C-x s
16590 Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single
16591 keys to @value{GDBN} commands (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
16592 @end table
16593
16594 The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode:
16595
16596 @table @asis
16597 @kindex PgUp
16598 @item @key{PgUp}
16599 Scroll the active window one page up.
16600
16601 @kindex PgDn
16602 @item @key{PgDn}
16603 Scroll the active window one page down.
16604
16605 @kindex Up
16606 @item @key{Up}
16607 Scroll the active window one line up.
16608
16609 @kindex Down
16610 @item @key{Down}
16611 Scroll the active window one line down.
16612
16613 @kindex Left
16614 @item @key{Left}
16615 Scroll the active window one column left.
16616
16617 @kindex Right
16618 @item @key{Right}
16619 Scroll the active window one column right.
16620
16621 @kindex C-L
16622 @item @kbd{C-L}
16623 Refresh the screen.
16624 @end table
16625
16626 Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they
16627 are not available for their normal use by readline unless the command
16628 window has the focus. When another window is active, you must use
16629 other readline key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b}
16630 and @kbd{C-f} to control the command window.
16631
16632 @node TUI Single Key Mode
16633 @section TUI Single Key Mode
16634 @cindex TUI single key mode
16635
16636 The TUI also provides a @dfn{SingleKey} mode, which binds several
16637 frequently used @value{GDBN} commands to single keys. Type @kbd{C-x s} to
16638 switch into this mode, where the following key bindings are used:
16639
16640 @table @kbd
16641 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16642 @item c
16643 continue
16644
16645 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16646 @item d
16647 down
16648
16649 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16650 @item f
16651 finish
16652
16653 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16654 @item n
16655 next
16656
16657 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16658 @item q
16659 exit the SingleKey mode.
16660
16661 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16662 @item r
16663 run
16664
16665 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16666 @item s
16667 step
16668
16669 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16670 @item u
16671 up
16672
16673 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16674 @item v
16675 info locals
16676
16677 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16678 @item w
16679 where
16680 @end table
16681
16682 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
16683 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
16684 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
16685 with the TUI SingleKey mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
16686 SingleKey mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
16687 this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
16688
16689
16690 @node TUI Commands
16691 @section TUI-specific Commands
16692 @cindex TUI commands
16693
16694 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
16695 These commands are always available, even when @value{GDBN} is not in
16696 the TUI mode. When @value{GDBN} is in the standard mode, most
16697 of these commands will automatically switch to the TUI mode.
16698
16699 @table @code
16700 @item info win
16701 @kindex info win
16702 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
16703
16704 @item layout next
16705 @kindex layout
16706 Display the next layout.
16707
16708 @item layout prev
16709 Display the previous layout.
16710
16711 @item layout src
16712 Display the source window only.
16713
16714 @item layout asm
16715 Display the assembly window only.
16716
16717 @item layout split
16718 Display the source and assembly window.
16719
16720 @item layout regs
16721 Display the register window together with the source or assembly window.
16722
16723 @item focus next
16724 @kindex focus
16725 Make the next window active for scrolling.
16726
16727 @item focus prev
16728 Make the previous window active for scrolling.
16729
16730 @item focus src
16731 Make the source window active for scrolling.
16732
16733 @item focus asm
16734 Make the assembly window active for scrolling.
16735
16736 @item focus regs
16737 Make the register window active for scrolling.
16738
16739 @item focus cmd
16740 Make the command window active for scrolling.
16741
16742 @item refresh
16743 @kindex refresh
16744 Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
16745
16746 @item tui reg float
16747 @kindex tui reg
16748 Show the floating point registers in the register window.
16749
16750 @item tui reg general
16751 Show the general registers in the register window.
16752
16753 @item tui reg next
16754 Show the next register group. The list of register groups as well as
16755 their order is target specific. The predefined register groups are the
16756 following: @code{general}, @code{float}, @code{system}, @code{vector},
16757 @code{all}, @code{save}, @code{restore}.
16758
16759 @item tui reg system
16760 Show the system registers in the register window.
16761
16762 @item update
16763 @kindex update
16764 Update the source window and the current execution point.
16765
16766 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
16767 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
16768 @kindex winheight
16769 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
16770 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
16771 decrease it.
16772
16773 @item tabset @var{nchars}
16774 @kindex tabset
16775 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters.
16776 @end table
16777
16778 @node TUI Configuration
16779 @section TUI Configuration Variables
16780 @cindex TUI configuration variables
16781
16782 Several configuration variables control the appearance of TUI windows.
16783
16784 @table @code
16785 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
16786 @kindex set tui border-kind
16787 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
16788 The possible values are the following:
16789 @table @code
16790 @item space
16791 Use a space character to draw the border.
16792
16793 @item ascii
16794 Use @sc{ascii} characters @samp{+}, @samp{-} and @samp{|} to draw the border.
16795
16796 @item acs
16797 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
16798 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
16799 @end table
16800
16801 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
16802 @kindex set tui border-mode
16803 @itemx set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
16804 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
16805 Select the display attributes for the borders of the inactive windows
16806 or the active window. The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
16807 @table @code
16808 @item normal
16809 Use normal attributes to display the border.
16810
16811 @item standout
16812 Use standout mode.
16813
16814 @item reverse
16815 Use reverse video mode.
16816
16817 @item half
16818 Use half bright mode.
16819
16820 @item half-standout
16821 Use half bright and standout mode.
16822
16823 @item bold
16824 Use extra bright or bold mode.
16825
16826 @item bold-standout
16827 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
16828 @end table
16829 @end table
16830
16831 @node Emacs
16832 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
16833
16834 @cindex Emacs
16835 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
16836 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
16837 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
16838 @value{GDBN}.
16839
16840 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
16841 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
16842 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
16843 created Emacs buffer.
16844 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
16845
16846 Running @value{GDBN} under Emacs can be just like running @value{GDBN} normally except for two
16847 things:
16848
16849 @itemize @bullet
16850 @item
16851 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through an Emacs buffer, called
16852 the GUD buffer.
16853
16854 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
16855 and output done by the program you are debugging.
16856
16857 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
16858 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
16859 in this way.
16860
16861 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
16862 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
16863 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
16864 stop.
16865
16866 @item
16867 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
16868
16869 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
16870 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
16871 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
16872 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
16873 and the source.
16874
16875 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
16876 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
16877 @end itemize
16878
16879 We call this @dfn{text command mode}. Emacs 22.1, and later, also uses
16880 a graphical mode, enabled by default, which provides further buffers
16881 that can control the execution and describe the state of your program.
16882 @xref{GDB Graphical Interface,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}.
16883
16884 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
16885 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
16886 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
16887 sets your current working directory to to the directory associated
16888 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
16889 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
16890 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
16891 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
16892 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
16893
16894 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
16895 line of the GUD buffer and this serves as a default for the commands
16896 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files,
16897 ,Commands to Specify Files}.
16898
16899 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
16900 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
16901 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
16902 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
16903 one you want.
16904
16905 In the GUD buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
16906 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
16907
16908 @table @kbd
16909 @item C-h m
16910 Describe the features of Emacs' GUD Mode.
16911
16912 @item C-c C-s
16913 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
16914 update the display window to show the current file and location.
16915
16916 @item C-c C-n
16917 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
16918 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
16919 to show the current file and location.
16920
16921 @item C-c C-i
16922 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
16923 display window accordingly.
16924
16925 @item C-c C-f
16926 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
16927 @code{finish} command.
16928
16929 @item C-c C-r
16930 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
16931 command.
16932
16933 @item C-c <
16934 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
16935 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
16936 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
16937
16938 @item C-c >
16939 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
16940 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
16941 @end table
16942
16943 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
16944 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
16945
16946 In text command mode, if you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, Emacs displays a
16947 separate frame which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current.
16948 Move point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it
16949 become the current frame and display the associated source in the
16950 source buffer. Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the
16951 selected frame become the current one. In graphical mode, the
16952 speedbar displays watch expressions.
16953
16954 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
16955 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
16956 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
16957 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
16958 frame.
16959
16960 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
16961 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
16962 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
16963 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
16964 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
16965 to correspond properly with the code.
16966
16967 A more detailed description of Emacs' interaction with @value{GDBN} is
16968 given in the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu}
16969 Emacs Manual}).
16970
16971 @c The following dropped because Epoch is nonstandard. Reactivate
16972 @c if/when v19 does something similar. ---doc@cygnus.com 19dec1990
16973 @ignore
16974 @kindex Emacs Epoch environment
16975 @kindex Epoch
16976 @kindex inspect
16977
16978 Version 18 of @sc{gnu} Emacs has a built-in window system
16979 called the @code{epoch}
16980 environment. Users of this environment can use a new command,
16981 @code{inspect} which performs identically to @code{print} except that
16982 each value is printed in its own window.
16983 @end ignore
16984
16985
16986 @node GDB/MI
16987 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
16988
16989 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
16990
16991 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
16992 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
16993 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
16994 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
16995 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
16996 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
16997
16998 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
16999 in the form of a reference manual.
17000
17001 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
17002 features described below are incomplete and subject to change
17003 (@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
17004
17005 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
17006
17007 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
17008 This chapter uses the following notation:
17009
17010 @itemize @bullet
17011 @item
17012 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
17013
17014 @item
17015 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
17016 it may or may not be given.
17017
17018 @item
17019 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
17020 may repeat zero or more times.
17021
17022 @item
17023 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
17024 may repeat one or more times.
17025
17026 @item
17027 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
17028 @end itemize
17029
17030 @ignore
17031 @heading Dependencies
17032 @end ignore
17033
17034 @menu
17035 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
17036 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
17037 * GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
17038 * GDB/MI Output Records::
17039 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
17040 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
17041 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
17042 * GDB/MI Program Context::
17043 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
17044 * GDB/MI Program Execution::
17045 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
17046 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
17047 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
17048 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
17049 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
17050 * GDB/MI File Commands::
17051 @ignore
17052 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
17053 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
17054 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
17055 @end ignore
17056 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
17057 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
17058 @end menu
17059
17060 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17061 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
17062 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
17063
17064 @menu
17065 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
17066 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
17067 @end menu
17068
17069 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
17070 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
17071
17072 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
17073 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
17074 @table @code
17075 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
17076 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
17077
17078 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
17079 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
17080 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
17081
17082 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
17083 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
17084 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
17085
17086 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
17087 "any sequence of digits"
17088
17089 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
17090 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
17091
17092 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
17093 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
17094
17095 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
17096 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
17097
17098 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
17099 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
17100 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
17101
17102 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
17103 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
17104
17105 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
17106 @code{CR | CR-LF}
17107 @end table
17108
17109 @noindent
17110 Notes:
17111
17112 @itemize @bullet
17113 @item
17114 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
17115 output is described below.
17116
17117 @item
17118 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
17119 finishes.
17120
17121 @item
17122 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
17123 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
17124 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
17125 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
17126 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
17127 @end itemize
17128
17129 Pragmatics:
17130
17131 @itemize @bullet
17132 @item
17133 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
17134
17135 @item
17136 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
17137 @end itemize
17138
17139 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
17140 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
17141
17142 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
17143 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
17144 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
17145 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
17146 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
17147 terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
17148
17149 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
17150 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
17151 @var{token}.
17152
17153 @table @code
17154 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
17155 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
17156
17157 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
17158 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
17159
17160 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
17161 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
17162
17163 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
17164 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
17165
17166 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
17167 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output}}
17168
17169 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
17170 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output}}
17171
17172 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
17173 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output}}
17174
17175 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
17176 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
17177
17178 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
17179 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
17180
17181 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
17182 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
17183 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
17184
17185 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
17186 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
17187
17188 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
17189 @code{ @var{string} }
17190
17191 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
17192 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
17193
17194 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
17195 @code{@var{c-string}}
17196
17197 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
17198 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
17199
17200 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
17201 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
17202 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
17203
17204 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
17205 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
17206
17207 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
17208 @code{"~" @var{c-string}}
17209
17210 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
17211 @code{"@@" @var{c-string}}
17212
17213 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
17214 @code{"&" @var{c-string}}
17215
17216 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
17217 @code{CR | CR-LF}
17218
17219 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
17220 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
17221 @end table
17222
17223 @noindent
17224 Notes:
17225
17226 @itemize @bullet
17227 @item
17228 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
17229
17230 @item
17231 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. If an execution
17232 command is interrupted by the @samp{-exec-interrupt} command, the
17233 @var{token} associated with the @samp{*stopped} message is the one of the
17234 original execution command, not the one of the interrupt command.
17235
17236 @item
17237 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17238 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
17239 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
17240 prefixed by @samp{+}.
17241
17242 @item
17243 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17244 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
17245 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
17246 @samp{*}.
17247
17248 @item
17249 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17250 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
17251 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
17252 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
17253
17254 @item
17255 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17256 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
17257 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
17258 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
17259
17260 @item
17261 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17262 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
17263 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
17264
17265 @item
17266 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17267 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
17268 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
17269 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
17270
17271 @item
17272 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17273 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
17274 @var{values}.
17275
17276
17277 @end itemize
17278
17279 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
17280 details about the various output records.
17281
17282 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17283 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
17284 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
17285
17286 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
17287 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
17288
17289 For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
17290 but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
17291 that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
17292 command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
17293 @code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
17294 @samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
17295
17296 This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
17297 recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
17298 (@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
17299
17300 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17301 @node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
17302 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
17303 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
17304
17305 The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
17306 program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
17307
17308 Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used
17309 by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}. This makes it difficult
17310 to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage. This
17311 section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol
17312 might change.
17313
17314 Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
17315 for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
17316 list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
17317 parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
17318
17319 @itemize @bullet
17320 @item
17321 New MI commands may be added.
17322
17323 @item
17324 New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
17325
17326 @item
17327 The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g.,
17328 @code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended.
17329
17330 @c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
17331 @c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
17332
17333 @c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
17334 @c resolve inconsistencies.
17335 @end itemize
17336
17337 If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
17338 will be increased by one. This will allow the front end to parse the
17339 output according to the MI version. Apart from mi0, new versions of
17340 @value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the
17341 responsibility of the front end to work with the new one.
17342
17343 @c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI
17344 @c version?
17345
17346 The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
17347 end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
17348 follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
17349 @email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}. There is also the mailing list
17350 @email{dmi-discuss@@lists.freestandards.org}, hosted by the Free Standards
17351 Group, which has the aim of creating a more general MI protocol
17352 called Debugger Machine Interface (DMI) that will become a standard
17353 for all debuggers, not just @value{GDBN}.
17354 @cindex mailing lists
17355
17356 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17357 @node GDB/MI Output Records
17358 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
17359
17360 @menu
17361 * GDB/MI Result Records::
17362 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
17363 * GDB/MI Out-of-band Records::
17364 @end menu
17365
17366 @node GDB/MI Result Records
17367 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
17368
17369 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
17370 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
17371 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
17372 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
17373
17374 @table @code
17375 @findex ^done
17376 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
17377 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
17378 values.
17379
17380 @item "^running"
17381 @findex ^running
17382 @c Is this one correct? Should it be an out-of-band notification?
17383 The asynchronous operation was successfully started. The target is
17384 running.
17385
17386 @item "^connected"
17387 @findex ^connected
17388 @value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target.
17389
17390 @item "^error" "," @var{c-string}
17391 @findex ^error
17392 The operation failed. The @code{@var{c-string}} contains the corresponding
17393 error message.
17394
17395 @item "^exit"
17396 @findex ^exit
17397 @value{GDBN} has terminated.
17398
17399 @end table
17400
17401 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
17402 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
17403
17404 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
17405 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
17406 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
17407 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
17408 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
17409
17410 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
17411 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
17412 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
17413 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
17414 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
17415
17416 @table @code
17417 @item "~" @var{string-output}
17418 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
17419 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
17420
17421 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
17422 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
17423 target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
17424 asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
17425
17426 @item "&" @var{string-output}
17427 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
17428 internals.
17429 @end table
17430
17431 @node GDB/MI Out-of-band Records
17432 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Out-of-band Records
17433
17434 @cindex out-of-band records in @sc{gdb/mi}
17435 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, out-of-band records
17436 @dfn{Out-of-band} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
17437 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
17438 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
17439 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
17440
17441 The following is a preliminary list of possible out-of-band records.
17442 In particular, the @var{exec-async-output} records.
17443
17444 @table @code
17445 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}"
17446 @end table
17447
17448 @var{reason} can be one of the following:
17449
17450 @table @code
17451 @item breakpoint-hit
17452 A breakpoint was reached.
17453 @item watchpoint-trigger
17454 A watchpoint was triggered.
17455 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
17456 A read watchpoint was triggered.
17457 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
17458 An access watchpoint was triggered.
17459 @item function-finished
17460 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
17461 @item location-reached
17462 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
17463 @item watchpoint-scope
17464 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
17465 @item end-stepping-range
17466 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
17467 similar CLI command was accomplished.
17468 @item exited-signalled
17469 The inferior exited because of a signal.
17470 @item exited
17471 The inferior exited.
17472 @item exited-normally
17473 The inferior exited normally.
17474 @item signal-received
17475 A signal was received by the inferior.
17476 @end table
17477
17478
17479 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17480 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
17481 @section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
17482 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
17483
17484 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
17485 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
17486 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
17487 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
17488
17489 Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
17490 readability, they don't appear in the real output.
17491
17492 @subheading Setting a Breakpoint
17493
17494 Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
17495 information of the breakpoint.
17496
17497 @smallexample
17498 -> -break-insert main
17499 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
17500 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
17501 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",times="0"@}
17502 <- (gdb)
17503 @end smallexample
17504
17505 @subheading Program Execution
17506
17507 Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
17508 reason that execution stopped.
17509
17510 @smallexample
17511 -> -exec-run
17512 <- ^running
17513 <- (gdb)
17514 <- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
17515 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
17516 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
17517 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68"@}
17518 <- (gdb)
17519 -> -exec-continue
17520 <- ^running
17521 <- (gdb)
17522 <- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
17523 <- (gdb)
17524 @end smallexample
17525
17526 @subheading Quitting @value{GDBN}
17527
17528 Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
17529
17530 @smallexample
17531 -> (gdb)
17532 <- -gdb-exit
17533 <- ^exit
17534 @end smallexample
17535
17536 @subheading A Bad Command
17537
17538 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
17539
17540 @smallexample
17541 -> -rubbish
17542 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
17543 <- (gdb)
17544 @end smallexample
17545
17546
17547 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17548 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
17549 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
17550
17551 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
17552 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
17553
17554 @subheading Motivation
17555
17556 The motivation for this collection of commands.
17557
17558 @subheading Introduction
17559
17560 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
17561
17562 @subheading Commands
17563
17564 For each command in the block, the following is described:
17565
17566 @subsubheading Synopsis
17567
17568 @smallexample
17569 -command @var{args}@dots{}
17570 @end smallexample
17571
17572 @subsubheading Result
17573
17574 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17575
17576 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
17577
17578 @subsubheading Example
17579
17580 Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
17581 not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
17582
17583
17584 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17585 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
17586 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
17587
17588 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
17589 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
17590 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
17591 breakpoints.
17592
17593 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
17594 @findex -break-after
17595
17596 @subsubheading Synopsis
17597
17598 @smallexample
17599 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
17600 @end smallexample
17601
17602 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
17603 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
17604 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
17605 @samp{-break-list} command below.
17606
17607 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17608
17609 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
17610
17611 @subsubheading Example
17612
17613 @smallexample
17614 (gdb)
17615 -break-insert main
17616 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x000100d0",file="hello.c",
17617 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",times="0"@}
17618 (gdb)
17619 -break-after 1 3
17620 ~
17621 ^done
17622 (gdb)
17623 -break-list
17624 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
17625 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
17626 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
17627 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
17628 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
17629 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
17630 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
17631 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
17632 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
17633 line="5",times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
17634 (gdb)
17635 @end smallexample
17636
17637 @ignore
17638 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
17639 @findex -break-catch
17640
17641 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
17642 @findex -break-commands
17643 @end ignore
17644
17645
17646 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
17647 @findex -break-condition
17648
17649 @subsubheading Synopsis
17650
17651 @smallexample
17652 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
17653 @end smallexample
17654
17655 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
17656 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
17657 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
17658 command below).
17659
17660 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17661
17662 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
17663
17664 @subsubheading Example
17665
17666 @smallexample
17667 (gdb)
17668 -break-condition 1 1
17669 ^done
17670 (gdb)
17671 -break-list
17672 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
17673 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
17674 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
17675 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
17676 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
17677 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
17678 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
17679 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
17680 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
17681 line="5",cond="1",times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
17682 (gdb)
17683 @end smallexample
17684
17685 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
17686 @findex -break-delete
17687
17688 @subsubheading Synopsis
17689
17690 @smallexample
17691 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
17692 @end smallexample
17693
17694 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
17695 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
17696
17697 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17698
17699 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
17700
17701 @subsubheading Example
17702
17703 @smallexample
17704 (gdb)
17705 -break-delete 1
17706 ^done
17707 (gdb)
17708 -break-list
17709 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
17710 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
17711 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
17712 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
17713 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
17714 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
17715 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
17716 body=[]@}
17717 (gdb)
17718 @end smallexample
17719
17720 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
17721 @findex -break-disable
17722
17723 @subsubheading Synopsis
17724
17725 @smallexample
17726 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
17727 @end smallexample
17728
17729 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
17730 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
17731
17732 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17733
17734 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
17735
17736 @subsubheading Example
17737
17738 @smallexample
17739 (gdb)
17740 -break-disable 2
17741 ^done
17742 (gdb)
17743 -break-list
17744 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
17745 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
17746 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
17747 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
17748 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
17749 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
17750 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
17751 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
17752 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
17753 line="5",times="0"@}]@}
17754 (gdb)
17755 @end smallexample
17756
17757 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
17758 @findex -break-enable
17759
17760 @subsubheading Synopsis
17761
17762 @smallexample
17763 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
17764 @end smallexample
17765
17766 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
17767
17768 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17769
17770 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
17771
17772 @subsubheading Example
17773
17774 @smallexample
17775 (gdb)
17776 -break-enable 2
17777 ^done
17778 (gdb)
17779 -break-list
17780 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
17781 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
17782 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
17783 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
17784 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
17785 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
17786 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
17787 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
17788 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
17789 line="5",times="0"@}]@}
17790 (gdb)
17791 @end smallexample
17792
17793 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
17794 @findex -break-info
17795
17796 @subsubheading Synopsis
17797
17798 @smallexample
17799 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
17800 @end smallexample
17801
17802 @c REDUNDANT???
17803 Get information about a single breakpoint.
17804
17805 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17806
17807 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
17808
17809 @subsubheading Example
17810 N.A.
17811
17812 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
17813 @findex -break-insert
17814
17815 @subsubheading Synopsis
17816
17817 @smallexample
17818 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -r ]
17819 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
17820 [ -p @var{thread} ] [ @var{line} | @var{addr} ]
17821 @end smallexample
17822
17823 @noindent
17824 If specified, @var{line}, can be one of:
17825
17826 @itemize @bullet
17827 @item function
17828 @c @item +offset
17829 @c @item -offset
17830 @c @item linenum
17831 @item filename:linenum
17832 @item filename:function
17833 @item *address
17834 @end itemize
17835
17836 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
17837
17838 @table @samp
17839 @item -t
17840 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
17841 @item -h
17842 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
17843 @item -c @var{condition}
17844 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
17845 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
17846 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
17847 @item -r
17848 Insert a regular breakpoint in all the functions whose names match the
17849 given regular expression. Other flags are not applicable to regular
17850 expressions.
17851 @end table
17852
17853 @subsubheading Result
17854
17855 The result is in the form:
17856
17857 @smallexample
17858 ^done,bkpt=@{number="@var{number}",type="@var{type}",disp="del"|"keep",
17859 enabled="y"|"n",addr="@var{hex}",func="@var{funcname}",file="@var{filename}",
17860 fullname="@var{full_filename}",line="@var{lineno}",[thread="@var{threadno},]
17861 times="@var{times}"@}
17862 @end smallexample
17863
17864 @noindent
17865 where @var{number} is the @value{GDBN} number for this breakpoint,
17866 @var{funcname} is the name of the function where the breakpoint was
17867 inserted, @var{filename} is the name of the source file which contains
17868 this function, @var{lineno} is the source line number within that file
17869 and @var{times} the number of times that the breakpoint has been hit
17870 (always 0 for -break-insert but may be greater for -break-info or -break-list
17871 which use the same output).
17872
17873 Note: this format is open to change.
17874 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
17875
17876 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17877
17878 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
17879 @samp{hbreak}, @samp{thbreak}, and @samp{rbreak}.
17880
17881 @subsubheading Example
17882
17883 @smallexample
17884 (gdb)
17885 -break-insert main
17886 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
17887 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",times="0"@}
17888 (gdb)
17889 -break-insert -t foo
17890 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
17891 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",times="0"@}
17892 (gdb)
17893 -break-list
17894 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
17895 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
17896 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
17897 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
17898 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
17899 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
17900 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
17901 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
17902 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
17903 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",times="0"@},
17904 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
17905 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
17906 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}]@}
17907 (gdb)
17908 -break-insert -r foo.*
17909 ~int foo(int, int);
17910 ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
17911 "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}
17912 (gdb)
17913 @end smallexample
17914
17915 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
17916 @findex -break-list
17917
17918 @subsubheading Synopsis
17919
17920 @smallexample
17921 -break-list
17922 @end smallexample
17923
17924 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
17925
17926 @table @samp
17927 @item Number
17928 number of the breakpoint
17929 @item Type
17930 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
17931 @item Disposition
17932 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
17933 or @samp{nokeep}
17934 @item Enabled
17935 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
17936 @item Address
17937 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
17938 @item What
17939 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
17940 name, line number
17941 @item Times
17942 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
17943 @end table
17944
17945 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
17946 @code{body} field is an empty list.
17947
17948 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17949
17950 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
17951
17952 @subsubheading Example
17953
17954 @smallexample
17955 (gdb)
17956 -break-list
17957 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
17958 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
17959 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
17960 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
17961 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
17962 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
17963 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
17964 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
17965 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",times="0"@},
17966 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
17967 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
17968 line="13",times="0"@}]@}
17969 (gdb)
17970 @end smallexample
17971
17972 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
17973
17974 @smallexample
17975 (gdb)
17976 -break-list
17977 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
17978 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
17979 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
17980 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
17981 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
17982 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
17983 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
17984 body=[]@}
17985 (gdb)
17986 @end smallexample
17987
17988 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
17989 @findex -break-watch
17990
17991 @subsubheading Synopsis
17992
17993 @smallexample
17994 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
17995 @end smallexample
17996
17997 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
17998 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a
17999 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
18000 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will
18001 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
18002 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
18003 i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
18004 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}.
18005
18006 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
18007 breakpoints inserted.
18008
18009 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18010
18011 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
18012 @samp{rwatch}.
18013
18014 @subsubheading Example
18015
18016 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
18017
18018 @smallexample
18019 (gdb)
18020 -break-watch x
18021 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
18022 (gdb)
18023 -exec-continue
18024 ^running
18025 (gdb)
18026 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
18027 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
18028 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
18029 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5"@}
18030 (gdb)
18031 @end smallexample
18032
18033 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
18034 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
18035 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
18036
18037 @smallexample
18038 (gdb)
18039 -break-watch C
18040 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
18041 (gdb)
18042 -exec-continue
18043 ^running
18044 (gdb)
18045 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
18046 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
18047 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
18048 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18049 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
18050 (gdb)
18051 -exec-continue
18052 ^running
18053 (gdb)
18054 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
18055 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
18056 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
18057 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18058 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
18059 (gdb)
18060 @end smallexample
18061
18062 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
18063 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
18064 deleted.
18065
18066 @smallexample
18067 (gdb)
18068 -break-watch C
18069 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
18070 (gdb)
18071 -break-list
18072 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
18073 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18074 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18075 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18076 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18077 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18078 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18079 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18080 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
18081 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18082 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",times="1"@},
18083 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
18084 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="0"@}]@}
18085 (gdb)
18086 -exec-continue
18087 ^running
18088 (gdb)
18089 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
18090 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
18091 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
18092 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18093 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
18094 (gdb)
18095 -break-list
18096 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
18097 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18098 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18099 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18100 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18101 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18102 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18103 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18104 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
18105 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18106 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",times="1"@},
18107 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
18108 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="-5"@}]@}
18109 (gdb)
18110 -exec-continue
18111 ^running
18112 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
18113 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
18114 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
18115 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18116 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
18117 (gdb)
18118 -break-list
18119 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
18120 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18121 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18122 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18123 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18124 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18125 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18126 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18127 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
18128 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18129 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
18130 times="1"@}]@}
18131 (gdb)
18132 @end smallexample
18133
18134 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18135 @node GDB/MI Program Context
18136 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
18137
18138 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
18139 @findex -exec-arguments
18140
18141
18142 @subsubheading Synopsis
18143
18144 @smallexample
18145 -exec-arguments @var{args}
18146 @end smallexample
18147
18148 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
18149 @samp{-exec-run}.
18150
18151 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18152
18153 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
18154
18155 @subsubheading Example
18156
18157 @c FIXME!
18158 Don't have one around.
18159
18160
18161 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
18162 @findex -exec-show-arguments
18163
18164 @subsubheading Synopsis
18165
18166 @smallexample
18167 -exec-show-arguments
18168 @end smallexample
18169
18170 Print the arguments of the program.
18171
18172 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18173
18174 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
18175
18176 @subsubheading Example
18177 N.A.
18178
18179
18180 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
18181 @findex -environment-cd
18182
18183 @subsubheading Synopsis
18184
18185 @smallexample
18186 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
18187 @end smallexample
18188
18189 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
18190
18191 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18192
18193 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
18194
18195 @subsubheading Example
18196
18197 @smallexample
18198 (gdb)
18199 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
18200 ^done
18201 (gdb)
18202 @end smallexample
18203
18204
18205 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
18206 @findex -environment-directory
18207
18208 @subsubheading Synopsis
18209
18210 @smallexample
18211 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
18212 @end smallexample
18213
18214 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
18215 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
18216 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
18217 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
18218 occurs as normal.
18219 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
18220 multiple directories in a single command
18221 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
18222 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
18223 If blanks are needed as
18224 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
18225 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
18226 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
18227 character must not be used
18228 in any directory name.
18229 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
18230
18231 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18232
18233 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
18234
18235 @subsubheading Example
18236
18237 @smallexample
18238 (gdb)
18239 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
18240 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
18241 (gdb)
18242 -environment-directory ""
18243 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
18244 (gdb)
18245 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
18246 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
18247 (gdb)
18248 -environment-directory -r
18249 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
18250 (gdb)
18251 @end smallexample
18252
18253
18254 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
18255 @findex -environment-path
18256
18257 @subsubheading Synopsis
18258
18259 @smallexample
18260 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
18261 @end smallexample
18262
18263 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
18264 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
18265 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
18266 supplied in addition to the
18267 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
18268 occurs as normal.
18269 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
18270 multiple directories in a single command
18271 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
18272 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
18273 If blanks are needed as
18274 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
18275 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
18276 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
18277 character must not be used
18278 in any directory name.
18279 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
18280
18281
18282 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18283
18284 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
18285
18286 @subsubheading Example
18287
18288 @smallexample
18289 (gdb)
18290 -environment-path
18291 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
18292 (gdb)
18293 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
18294 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
18295 (gdb)
18296 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
18297 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
18298 (gdb)
18299 @end smallexample
18300
18301
18302 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
18303 @findex -environment-pwd
18304
18305 @subsubheading Synopsis
18306
18307 @smallexample
18308 -environment-pwd
18309 @end smallexample
18310
18311 Show the current working directory.
18312
18313 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18314
18315 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
18316
18317 @subsubheading Example
18318
18319 @smallexample
18320 (gdb)
18321 -environment-pwd
18322 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
18323 (gdb)
18324 @end smallexample
18325
18326 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18327 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
18328 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
18329
18330
18331 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
18332 @findex -thread-info
18333
18334 @subsubheading Synopsis
18335
18336 @smallexample
18337 -thread-info
18338 @end smallexample
18339
18340 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18341
18342 No equivalent.
18343
18344 @subsubheading Example
18345 N.A.
18346
18347
18348 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-all-threads} Command
18349 @findex -thread-list-all-threads
18350
18351 @subsubheading Synopsis
18352
18353 @smallexample
18354 -thread-list-all-threads
18355 @end smallexample
18356
18357 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18358
18359 The equivalent @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info threads}.
18360
18361 @subsubheading Example
18362 N.A.
18363
18364
18365 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
18366 @findex -thread-list-ids
18367
18368 @subsubheading Synopsis
18369
18370 @smallexample
18371 -thread-list-ids
18372 @end smallexample
18373
18374 Produces a list of the currently known @value{GDBN} thread ids. At the
18375 end of the list it also prints the total number of such threads.
18376
18377 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18378
18379 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
18380
18381 @subsubheading Example
18382
18383 No threads present, besides the main process:
18384
18385 @smallexample
18386 (gdb)
18387 -thread-list-ids
18388 ^done,thread-ids=@{@},number-of-threads="0"
18389 (gdb)
18390 @end smallexample
18391
18392
18393 Several threads:
18394
18395 @smallexample
18396 (gdb)
18397 -thread-list-ids
18398 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
18399 number-of-threads="3"
18400 (gdb)
18401 @end smallexample
18402
18403
18404 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
18405 @findex -thread-select
18406
18407 @subsubheading Synopsis
18408
18409 @smallexample
18410 -thread-select @var{threadnum}
18411 @end smallexample
18412
18413 Make @var{threadnum} the current thread. It prints the number of the new
18414 current thread, and the topmost frame for that thread.
18415
18416 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18417
18418 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
18419
18420 @subsubheading Example
18421
18422 @smallexample
18423 (gdb)
18424 -exec-next
18425 ^running
18426 (gdb)
18427 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
18428 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
18429 (gdb)
18430 -thread-list-ids
18431 ^done,
18432 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
18433 number-of-threads="3"
18434 (gdb)
18435 -thread-select 3
18436 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
18437 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
18438 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
18439 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@}
18440 (gdb)
18441 @end smallexample
18442
18443 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18444 @node GDB/MI Program Execution
18445 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
18446
18447 These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
18448 record @samp{*stopped}. Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes
18449 asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
18450 other cases.
18451
18452 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
18453 @findex -exec-continue
18454
18455 @subsubheading Synopsis
18456
18457 @smallexample
18458 -exec-continue
18459 @end smallexample
18460
18461 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until a breakpoint is
18462 encountered, or until the inferior exits.
18463
18464 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18465
18466 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
18467
18468 @subsubheading Example
18469
18470 @smallexample
18471 -exec-continue
18472 ^running
18473 (gdb)
18474 @@Hello world
18475 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="2",frame=@{func="foo",args=[],
18476 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="13"@}
18477 (gdb)
18478 @end smallexample
18479
18480
18481 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
18482 @findex -exec-finish
18483
18484 @subsubheading Synopsis
18485
18486 @smallexample
18487 -exec-finish
18488 @end smallexample
18489
18490 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
18491 function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
18492
18493 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18494
18495 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
18496
18497 @subsubheading Example
18498
18499 Function returning @code{void}.
18500
18501 @smallexample
18502 -exec-finish
18503 ^running
18504 (gdb)
18505 @@hello from foo
18506 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
18507 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7"@}
18508 (gdb)
18509 @end smallexample
18510
18511 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
18512 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
18513 value itself.
18514
18515 @smallexample
18516 -exec-finish
18517 ^running
18518 (gdb)
18519 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
18520 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
18521 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
18522 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
18523 (gdb)
18524 @end smallexample
18525
18526
18527 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
18528 @findex -exec-interrupt
18529
18530 @subsubheading Synopsis
18531
18532 @smallexample
18533 -exec-interrupt
18534 @end smallexample
18535
18536 Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
18537 associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
18538 that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
18539 appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
18540 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
18541
18542 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18543
18544 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
18545
18546 @subsubheading Example
18547
18548 @smallexample
18549 (gdb)
18550 111-exec-continue
18551 111^running
18552
18553 (gdb)
18554 222-exec-interrupt
18555 222^done
18556 (gdb)
18557 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
18558 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
18559 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13"@}
18560 (gdb)
18561
18562 (gdb)
18563 -exec-interrupt
18564 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
18565 (gdb)
18566 @end smallexample
18567
18568
18569 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
18570 @findex -exec-next
18571
18572 @subsubheading Synopsis
18573
18574 @smallexample
18575 -exec-next
18576 @end smallexample
18577
18578 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
18579 of the next source line is reached.
18580
18581 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18582
18583 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
18584
18585 @subsubheading Example
18586
18587 @smallexample
18588 -exec-next
18589 ^running
18590 (gdb)
18591 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
18592 (gdb)
18593 @end smallexample
18594
18595
18596 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
18597 @findex -exec-next-instruction
18598
18599 @subsubheading Synopsis
18600
18601 @smallexample
18602 -exec-next-instruction
18603 @end smallexample
18604
18605 Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
18606 call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
18607 instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
18608 printed as well.
18609
18610 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18611
18612 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
18613
18614 @subsubheading Example
18615
18616 @smallexample
18617 (gdb)
18618 -exec-next-instruction
18619 ^running
18620
18621 (gdb)
18622 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
18623 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
18624 (gdb)
18625 @end smallexample
18626
18627
18628 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
18629 @findex -exec-return
18630
18631 @subsubheading Synopsis
18632
18633 @smallexample
18634 -exec-return
18635 @end smallexample
18636
18637 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
18638 Displays the new current frame.
18639
18640 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18641
18642 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
18643
18644 @subsubheading Example
18645
18646 @smallexample
18647 (gdb)
18648 200-break-insert callee4
18649 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
18650 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
18651 (gdb)
18652 000-exec-run
18653 000^running
18654 (gdb)
18655 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",
18656 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
18657 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18658 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
18659 (gdb)
18660 205-break-delete
18661 205^done
18662 (gdb)
18663 111-exec-return
18664 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
18665 args=[@{name="strarg",
18666 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
18667 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18668 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
18669 (gdb)
18670 @end smallexample
18671
18672
18673 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
18674 @findex -exec-run
18675
18676 @subsubheading Synopsis
18677
18678 @smallexample
18679 -exec-run
18680 @end smallexample
18681
18682 Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
18683 executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
18684 exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
18685 the program has exited exceptionally.
18686
18687 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18688
18689 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
18690
18691 @subsubheading Examples
18692
18693 @smallexample
18694 (gdb)
18695 -break-insert main
18696 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
18697 (gdb)
18698 -exec-run
18699 ^running
18700 (gdb)
18701 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",
18702 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
18703 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}
18704 (gdb)
18705 @end smallexample
18706
18707 @noindent
18708 Program exited normally:
18709
18710 @smallexample
18711 (gdb)
18712 -exec-run
18713 ^running
18714 (gdb)
18715 x = 55
18716 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
18717 (gdb)
18718 @end smallexample
18719
18720 @noindent
18721 Program exited exceptionally:
18722
18723 @smallexample
18724 (gdb)
18725 -exec-run
18726 ^running
18727 (gdb)
18728 x = 55
18729 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
18730 (gdb)
18731 @end smallexample
18732
18733 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
18734 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
18735
18736 @smallexample
18737 (gdb)
18738 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
18739 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
18740 @end smallexample
18741
18742
18743 @c @subheading -exec-signal
18744
18745
18746 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
18747 @findex -exec-step
18748
18749 @subsubheading Synopsis
18750
18751 @smallexample
18752 -exec-step
18753 @end smallexample
18754
18755 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
18756 of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
18757 function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
18758 function.
18759
18760 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18761
18762 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
18763
18764 @subsubheading Example
18765
18766 Stepping into a function:
18767
18768 @smallexample
18769 -exec-step
18770 ^running
18771 (gdb)
18772 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
18773 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
18774 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
18775 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@}
18776 (gdb)
18777 @end smallexample
18778
18779 Regular stepping:
18780
18781 @smallexample
18782 -exec-step
18783 ^running
18784 (gdb)
18785 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
18786 (gdb)
18787 @end smallexample
18788
18789
18790 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
18791 @findex -exec-step-instruction
18792
18793 @subsubheading Synopsis
18794
18795 @smallexample
18796 -exec-step-instruction
18797 @end smallexample
18798
18799 Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. The
18800 output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on whether
18801 we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the former
18802 case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed as
18803 well.
18804
18805 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18806
18807 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
18808
18809 @subsubheading Example
18810
18811 @smallexample
18812 (gdb)
18813 -exec-step-instruction
18814 ^running
18815
18816 (gdb)
18817 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
18818 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
18819 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
18820 (gdb)
18821 -exec-step-instruction
18822 ^running
18823
18824 (gdb)
18825 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
18826 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
18827 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
18828 (gdb)
18829 @end smallexample
18830
18831
18832 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
18833 @findex -exec-until
18834
18835 @subsubheading Synopsis
18836
18837 @smallexample
18838 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
18839 @end smallexample
18840
18841 Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
18842 argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
18843 until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
18844 reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
18845
18846 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18847
18848 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
18849
18850 @subsubheading Example
18851
18852 @smallexample
18853 (gdb)
18854 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
18855 ^running
18856 (gdb)
18857 x = 55
18858 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
18859 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6"@}
18860 (gdb)
18861 @end smallexample
18862
18863 @ignore
18864 @subheading -file-clear
18865 Is this going away????
18866 @end ignore
18867
18868 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18869 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
18870 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
18871
18872
18873 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
18874 @findex -stack-info-frame
18875
18876 @subsubheading Synopsis
18877
18878 @smallexample
18879 -stack-info-frame
18880 @end smallexample
18881
18882 Get info on the selected frame.
18883
18884 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18885
18886 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
18887 (without arguments).
18888
18889 @subsubheading Example
18890
18891 @smallexample
18892 (gdb)
18893 -stack-info-frame
18894 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
18895 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18896 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@}
18897 (gdb)
18898 @end smallexample
18899
18900 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
18901 @findex -stack-info-depth
18902
18903 @subsubheading Synopsis
18904
18905 @smallexample
18906 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
18907 @end smallexample
18908
18909 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
18910 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
18911
18912 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18913
18914 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
18915
18916 @subsubheading Example
18917
18918 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
18919
18920 @smallexample
18921 (gdb)
18922 -stack-info-depth
18923 ^done,depth="12"
18924 (gdb)
18925 -stack-info-depth 4
18926 ^done,depth="4"
18927 (gdb)
18928 -stack-info-depth 12
18929 ^done,depth="12"
18930 (gdb)
18931 -stack-info-depth 11
18932 ^done,depth="11"
18933 (gdb)
18934 -stack-info-depth 13
18935 ^done,depth="12"
18936 (gdb)
18937 @end smallexample
18938
18939 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
18940 @findex -stack-list-arguments
18941
18942 @subsubheading Synopsis
18943
18944 @smallexample
18945 -stack-list-arguments @var{show-values}
18946 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
18947 @end smallexample
18948
18949 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
18950 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
18951 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
18952 call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
18953 at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
18954 larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
18955 @var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
18956 which case only existing frames will be returned.
18957
18958 The @var{show-values} argument must have a value of 0 or 1. A value of
18959 0 means that only the names of the arguments are listed, a value of 1
18960 means that both names and values of the arguments are printed.
18961
18962 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18963
18964 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
18965 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
18966 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
18967
18968 @subsubheading Example
18969
18970 @smallexample
18971 (gdb)
18972 -stack-list-frames
18973 ^done,
18974 stack=[
18975 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
18976 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18977 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@},
18978 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
18979 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18980 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@},
18981 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
18982 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18983 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@},
18984 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
18985 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18986 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@},
18987 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
18988 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18989 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}]
18990 (gdb)
18991 -stack-list-arguments 0
18992 ^done,
18993 stack-args=[
18994 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
18995 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
18996 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
18997 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
18998 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
18999 (gdb)
19000 -stack-list-arguments 1
19001 ^done,
19002 stack-args=[
19003 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
19004 frame=@{level="1",
19005 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
19006 frame=@{level="2",args=[
19007 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
19008 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
19009 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
19010 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
19011 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
19012 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
19013 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
19014 (gdb)
19015 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
19016 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
19017 (gdb)
19018 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
19019 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
19020 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
19021 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
19022 (gdb)
19023 @end smallexample
19024
19025 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
19026
19027
19028 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
19029 @findex -stack-list-frames
19030
19031 @subsubheading Synopsis
19032
19033 @smallexample
19034 -stack-list-frames [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
19035 @end smallexample
19036
19037 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
19038 following info:
19039
19040 @table @samp
19041 @item @var{level}
19042 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function.
19043 @item @var{addr}
19044 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
19045 @item @var{func}
19046 Function name.
19047 @item @var{file}
19048 File name of the source file where the function lives.
19049 @item @var{line}
19050 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
19051 @end table
19052
19053 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
19054 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
19055 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
19056 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
19057 an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
19058 frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
19059 actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be returned.
19060
19061 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19062
19063 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
19064
19065 @subsubheading Example
19066
19067 Full stack backtrace:
19068
19069 @smallexample
19070 (gdb)
19071 -stack-list-frames
19072 ^done,stack=
19073 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
19074 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@},
19075 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19076 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19077 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19078 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19079 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19080 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19081 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19082 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19083 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19084 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19085 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19086 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19087 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19088 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19089 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19090 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19091 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19092 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19093 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19094 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19095 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
19096 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}]
19097 (gdb)
19098 @end smallexample
19099
19100 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
19101
19102 @smallexample
19103 (gdb)
19104 -stack-list-frames 3 5
19105 ^done,stack=
19106 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19107 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19108 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19109 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19110 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19111 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
19112 (gdb)
19113 @end smallexample
19114
19115 Show a single frame:
19116
19117 @smallexample
19118 (gdb)
19119 -stack-list-frames 3 3
19120 ^done,stack=
19121 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19122 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
19123 (gdb)
19124 @end smallexample
19125
19126
19127 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
19128 @findex -stack-list-locals
19129
19130 @subsubheading Synopsis
19131
19132 @smallexample
19133 -stack-list-locals @var{print-values}
19134 @end smallexample
19135
19136 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
19137 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
19138 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
19139 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
19140 type and value for simple data types and the name and type for arrays,
19141 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
19142 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
19143 other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in
19144 more detail.
19145
19146 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19147
19148 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
19149
19150 @subsubheading Example
19151
19152 @smallexample
19153 (gdb)
19154 -stack-list-locals 0
19155 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
19156 (gdb)
19157 -stack-list-locals --all-values
19158 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
19159 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
19160 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
19161 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
19162 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
19163 (gdb)
19164 @end smallexample
19165
19166
19167 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
19168 @findex -stack-select-frame
19169
19170 @subsubheading Synopsis
19171
19172 @smallexample
19173 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
19174 @end smallexample
19175
19176 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
19177 the stack.
19178
19179 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19180
19181 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
19182 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
19183
19184 @subsubheading Example
19185
19186 @smallexample
19187 (gdb)
19188 -stack-select-frame 2
19189 ^done
19190 (gdb)
19191 @end smallexample
19192
19193 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19194 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
19195 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
19196
19197 @ignore
19198
19199 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
19200
19201 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
19202 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
19203 used by @code{Insight}.
19204
19205 The two main reasons for that are:
19206
19207 @enumerate 1
19208 @item
19209 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
19210
19211 @item
19212 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
19213 now).
19214 @end enumerate
19215
19216 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
19217 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
19218 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
19219 hints about their use.
19220
19221 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
19222 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
19223 least, the following operations:
19224
19225 @itemize @bullet
19226 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
19227 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
19228 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
19229 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
19230 @end itemize
19231
19232 @end ignore
19233
19234 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
19235
19236 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
19237
19238 Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
19239 changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that
19240 work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
19241 simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object
19242 is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the
19243 frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The
19244 expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
19245 expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a
19246 variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
19247 operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
19248 object, or to change display format.
19249
19250 Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object
19251 that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
19252 a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
19253 element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have
19254 children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach
19255 leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types. Child variable
19256 objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend
19257 is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no
19258 child will be created.
19259
19260 For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
19261 string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also
19262 obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
19263 that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
19264 contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
19265
19266 A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
19267 the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
19268 variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
19269 operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
19270 be transferred to the frontend. As noted above, children variable
19271 objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a
19272 real value. As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf
19273 variables that frontend has created.
19274
19275 The automatic update is not always desirable. For example, a frontend
19276 might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference,
19277 and never update it. For another example, fetching memory is
19278 relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want
19279 to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not
19280 visible on the screen, or ``closed''. This is possible using so
19281 called ``frozen variable objects''. Such variable objects are never
19282 implicitly updated.
19283
19284 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
19285 access this functionality:
19286
19287 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
19288 @item @strong{Operation}
19289 @tab @strong{Description}
19290
19291 @item @code{-var-create}
19292 @tab create a variable object
19293 @item @code{-var-delete}
19294 @tab delete the variable object and/or its children
19295 @item @code{-var-set-format}
19296 @tab set the display format of this variable
19297 @item @code{-var-show-format}
19298 @tab show the display format of this variable
19299 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
19300 @tab tells how many children this object has
19301 @item @code{-var-list-children}
19302 @tab return a list of the object's children
19303 @item @code{-var-info-type}
19304 @tab show the type of this variable object
19305 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
19306 @tab print what this variable object represents
19307 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
19308 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
19309 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
19310 @tab get the value of this variable
19311 @item @code{-var-assign}
19312 @tab set the value of this variable
19313 @item @code{-var-update}
19314 @tab update the variable and its children
19315 @item @code{-var-set-frozen}
19316 @tab set frozeness attribute
19317 @end multitable
19318
19319 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
19320 how it can be used.
19321
19322 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
19323
19324 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
19325 @findex -var-create
19326
19327 @subsubheading Synopsis
19328
19329 @smallexample
19330 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
19331 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*"@} @var{expression}
19332 @end smallexample
19333
19334 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
19335 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
19336 register.
19337
19338 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
19339 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
19340 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
19341 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} on that format.
19342 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
19343
19344 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
19345 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
19346 frame should be used.
19347
19348 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
19349 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
19350
19351 @itemize @bullet
19352 @item
19353 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
19354
19355 @item
19356 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
19357
19358 @item
19359 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
19360 @end itemize
19361
19362 @subsubheading Result
19363
19364 This operation returns the name, number of children and the type of the
19365 object created. Type is returned as a string as the ones generated by
19366 the @value{GDBN} CLI:
19367
19368 @smallexample
19369 name="@var{name}",numchild="N",type="@var{type}"
19370 @end smallexample
19371
19372
19373 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
19374 @findex -var-delete
19375
19376 @subsubheading Synopsis
19377
19378 @smallexample
19379 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
19380 @end smallexample
19381
19382 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
19383 With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
19384
19385 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
19386
19387
19388 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
19389 @findex -var-set-format
19390
19391 @subsubheading Synopsis
19392
19393 @smallexample
19394 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
19395 @end smallexample
19396
19397 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
19398 @var{format-spec}.
19399
19400 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
19401
19402 @smallexample
19403 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
19404 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural@}
19405 @end smallexample
19406
19407 The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
19408 based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
19409 for pointers, etc.).
19410
19411 For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
19412 variable itself, and the children are not affected.
19413
19414 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
19415 @findex -var-show-format
19416
19417 @subsubheading Synopsis
19418
19419 @smallexample
19420 -var-show-format @var{name}
19421 @end smallexample
19422
19423 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
19424
19425 @smallexample
19426 @var{format} @expansion{}
19427 @var{format-spec}
19428 @end smallexample
19429
19430
19431 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
19432 @findex -var-info-num-children
19433
19434 @subsubheading Synopsis
19435
19436 @smallexample
19437 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
19438 @end smallexample
19439
19440 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
19441
19442 @smallexample
19443 numchild=@var{n}
19444 @end smallexample
19445
19446
19447 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
19448 @findex -var-list-children
19449
19450 @subsubheading Synopsis
19451
19452 @smallexample
19453 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name}
19454 @end smallexample
19455 @anchor{-var-list-children}
19456
19457 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
19458 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
19459 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value for of 0 or
19460 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
19461 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
19462 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
19463 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
19464 and unions.
19465
19466 @subsubheading Example
19467
19468 @smallexample
19469 (gdb)
19470 -var-list-children n
19471 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[@{name=@var{name},
19472 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
19473 (gdb)
19474 -var-list-children --all-values n
19475 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[@{name=@var{name},
19476 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
19477 @end smallexample
19478
19479
19480 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
19481 @findex -var-info-type
19482
19483 @subsubheading Synopsis
19484
19485 @smallexample
19486 -var-info-type @var{name}
19487 @end smallexample
19488
19489 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
19490 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
19491 @value{GDBN} CLI:
19492
19493 @smallexample
19494 type=@var{typename}
19495 @end smallexample
19496
19497
19498 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
19499 @findex -var-info-expression
19500
19501 @subsubheading Synopsis
19502
19503 @smallexample
19504 -var-info-expression @var{name}
19505 @end smallexample
19506
19507 Returns what is represented by the variable object @var{name}:
19508
19509 @smallexample
19510 lang=@var{lang-spec},exp=@var{expression}
19511 @end smallexample
19512
19513 @noindent
19514 where @var{lang-spec} is @code{@{"C" | "C++" | "Java"@}}.
19515
19516 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
19517 @findex -var-show-attributes
19518
19519 @subsubheading Synopsis
19520
19521 @smallexample
19522 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
19523 @end smallexample
19524
19525 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
19526
19527 @smallexample
19528 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
19529 @end smallexample
19530
19531 @noindent
19532 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
19533
19534 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
19535 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
19536
19537 @subsubheading Synopsis
19538
19539 @smallexample
19540 -var-evaluate-expression @var{name}
19541 @end smallexample
19542
19543 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
19544 object and returns its value as a string. The format of the
19545 string can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
19546
19547 @smallexample
19548 value=@var{value}
19549 @end smallexample
19550
19551 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
19552 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
19553
19554 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
19555 @findex -var-assign
19556
19557 @subsubheading Synopsis
19558
19559 @smallexample
19560 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
19561 @end smallexample
19562
19563 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
19564 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
19565 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
19566 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
19567
19568 @subsubheading Example
19569
19570 @smallexample
19571 (gdb)
19572 -var-assign var1 3
19573 ^done,value="3"
19574 (gdb)
19575 -var-update *
19576 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
19577 (gdb)
19578 @end smallexample
19579
19580 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
19581 @findex -var-update
19582
19583 @subsubheading Synopsis
19584
19585 @smallexample
19586 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
19587 @end smallexample
19588
19589 Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
19590 @var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
19591 list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must
19592 be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of
19593 @code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the
19594 @code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable
19595 object names, all existing variable objects are updated, except
19596 for frozen ones (@pxref{-var-set-frozen}). The option
19597 @var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just
19598 names are printed. The possible values of this options are the same
19599 as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is
19600 recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the
19601 number of MI commands needed on each program stop.
19602
19603
19604 @subsubheading Example
19605
19606 @smallexample
19607 (gdb)
19608 -var-assign var1 3
19609 ^done,value="3"
19610 (gdb)
19611 -var-update --all-values var1
19612 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
19613 type_changed="false"@}]
19614 (gdb)
19615 @end smallexample
19616
19617 @anchor{-var-update}
19618 The field in_scope may take three values:
19619
19620 @table @code
19621 @item "true"
19622 The variable object's current value is valid.
19623
19624 @item "false"
19625 The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
19626 hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
19627 scope.
19628
19629 @item "invalid"
19630 The variable object no longer holds a valid value.
19631 This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed,
19632 either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file}
19633 command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable
19634 objects.
19635 @end table
19636
19637 In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should
19638 be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}.
19639
19640 @subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command
19641 @findex -var-set-frozen
19642 @anchor{-var-set-frozen}
19643
19644 @subsubheading Synopsis
19645
19646 @smallexample
19647 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @var{flag}
19648 @end smallexample
19649
19650 Set the frozenness flag on the variable object @var{name}. The
19651 @var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable
19652 frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfrozen. If a variable object is
19653 frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are
19654 implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} of
19655 a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}. Only
19656 @code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and
19657 values of its children. After a variable object is unfrozen, it is
19658 implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations.
19659 Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent
19660 @code{-var-update} does.
19661
19662 @subsubheading Example
19663
19664 @smallexample
19665 (gdb)
19666 -var-set-frozen V 1
19667 ^done
19668 (gdb)
19669 @end smallexample
19670
19671
19672 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19673 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
19674 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
19675
19676 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
19677 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
19678 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
19679 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
19680
19681 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
19682 @c @subheading -data-assign
19683 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
19684 @c @subsubheading GDB Command
19685 @c set variable
19686 @c @subsubheading Example
19687 @c N.A.
19688
19689 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
19690 @findex -data-disassemble
19691
19692 @subsubheading Synopsis
19693
19694 @smallexample
19695 -data-disassemble
19696 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
19697 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
19698 -- @var{mode}
19699 @end smallexample
19700
19701 @noindent
19702 Where:
19703
19704 @table @samp
19705 @item @var{start-addr}
19706 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
19707 @item @var{end-addr}
19708 is the end address
19709 @item @var{filename}
19710 is the name of the file to disassemble
19711 @item @var{linenum}
19712 is the line number to disassemble around
19713 @item @var{lines}
19714 is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
19715 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
19716 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
19717 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
19718 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
19719 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
19720 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
19721 are displayed.
19722 @item @var{mode}
19723 is either 0 (meaning only disassembly) or 1 (meaning mixed source and
19724 disassembly).
19725 @end table
19726
19727 @subsubheading Result
19728
19729 The output for each instruction is composed of four fields:
19730
19731 @itemize @bullet
19732 @item Address
19733 @item Func-name
19734 @item Offset
19735 @item Instruction
19736 @end itemize
19737
19738 Note that whatever included in the instruction field, is not manipulated
19739 directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to adjust its format.
19740
19741 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19742
19743 There's no direct mapping from this command to the CLI.
19744
19745 @subsubheading Example
19746
19747 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
19748
19749 @smallexample
19750 (gdb)
19751 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
19752 ^done,
19753 asm_insns=[
19754 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
19755 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
19756 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
19757 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
19758 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
19759 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
19760 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
19761 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
19762 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
19763 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
19764 (gdb)
19765 @end smallexample
19766
19767 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
19768 @code{main}.
19769
19770 @smallexample
19771 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
19772 ^done,asm_insns=[
19773 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
19774 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
19775 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
19776 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
19777 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
19778 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
19779 [@dots{}]
19780 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
19781 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
19782 (gdb)
19783 @end smallexample
19784
19785 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
19786
19787 @smallexample
19788 (gdb)
19789 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
19790 ^done,asm_insns=[
19791 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
19792 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
19793 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
19794 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
19795 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
19796 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
19797 (gdb)
19798 @end smallexample
19799
19800 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
19801
19802 @smallexample
19803 (gdb)
19804 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
19805 ^done,asm_insns=[
19806 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
19807 file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
19808 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
19809 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
19810 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
19811 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
19812 file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
19813 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
19814 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
19815 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
19816 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
19817 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
19818 (gdb)
19819 @end smallexample
19820
19821
19822 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
19823 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
19824
19825 @subsubheading Synopsis
19826
19827 @smallexample
19828 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
19829 @end smallexample
19830
19831 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
19832 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
19833 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
19834
19835 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19836
19837 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
19838 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
19839 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
19840
19841 @subsubheading Example
19842
19843 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
19844 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
19845 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
19846 output.
19847
19848 @smallexample
19849 211-data-evaluate-expression A
19850 211^done,value="1"
19851 (gdb)
19852 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
19853 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
19854 (gdb)
19855 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
19856 411^done,value="4"
19857 (gdb)
19858 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
19859 511^done,value="4"
19860 (gdb)
19861 @end smallexample
19862
19863
19864 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
19865 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
19866
19867 @subsubheading Synopsis
19868
19869 @smallexample
19870 -data-list-changed-registers
19871 @end smallexample
19872
19873 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
19874
19875 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19876
19877 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
19878 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
19879
19880 @subsubheading Example
19881
19882 On a PPC MBX board:
19883
19884 @smallexample
19885 (gdb)
19886 -exec-continue
19887 ^running
19888
19889 (gdb)
19890 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",frame=@{func="main",
19891 args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="5"@}
19892 (gdb)
19893 -data-list-changed-registers
19894 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
19895 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
19896 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
19897 (gdb)
19898 @end smallexample
19899
19900
19901 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
19902 @findex -data-list-register-names
19903
19904 @subsubheading Synopsis
19905
19906 @smallexample
19907 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
19908 @end smallexample
19909
19910 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
19911 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
19912 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
19913 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
19914 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
19915 include empty register names.
19916
19917 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19918
19919 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
19920 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
19921 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
19922
19923 @subsubheading Example
19924
19925 For the PPC MBX board:
19926 @smallexample
19927 (gdb)
19928 -data-list-register-names
19929 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
19930 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
19931 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
19932 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
19933 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
19934 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
19935 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
19936 (gdb)
19937 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
19938 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
19939 (gdb)
19940 @end smallexample
19941
19942 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
19943 @findex -data-list-register-values
19944
19945 @subsubheading Synopsis
19946
19947 @smallexample
19948 -data-list-register-values @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
19949 @end smallexample
19950
19951 Display the registers' contents. @var{fmt} is the format according to
19952 which the registers' contents are to be returned, followed by an optional
19953 list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A missing list of
19954 numbers indicates that the contents of all the registers must be returned.
19955
19956 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
19957
19958 @table @code
19959 @item x
19960 Hexadecimal
19961 @item o
19962 Octal
19963 @item t
19964 Binary
19965 @item d
19966 Decimal
19967 @item r
19968 Raw
19969 @item N
19970 Natural
19971 @end table
19972
19973 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19974
19975 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
19976 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
19977
19978 @subsubheading Example
19979
19980 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
19981 don't appear in the actual output):
19982
19983 @smallexample
19984 (gdb)
19985 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
19986 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
19987 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
19988 (gdb)
19989 -data-list-register-values x
19990 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
19991 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
19992 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
19993 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
19994 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
19995 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
19996 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
19997 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
19998 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
19999 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
20000 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
20001 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
20002 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
20003 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
20004 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
20005 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
20006 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
20007 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
20008 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
20009 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
20010 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
20011 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
20012 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
20013 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
20014 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
20015 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
20016 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
20017 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
20018 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
20019 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
20020 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
20021 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
20022 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
20023 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
20024 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
20025 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
20026 (gdb)
20027 @end smallexample
20028
20029
20030 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
20031 @findex -data-read-memory
20032
20033 @subsubheading Synopsis
20034
20035 @smallexample
20036 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
20037 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
20038 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
20039 @end smallexample
20040
20041 @noindent
20042 where:
20043
20044 @table @samp
20045 @item @var{address}
20046 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
20047 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
20048 quoted using the C convention.
20049
20050 @item @var{word-format}
20051 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
20052 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
20053 ,Output Formats}).
20054
20055 @item @var{word-size}
20056 The size of each memory word in bytes.
20057
20058 @item @var{nr-rows}
20059 The number of rows in the output table.
20060
20061 @item @var{nr-cols}
20062 The number of columns in the output table.
20063
20064 @item @var{aschar}
20065 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
20066 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
20067 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
20068 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
20069
20070 @item @var{byte-offset}
20071 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
20072 @end table
20073
20074 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
20075 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
20076 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
20077 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
20078 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
20079 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
20080 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
20081 @samp{addr}.
20082
20083 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
20084 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
20085 @samp{prev-page}.
20086
20087 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20088
20089 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
20090 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
20091
20092 @subsubheading Example
20093
20094 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
20095 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
20096 word. Display each word in hex.
20097
20098 @smallexample
20099 (gdb)
20100 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
20101 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
20102 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
20103 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
20104 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
20105 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
20106 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
20107 (gdb)
20108 @end smallexample
20109
20110 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
20111 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
20112
20113 @smallexample
20114 (gdb)
20115 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
20116 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
20117 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
20118 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
20119 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
20120 (gdb)
20121 @end smallexample
20122
20123 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
20124 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
20125 used as the non-printable character.
20126
20127 @smallexample
20128 (gdb)
20129 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
20130 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
20131 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
20132 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
20133 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
20134 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
20135 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
20136 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
20137 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
20138 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
20139 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
20140 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
20141 (gdb)
20142 @end smallexample
20143
20144 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20145 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
20146 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
20147
20148 The tracepoint commands are not yet implemented.
20149
20150 @c @subheading -trace-actions
20151
20152 @c @subheading -trace-delete
20153
20154 @c @subheading -trace-disable
20155
20156 @c @subheading -trace-dump
20157
20158 @c @subheading -trace-enable
20159
20160 @c @subheading -trace-exists
20161
20162 @c @subheading -trace-find
20163
20164 @c @subheading -trace-frame-number
20165
20166 @c @subheading -trace-info
20167
20168 @c @subheading -trace-insert
20169
20170 @c @subheading -trace-list
20171
20172 @c @subheading -trace-pass-count
20173
20174 @c @subheading -trace-save
20175
20176 @c @subheading -trace-start
20177
20178 @c @subheading -trace-stop
20179
20180
20181 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20182 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
20183 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
20184
20185
20186 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
20187 @findex -symbol-info-address
20188
20189 @subsubheading Synopsis
20190
20191 @smallexample
20192 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
20193 @end smallexample
20194
20195 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
20196
20197 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20198
20199 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
20200
20201 @subsubheading Example
20202 N.A.
20203
20204
20205 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
20206 @findex -symbol-info-file
20207
20208 @subsubheading Synopsis
20209
20210 @smallexample
20211 -symbol-info-file
20212 @end smallexample
20213
20214 Show the file for the symbol.
20215
20216 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20217
20218 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
20219 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
20220
20221 @subsubheading Example
20222 N.A.
20223
20224
20225 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
20226 @findex -symbol-info-function
20227
20228 @subsubheading Synopsis
20229
20230 @smallexample
20231 -symbol-info-function
20232 @end smallexample
20233
20234 Show which function the symbol lives in.
20235
20236 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20237
20238 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
20239
20240 @subsubheading Example
20241 N.A.
20242
20243
20244 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
20245 @findex -symbol-info-line
20246
20247 @subsubheading Synopsis
20248
20249 @smallexample
20250 -symbol-info-line
20251 @end smallexample
20252
20253 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
20254
20255 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20256
20257 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
20258 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
20259
20260 @subsubheading Example
20261 N.A.
20262
20263
20264 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
20265 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
20266
20267 @subsubheading Synopsis
20268
20269 @smallexample
20270 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
20271 @end smallexample
20272
20273 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
20274
20275 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20276
20277 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
20278
20279 @subsubheading Example
20280 N.A.
20281
20282
20283 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
20284 @findex -symbol-list-functions
20285
20286 @subsubheading Synopsis
20287
20288 @smallexample
20289 -symbol-list-functions
20290 @end smallexample
20291
20292 List the functions in the executable.
20293
20294 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20295
20296 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
20297 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
20298
20299 @subsubheading Example
20300 N.A.
20301
20302
20303 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
20304 @findex -symbol-list-lines
20305
20306 @subsubheading Synopsis
20307
20308 @smallexample
20309 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
20310 @end smallexample
20311
20312 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
20313 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
20314 ascending PC order.
20315
20316 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20317
20318 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
20319
20320 @subsubheading Example
20321 @smallexample
20322 (gdb)
20323 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
20324 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
20325 (gdb)
20326 @end smallexample
20327
20328
20329 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
20330 @findex -symbol-list-types
20331
20332 @subsubheading Synopsis
20333
20334 @smallexample
20335 -symbol-list-types
20336 @end smallexample
20337
20338 List all the type names.
20339
20340 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20341
20342 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
20343 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
20344
20345 @subsubheading Example
20346 N.A.
20347
20348
20349 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
20350 @findex -symbol-list-variables
20351
20352 @subsubheading Synopsis
20353
20354 @smallexample
20355 -symbol-list-variables
20356 @end smallexample
20357
20358 List all the global and static variable names.
20359
20360 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20361
20362 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
20363
20364 @subsubheading Example
20365 N.A.
20366
20367
20368 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
20369 @findex -symbol-locate
20370
20371 @subsubheading Synopsis
20372
20373 @smallexample
20374 -symbol-locate
20375 @end smallexample
20376
20377 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20378
20379 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
20380
20381 @subsubheading Example
20382 N.A.
20383
20384
20385 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
20386 @findex -symbol-type
20387
20388 @subsubheading Synopsis
20389
20390 @smallexample
20391 -symbol-type @var{variable}
20392 @end smallexample
20393
20394 Show type of @var{variable}.
20395
20396 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20397
20398 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
20399 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
20400
20401 @subsubheading Example
20402 N.A.
20403
20404
20405 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20406 @node GDB/MI File Commands
20407 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
20408
20409 This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
20410 and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
20411
20412 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
20413 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
20414
20415 @subsubheading Synopsis
20416
20417 @smallexample
20418 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
20419 @end smallexample
20420
20421 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
20422 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
20423 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
20424 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
20425 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
20426 notification.
20427
20428 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20429
20430 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
20431
20432 @subsubheading Example
20433
20434 @smallexample
20435 (gdb)
20436 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
20437 ^done
20438 (gdb)
20439 @end smallexample
20440
20441
20442 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
20443 @findex -file-exec-file
20444
20445 @subsubheading Synopsis
20446
20447 @smallexample
20448 -file-exec-file @var{file}
20449 @end smallexample
20450
20451 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
20452 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
20453 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
20454 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
20455 notification.
20456
20457 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20458
20459 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
20460
20461 @subsubheading Example
20462
20463 @smallexample
20464 (gdb)
20465 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
20466 ^done
20467 (gdb)
20468 @end smallexample
20469
20470
20471 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
20472 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
20473
20474 @subsubheading Synopsis
20475
20476 @smallexample
20477 -file-list-exec-sections
20478 @end smallexample
20479
20480 List the sections of the current executable file.
20481
20482 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20483
20484 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
20485 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
20486 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
20487
20488 @subsubheading Example
20489 N.A.
20490
20491
20492 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
20493 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
20494
20495 @subsubheading Synopsis
20496
20497 @smallexample
20498 -file-list-exec-source-file
20499 @end smallexample
20500
20501 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
20502 to the current source file for the current executable.
20503
20504 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20505
20506 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
20507
20508 @subsubheading Example
20509
20510 @smallexample
20511 (gdb)
20512 123-file-list-exec-source-file
20513 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c"
20514 (gdb)
20515 @end smallexample
20516
20517
20518 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
20519 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
20520
20521 @subsubheading Synopsis
20522
20523 @smallexample
20524 -file-list-exec-source-files
20525 @end smallexample
20526
20527 List the source files for the current executable.
20528
20529 It will always output the filename, but only when @value{GDBN} can find
20530 the absolute file name of a source file, will it output the fullname.
20531
20532 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20533
20534 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
20535 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
20536
20537 @subsubheading Example
20538 @smallexample
20539 (gdb)
20540 -file-list-exec-source-files
20541 ^done,files=[
20542 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
20543 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
20544 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
20545 (gdb)
20546 @end smallexample
20547
20548 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
20549 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
20550
20551 @subsubheading Synopsis
20552
20553 @smallexample
20554 -file-list-shared-libraries
20555 @end smallexample
20556
20557 List the shared libraries in the program.
20558
20559 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20560
20561 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}.
20562
20563 @subsubheading Example
20564 N.A.
20565
20566
20567 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
20568 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
20569
20570 @subsubheading Synopsis
20571
20572 @smallexample
20573 -file-list-symbol-files
20574 @end smallexample
20575
20576 List symbol files.
20577
20578 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20579
20580 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
20581
20582 @subsubheading Example
20583 N.A.
20584
20585
20586 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
20587 @findex -file-symbol-file
20588
20589 @subsubheading Synopsis
20590
20591 @smallexample
20592 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
20593 @end smallexample
20594
20595 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
20596 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
20597 produced, except for a completion notification.
20598
20599 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20600
20601 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
20602
20603 @subsubheading Example
20604
20605 @smallexample
20606 (gdb)
20607 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
20608 ^done
20609 (gdb)
20610 @end smallexample
20611
20612 @ignore
20613 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20614 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
20615 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
20616
20617 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
20618
20619 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
20620
20621 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
20622
20623 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
20624
20625 @c @subheading -overlay-map
20626
20627 @c @subheading -overlay-off
20628
20629 @c @subheading -overlay-on
20630
20631 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
20632
20633 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20634 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
20635 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
20636
20637 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
20638
20639 @c @subheading -signal-handle
20640
20641 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
20642
20643 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
20644 @end ignore
20645
20646
20647 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20648 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
20649 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
20650
20651
20652 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
20653 @findex -target-attach
20654
20655 @subsubheading Synopsis
20656
20657 @smallexample
20658 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{file}
20659 @end smallexample
20660
20661 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of @value{GDBN}.
20662
20663 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20664
20665 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
20666
20667 @subsubheading Example
20668 N.A.
20669
20670
20671 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
20672 @findex -target-compare-sections
20673
20674 @subsubheading Synopsis
20675
20676 @smallexample
20677 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
20678 @end smallexample
20679
20680 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
20681 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
20682
20683 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20684
20685 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
20686
20687 @subsubheading Example
20688 N.A.
20689
20690
20691 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
20692 @findex -target-detach
20693
20694 @subsubheading Synopsis
20695
20696 @smallexample
20697 -target-detach
20698 @end smallexample
20699
20700 Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
20701 There's no output.
20702
20703 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20704
20705 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
20706
20707 @subsubheading Example
20708
20709 @smallexample
20710 (gdb)
20711 -target-detach
20712 ^done
20713 (gdb)
20714 @end smallexample
20715
20716
20717 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
20718 @findex -target-disconnect
20719
20720 @subsubheading Synopsis
20721
20722 @smallexample
20723 -target-disconnect
20724 @end smallexample
20725
20726 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
20727 generally not resumed.
20728
20729 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20730
20731 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
20732
20733 @subsubheading Example
20734
20735 @smallexample
20736 (gdb)
20737 -target-disconnect
20738 ^done
20739 (gdb)
20740 @end smallexample
20741
20742
20743 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
20744 @findex -target-download
20745
20746 @subsubheading Synopsis
20747
20748 @smallexample
20749 -target-download
20750 @end smallexample
20751
20752 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
20753 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
20754
20755 @table @samp
20756 @item section
20757 The name of the section.
20758 @item section-sent
20759 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
20760 @item section-size
20761 The size of the section.
20762 @item total-sent
20763 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
20764 @item total-size
20765 The size of the overall executable to download.
20766 @end table
20767
20768 @noindent
20769 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
20770 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
20771
20772 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
20773 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
20774
20775 @table @samp
20776 @item section
20777 The name of the section.
20778 @item section-size
20779 The size of the section.
20780 @item total-size
20781 The size of the overall executable to download.
20782 @end table
20783
20784 @noindent
20785 At the end, a summary is printed.
20786
20787 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20788
20789 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
20790
20791 @subsubheading Example
20792
20793 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
20794 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
20795
20796 @smallexample
20797 (gdb)
20798 -target-download
20799 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
20800 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
20801 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
20802 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
20803 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
20804 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
20805 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
20806 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
20807 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
20808 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
20809 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
20810 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
20811 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
20812 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
20813 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
20814 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
20815 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
20816 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
20817 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
20818 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
20819 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
20820 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
20821 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
20822 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
20823 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
20824 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
20825 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
20826 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
20827 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
20828 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
20829 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
20830 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
20831 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
20832 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
20833 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
20834 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
20835 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
20836 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
20837 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
20838 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
20839 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
20840 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
20841 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
20842 write-rate="429"
20843 (gdb)
20844 @end smallexample
20845
20846
20847 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
20848 @findex -target-exec-status
20849
20850 @subsubheading Synopsis
20851
20852 @smallexample
20853 -target-exec-status
20854 @end smallexample
20855
20856 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
20857 not, for instance).
20858
20859 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20860
20861 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
20862
20863 @subsubheading Example
20864 N.A.
20865
20866
20867 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
20868 @findex -target-list-available-targets
20869
20870 @subsubheading Synopsis
20871
20872 @smallexample
20873 -target-list-available-targets
20874 @end smallexample
20875
20876 List the possible targets to connect to.
20877
20878 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20879
20880 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
20881
20882 @subsubheading Example
20883 N.A.
20884
20885
20886 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
20887 @findex -target-list-current-targets
20888
20889 @subsubheading Synopsis
20890
20891 @smallexample
20892 -target-list-current-targets
20893 @end smallexample
20894
20895 Describe the current target.
20896
20897 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20898
20899 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
20900 other things).
20901
20902 @subsubheading Example
20903 N.A.
20904
20905
20906 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
20907 @findex -target-list-parameters
20908
20909 @subsubheading Synopsis
20910
20911 @smallexample
20912 -target-list-parameters
20913 @end smallexample
20914
20915 @c ????
20916
20917 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20918
20919 No equivalent.
20920
20921 @subsubheading Example
20922 N.A.
20923
20924
20925 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
20926 @findex -target-select
20927
20928 @subsubheading Synopsis
20929
20930 @smallexample
20931 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
20932 @end smallexample
20933
20934 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
20935
20936 @table @samp
20937 @item @var{type}
20938 The type of target, for instance @samp{async}, @samp{remote}, etc.
20939 @item @var{parameters}
20940 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
20941 Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details.
20942 @end table
20943
20944 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
20945 which the target program is, in the following form:
20946
20947 @smallexample
20948 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
20949 args=[@var{arg list}]
20950 @end smallexample
20951
20952 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20953
20954 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
20955
20956 @subsubheading Example
20957
20958 @smallexample
20959 (gdb)
20960 -target-select async /dev/ttya
20961 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
20962 (gdb)
20963 @end smallexample
20964
20965 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20966 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
20967 @section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
20968
20969 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
20970
20971 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
20972 @findex -gdb-exit
20973
20974 @subsubheading Synopsis
20975
20976 @smallexample
20977 -gdb-exit
20978 @end smallexample
20979
20980 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
20981
20982 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20983
20984 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
20985
20986 @subsubheading Example
20987
20988 @smallexample
20989 (gdb)
20990 -gdb-exit
20991 ^exit
20992 @end smallexample
20993
20994
20995 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
20996 @findex -exec-abort
20997
20998 @subsubheading Synopsis
20999
21000 @smallexample
21001 -exec-abort
21002 @end smallexample
21003
21004 Kill the inferior running program.
21005
21006 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21007
21008 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
21009
21010 @subsubheading Example
21011 N.A.
21012
21013
21014 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
21015 @findex -gdb-set
21016
21017 @subsubheading Synopsis
21018
21019 @smallexample
21020 -gdb-set
21021 @end smallexample
21022
21023 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
21024 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
21025
21026 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21027
21028 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
21029
21030 @subsubheading Example
21031
21032 @smallexample
21033 (gdb)
21034 -gdb-set $foo=3
21035 ^done
21036 (gdb)
21037 @end smallexample
21038
21039
21040 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
21041 @findex -gdb-show
21042
21043 @subsubheading Synopsis
21044
21045 @smallexample
21046 -gdb-show
21047 @end smallexample
21048
21049 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
21050
21051 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21052
21053 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
21054
21055 @subsubheading Example
21056
21057 @smallexample
21058 (gdb)
21059 -gdb-show annotate
21060 ^done,value="0"
21061 (gdb)
21062 @end smallexample
21063
21064 @c @subheading -gdb-source
21065
21066
21067 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
21068 @findex -gdb-version
21069
21070 @subsubheading Synopsis
21071
21072 @smallexample
21073 -gdb-version
21074 @end smallexample
21075
21076 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
21077
21078 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21079
21080 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
21081 default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
21082
21083 @subsubheading Example
21084
21085 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
21086 @c box in TeX.
21087 @smallexample
21088 (gdb)
21089 -gdb-version
21090 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
21091 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
21092 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
21093 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
21094 ~ certain conditions.
21095 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
21096 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
21097 ~ details.
21098 ~This GDB was configured as
21099 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
21100 ^done
21101 (gdb)
21102 @end smallexample
21103
21104 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
21105 @findex -interpreter-exec
21106
21107 @subheading Synopsis
21108
21109 @smallexample
21110 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
21111 @end smallexample
21112 @anchor{-interpreter-exec}
21113
21114 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
21115
21116 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
21117
21118 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
21119
21120 @subheading Example
21121
21122 @smallexample
21123 (gdb)
21124 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
21125 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
21126 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
21127 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
21128 ^done
21129 (gdb)
21130 @end smallexample
21131
21132 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
21133 @findex -inferior-tty-set
21134
21135 @subheading Synopsis
21136
21137 @smallexample
21138 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
21139 @end smallexample
21140
21141 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
21142
21143 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
21144
21145 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
21146
21147 @subheading Example
21148
21149 @smallexample
21150 (gdb)
21151 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
21152 ^done
21153 (gdb)
21154 @end smallexample
21155
21156 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
21157 @findex -inferior-tty-show
21158
21159 @subheading Synopsis
21160
21161 @smallexample
21162 -inferior-tty-show
21163 @end smallexample
21164
21165 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
21166
21167 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
21168
21169 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
21170
21171 @subheading Example
21172
21173 @smallexample
21174 (gdb)
21175 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
21176 ^done
21177 (gdb)
21178 -inferior-tty-show
21179 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
21180 (gdb)
21181 @end smallexample
21182
21183 @subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command
21184 @findex -enable-timings
21185
21186 @subheading Synopsis
21187
21188 @smallexample
21189 -enable-timings [yes | no]
21190 @end smallexample
21191
21192 Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI
21193 command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend
21194 developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is
21195 equivalent to @samp{yes}.
21196
21197 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
21198
21199 No equivalent.
21200
21201 @subheading Example
21202
21203 @smallexample
21204 (gdb)
21205 -enable-timings
21206 ^done
21207 (gdb)
21208 -break-insert main
21209 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
21210 addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
21211 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",times="0"@},
21212 time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@}
21213 (gdb)
21214 -enable-timings no
21215 ^done
21216 (gdb)
21217 -exec-run
21218 ^running
21219 (gdb)
21220 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
21221 frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},
21222 @{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c",
21223 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73"@}
21224 (gdb)
21225 @end smallexample
21226
21227 @node Annotations
21228 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
21229
21230 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
21231 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
21232 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
21233 relatively high level.
21234
21235 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
21236 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
21237
21238 @ignore
21239 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
21240 @end ignore
21241
21242 @menu
21243 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
21244 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
21245 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
21246 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
21247 * Annotations for Running::
21248 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
21249 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
21250 @end menu
21251
21252 @node Annotations Overview
21253 @section What is an Annotation?
21254 @cindex annotations
21255
21256 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
21257 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
21258 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
21259 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
21260 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
21261 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
21262 cannot contain newline characters.
21263
21264 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
21265 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
21266 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
21267 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
21268 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
21269 means those three characters as output.
21270
21271 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
21272 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
21273 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
21274 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
21275 is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
21276 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
21277 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
21278 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
21279 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
21280
21281 @table @code
21282 @kindex set annotate
21283 @item set annotate @var{level}
21284 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
21285 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
21286
21287 @item show annotate
21288 @kindex show annotate
21289 Show the current annotation level.
21290 @end table
21291
21292 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
21293
21294 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
21295
21296 @smallexample
21297 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
21298 GNU gdb 6.0
21299 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
21300 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
21301 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
21302 under certain conditions.
21303 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
21304 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
21305 for details.
21306 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
21307
21308 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
21309 (@value{GDBP})
21310 ^Z^Zprompt
21311 @kbd{quit}
21312
21313 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
21314 $
21315 @end smallexample
21316
21317 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
21318 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
21319 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
21320 output from @value{GDBN}.
21321
21322 @node Prompting
21323 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
21324
21325 @cindex annotations for prompts
21326 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
21327 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
21328 over, etc.
21329
21330 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
21331 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
21332 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
21333 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
21334 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
21335 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
21336 features the following annotations:
21337
21338 @smallexample
21339 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
21340 ^Z^Zprompt
21341 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
21342 @end smallexample
21343
21344 The input types are
21345
21346 @table @code
21347 @findex pre-prompt annotation
21348 @findex prompt annotation
21349 @findex post-prompt annotation
21350 @item prompt
21351 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
21352
21353 @findex pre-commands annotation
21354 @findex commands annotation
21355 @findex post-commands annotation
21356 @item commands
21357 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
21358 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
21359
21360 @findex pre-overload-choice annotation
21361 @findex overload-choice annotation
21362 @findex post-overload-choice annotation
21363 @item overload-choice
21364 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
21365
21366 @findex pre-query annotation
21367 @findex query annotation
21368 @findex post-query annotation
21369 @item query
21370 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
21371
21372 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
21373 @findex prompt-for-continue annotation
21374 @findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
21375 @item prompt-for-continue
21376 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
21377 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
21378 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
21379 presence of annotations.
21380 @end table
21381
21382 @node Errors
21383 @section Errors
21384 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
21385
21386 @findex quit annotation
21387 @smallexample
21388 ^Z^Zquit
21389 @end smallexample
21390
21391 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
21392
21393 @findex error annotation
21394 @smallexample
21395 ^Z^Zerror
21396 @end smallexample
21397
21398 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
21399
21400 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
21401 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
21402 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
21403 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
21404 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
21405 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
21406 to the top level.
21407
21408 @findex error-begin annotation
21409 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
21410
21411 @smallexample
21412 ^Z^Zerror-begin
21413 @end smallexample
21414
21415 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
21416 message.
21417
21418 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
21419 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
21420 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
21421
21422 @node Invalidation
21423 @section Invalidation Notices
21424
21425 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
21426 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
21427 changed.
21428
21429 @table @code
21430 @findex frames-invalid annotation
21431 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
21432
21433 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
21434 have changed.
21435
21436 @findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
21437 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
21438
21439 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
21440 deleted a breakpoint.
21441 @end table
21442
21443 @node Annotations for Running
21444 @section Running the Program
21445 @cindex annotations for running programs
21446
21447 @findex starting annotation
21448 @findex stopping annotation
21449 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
21450 @code{step} or @code{continue},
21451
21452 @smallexample
21453 ^Z^Zstarting
21454 @end smallexample
21455
21456 is output. When the program stops,
21457
21458 @smallexample
21459 ^Z^Zstopped
21460 @end smallexample
21461
21462 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
21463 annotations describe how the program stopped.
21464
21465 @table @code
21466 @findex exited annotation
21467 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
21468 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
21469 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
21470
21471 @findex signalled annotation
21472 @findex signal-name annotation
21473 @findex signal-name-end annotation
21474 @findex signal-string annotation
21475 @findex signal-string-end annotation
21476 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
21477 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
21478 annotation continues:
21479
21480 @smallexample
21481 @var{intro-text}
21482 ^Z^Zsignal-name
21483 @var{name}
21484 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
21485 @var{middle-text}
21486 ^Z^Zsignal-string
21487 @var{string}
21488 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
21489 @var{end-text}
21490 @end smallexample
21491
21492 @noindent
21493 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
21494 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
21495 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}.
21496 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
21497 user's benefit and have no particular format.
21498
21499 @findex signal annotation
21500 @item ^Z^Zsignal
21501 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
21502 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
21503 terminated with it.
21504
21505 @findex breakpoint annotation
21506 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
21507 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
21508
21509 @findex watchpoint annotation
21510 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
21511 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
21512 @end table
21513
21514 @node Source Annotations
21515 @section Displaying Source
21516 @cindex annotations for source display
21517
21518 @findex source annotation
21519 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
21520
21521 @smallexample
21522 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
21523 @end smallexample
21524
21525 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
21526 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
21527 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
21528 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
21529 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
21530 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
21531 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
21532 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
21533 source which is being displayed. @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
21534 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
21535 depend on the language).
21536
21537 @node GDB Bugs
21538 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
21539 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
21540 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
21541
21542 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
21543
21544 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
21545 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
21546 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
21547 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
21548
21549 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
21550 information that enables us to fix the bug.
21551
21552 @menu
21553 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
21554 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
21555 @end menu
21556
21557 @node Bug Criteria
21558 @section Have You Found a Bug?
21559 @cindex bug criteria
21560
21561 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
21562
21563 @itemize @bullet
21564 @cindex fatal signal
21565 @cindex debugger crash
21566 @cindex crash of debugger
21567 @item
21568 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
21569 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
21570
21571 @cindex error on valid input
21572 @item
21573 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
21574 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
21575 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
21576
21577 @cindex invalid input
21578 @item
21579 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
21580 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
21581 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
21582 for traditional practice''.
21583
21584 @item
21585 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
21586 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
21587 @end itemize
21588
21589 @node Bug Reporting
21590 @section How to Report Bugs
21591 @cindex bug reports
21592 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
21593
21594 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
21595 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
21596 contact that organization first.
21597
21598 You can find contact information for many support companies and
21599 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
21600 distribution.
21601 @c should add a web page ref...
21602
21603 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
21604 @value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using
21605 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
21606 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
21607 be used.
21608
21609 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
21610 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
21611 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
21612 @samp{bug-gdb}.
21613
21614 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
21615 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
21616 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
21617 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
21618 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
21619 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
21620 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
21621 bug reports to the mailing list.
21622
21623 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
21624 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
21625 fact or leave it out, state it!
21626
21627 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
21628 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
21629 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
21630 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
21631 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
21632 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
21633 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
21634 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
21635 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
21636
21637 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
21638 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
21639 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
21640 self-contained.
21641
21642 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
21643 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
21644 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
21645 bugs properly.
21646
21647 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
21648
21649 @itemize @bullet
21650 @item
21651 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
21652 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
21653 version}.
21654
21655 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
21656 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
21657
21658 @item
21659 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
21660 version number.
21661
21662 @item
21663 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
21664 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
21665
21666 @item
21667 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
21668 debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
21669 C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version}
21670 to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for
21671 those compilers.
21672
21673 @item
21674 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
21675 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
21676 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
21677 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
21678
21679 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
21680 and then we might not encounter the bug.
21681
21682 @item
21683 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
21684 reproduce the bug.
21685
21686 @item
21687 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
21688 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
21689
21690 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
21691 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
21692 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
21693 a chance to make a mistake.
21694
21695 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
21696 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
21697 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
21698 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
21699 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
21700 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
21701 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
21702 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
21703
21704 @pindex script
21705 @cindex recording a session script
21706 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
21707 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
21708 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
21709 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
21710
21711 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
21712 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
21713
21714 @item
21715 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
21716 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
21717 it by context, not by line number.
21718
21719 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
21720 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
21721
21722 @end itemize
21723
21724 Here are some things that are not necessary:
21725
21726 @itemize @bullet
21727 @item
21728 A description of the envelope of the bug.
21729
21730 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
21731 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
21732 changes will not affect it.
21733
21734 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
21735 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
21736 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
21737 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
21738
21739 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
21740 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
21741 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
21742 less time, and so on.
21743
21744 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
21745 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
21746
21747 @item
21748 A patch for the bug.
21749
21750 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
21751 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
21752 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
21753 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
21754
21755 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
21756 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
21757 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
21758 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
21759
21760 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
21761 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
21762 help us to understand.
21763
21764 @item
21765 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
21766
21767 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
21768 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
21769 @end itemize
21770
21771 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
21772 @c and consists of the two following files:
21773 @c rluser.texinfo
21774 @c inc-hist.texinfo
21775 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
21776 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
21777 @include rluser.texi
21778 @include inc-hist.texinfo
21779
21780
21781 @node Formatting Documentation
21782 @appendix Formatting Documentation
21783
21784 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
21785 @cindex reference card
21786 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
21787 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
21788 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
21789 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
21790 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
21791 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
21792
21793 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
21794 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
21795
21796 @smallexample
21797 make refcard.dvi
21798 @end smallexample
21799
21800 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
21801 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
21802 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
21803 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
21804 your @sc{dvi} output program.
21805
21806 @cindex documentation
21807
21808 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
21809 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
21810 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
21811 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
21812 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
21813 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
21814
21815 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
21816 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
21817 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
21818 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
21819 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
21820 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
21821 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
21822 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
21823
21824 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
21825 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
21826 @code{makeinfo}.
21827
21828 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
21829 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
21830 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
21831
21832 @smallexample
21833 cd gdb
21834 make gdb.info
21835 @end smallexample
21836
21837 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
21838 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
21839 Texinfo definitions file.
21840
21841 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
21842 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
21843 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
21844 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
21845 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
21846 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
21847 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
21848
21849 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
21850 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
21851 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
21852 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
21853 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
21854 directory.
21855
21856 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
21857 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb}
21858 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
21859 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
21860
21861 @smallexample
21862 make gdb.dvi
21863 @end smallexample
21864
21865 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
21866
21867 @node Installing GDB
21868 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
21869 @cindex installation
21870
21871 @menu
21872 * Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
21873 * Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script
21874 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
21875 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
21876 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
21877 @end menu
21878
21879 @node Requirements
21880 @section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN}
21881 @cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
21882
21883 Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
21884 Other packages will be used only if they are found.
21885
21886 @heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN}
21887 @table @asis
21888 @item ISO C90 compiler
21889 @value{GDBN} is written in ISO C90. It should be buildable with any
21890 working C90 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
21891
21892 @end table
21893
21894 @heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN}
21895 @table @asis
21896 @item Expat
21897 @anchor{Expat}
21898 @value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
21899 included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
21900 can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
21901 The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several
21902 standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
21903 use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
21904
21905 Expat is used for remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format})
21906 and for target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions}).
21907
21908 @end table
21909
21910 @node Running Configure
21911 @section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script
21912 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
21913 @value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process
21914 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
21915 build the @code{gdb} program.
21916 @iftex
21917 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
21918 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
21919 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
21920 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
21921 @end iftex
21922
21923 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
21924 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
21925 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
21926
21927 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
21928 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
21929
21930 @table @code
21931 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
21932 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
21933
21934 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
21935 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
21936
21937 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
21938 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
21939
21940 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
21941 @sc{gnu} include files
21942
21943 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
21944 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
21945
21946 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
21947 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
21948
21949 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
21950 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
21951
21952 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
21953 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
21954
21955 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
21956 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
21957 @end table
21958
21959 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure}
21960 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
21961 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
21962
21963 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
21964 if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}. Pass the
21965 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
21966 argument.
21967
21968 For example:
21969
21970 @smallexample
21971 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
21972 ./configure @var{host}
21973 make
21974 @end smallexample
21975
21976 @noindent
21977 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
21978 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
21979 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @file{configure} tries to guess the
21980 correct value by examining your system.)
21981
21982 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
21983 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
21984 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
21985 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
21986
21987 @need 750
21988 @file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
21989 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
21990 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
21991
21992 @smallexample
21993 sh configure @var{host}
21994 @end smallexample
21995
21996 If you run @file{configure} from a directory that contains source
21997 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
21998 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN},
21999 @file{configure}
22000 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
22001 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
22002
22003 You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the
22004 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
22005 @file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
22006 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
22007 if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
22008 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
22009 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
22010 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
22011 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
22012
22013 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
22014 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
22015 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
22016 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
22017 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
22018
22019 @node Separate Objdir
22020 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory
22021
22022 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
22023 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
22024 host and target. @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by
22025 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
22026 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
22027 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
22028 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
22029 program specified there.
22030
22031 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure}
22032 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
22033 (You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure}
22034 itself from your working directory. If the path to @file{configure}
22035 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
22036 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
22037
22038 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
22039 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
22040
22041 @smallexample
22042 @group
22043 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
22044 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
22045 cd ../gdb-sun4
22046 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
22047 make
22048 @end group
22049 @end smallexample
22050
22051 When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
22052 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
22053 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
22054 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
22055 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
22056 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
22057
22058 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
22059 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
22060 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
22061 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
22062 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
22063
22064 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
22065 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
22066 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
22067 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
22068 You specify a cross-debugging target by
22069 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}.
22070
22071 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
22072 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
22073 called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
22074
22075 The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source
22076 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
22077 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
22078 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
22079 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
22080
22081 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
22082 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
22083 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
22084 with each other.
22085
22086 @node Config Names
22087 @section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets
22088
22089 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure}
22090 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
22091 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
22092 of information in the following pattern:
22093
22094 @smallexample
22095 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
22096 @end smallexample
22097
22098 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
22099 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
22100 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
22101
22102 The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
22103 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
22104 aliases. @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
22105 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
22106 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
22107 abbreviations---for example:
22108
22109 @smallexample
22110 % sh config.sub i386-linux
22111 i386-pc-linux-gnu
22112 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
22113 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
22114 % sh config.sub hp9k700
22115 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
22116 % sh config.sub sun4
22117 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
22118 % sh config.sub sun3
22119 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
22120 % sh config.sub i986v
22121 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
22122 @end smallexample
22123
22124 @noindent
22125 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
22126 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
22127
22128 @node Configure Options
22129 @section @file{configure} Options
22130
22131 Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that
22132 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @file{configure} also has
22133 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
22134 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @file{configure}.
22135
22136 @smallexample
22137 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
22138 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
22139 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
22140 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
22141 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
22142 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
22143 @var{host}
22144 @end smallexample
22145
22146 @noindent
22147 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
22148 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
22149 @samp{--}.
22150
22151 @table @code
22152 @item --help
22153 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}.
22154
22155 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
22156 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
22157 @file{@var{dir}}.
22158
22159 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
22160 Configure the source to install programs under directory
22161 @file{@var{dir}}.
22162
22163 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
22164 @need 2000
22165 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
22166 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
22167 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
22168 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
22169 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
22170 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
22171 directories. @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in
22172 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
22173 directory @var{dirname}. @file{configure} creates directories under
22174 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
22175 @var{dirname}.
22176
22177 @item --norecursion
22178 Configure only the directory level where @file{configure} is executed; do not
22179 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
22180
22181 @item --target=@var{target}
22182 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
22183 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
22184 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
22185
22186 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
22187
22188 @item @var{host} @dots{}
22189 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
22190
22191 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
22192 @end table
22193
22194 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
22195 needed for special purposes only.
22196
22197 @node Maintenance Commands
22198 @appendix Maintenance Commands
22199 @cindex maintenance commands
22200 @cindex internal commands
22201
22202 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
22203 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
22204 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
22205 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
22206 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
22207
22208 @table @code
22209 @kindex maint agent
22210 @item maint agent @var{expression}
22211 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
22212 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
22213 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}).
22214
22215 @kindex maint info breakpoints
22216 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
22217 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
22218 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
22219 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
22220 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
22221 is shown:
22222
22223 @table @code
22224 @item breakpoint
22225 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
22226
22227 @item watchpoint
22228 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
22229
22230 @item longjmp
22231 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
22232 @code{longjmp} calls.
22233
22234 @item longjmp resume
22235 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
22236
22237 @item until
22238 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
22239
22240 @item finish
22241 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
22242
22243 @item shlib events
22244 Shared library events.
22245
22246 @end table
22247
22248 @kindex maint check-symtabs
22249 @item maint check-symtabs
22250 Check the consistency of psymtabs and symtabs.
22251
22252 @kindex maint cplus first_component
22253 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
22254 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
22255
22256 @kindex maint cplus namespace
22257 @item maint cplus namespace
22258 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
22259
22260 @kindex maint demangle
22261 @item maint demangle @var{name}
22262 Demangle a C@t{++} or Objective-C mangled @var{name}.
22263
22264 @kindex maint deprecate
22265 @kindex maint undeprecate
22266 @cindex deprecated commands
22267 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
22268 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
22269 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
22270 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
22271 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
22272 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
22273 the replacement as part of the warning.
22274
22275 @kindex maint dump-me
22276 @item maint dump-me
22277 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
22278 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
22279 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
22280 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
22281
22282 @kindex maint internal-error
22283 @kindex maint internal-warning
22284 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
22285 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
22286 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error}
22287 or @code{internal_warning} and hence behave as though an internal error
22288 or internal warning has been detected. In addition to reporting the
22289 internal problem, these functions give the user the opportunity to
22290 either quit @value{GDBN} or create a core file of the current
22291 @value{GDBN} session.
22292
22293 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
22294 used as the text of the error or warning message.
22295
22296 Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}:
22297
22298 @smallexample
22299 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
22300 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
22301 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
22302 debugging may prove unreliable.
22303 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
22304 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
22305 (@value{GDBP})
22306 @end smallexample
22307
22308 @kindex maint packet
22309 @item maint packet @var{text}
22310 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
22311 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
22312 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
22313 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
22314 checksum.
22315
22316 @kindex maint print architecture
22317 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22318 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
22319 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
22320
22321 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
22322 @item maint print dummy-frames
22323 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
22324
22325 @smallexample
22326 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
22327 @dots{}
22328 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
22329 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
22330 58 return (a + b);
22331 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
22332 @dots{}
22333 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
22334 0x1a57c80: pc=0x01014068 fp=0x0200bddc sp=0x0200bdd6
22335 top=0x0200bdd4 id=@{stack=0x200bddc,code=0x101405c@}
22336 call_lo=0x01014000 call_hi=0x01014001
22337 (@value{GDBP})
22338 @end smallexample
22339
22340 Takes an optional file parameter.
22341
22342 @kindex maint print registers
22343 @kindex maint print raw-registers
22344 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
22345 @kindex maint print register-groups
22346 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22347 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22348 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22349 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22350 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
22351
22352 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
22353 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print cooked-registers}
22354 includes the (cooked) value of all registers; and the command
22355 @code{maint print register-groups} includes the groups that each
22356 register is a member of. @xref{Registers,, Registers, gdbint,
22357 @value{GDBN} Internals}.
22358
22359 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
22360 write the information.
22361
22362 @kindex maint print reggroups
22363 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22364 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
22365 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
22366 information.
22367
22368 The register groups info looks like this:
22369
22370 @smallexample
22371 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
22372 Group Type
22373 general user
22374 float user
22375 all user
22376 vector user
22377 system user
22378 save internal
22379 restore internal
22380 @end smallexample
22381
22382 @kindex flushregs
22383 @item flushregs
22384 This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
22385
22386 @kindex maint print objfiles
22387 @cindex info for known object files
22388 @item maint print objfiles
22389 Print a dump of all known object files. For each object file, this
22390 command prints its name, address in memory, and all of its psymtabs
22391 and symtabs.
22392
22393 @kindex maint print statistics
22394 @cindex bcache statistics
22395 @item maint print statistics
22396 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
22397 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
22398 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
22399 of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
22400 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
22401 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
22402 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
22403 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
22404 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
22405 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
22406 lengths.
22407
22408 @kindex maint print target-stack
22409 @cindex target stack description
22410 @item maint print target-stack
22411 A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular
22412 kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata},
22413 so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request.
22414 In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets
22415 until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular
22416 address.
22417
22418 This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on
22419 the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one.
22420
22421 @kindex maint print type
22422 @cindex type chain of a data type
22423 @item maint print type @var{expr}
22424 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
22425 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
22426 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
22427 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
22428 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
22429
22430 @kindex maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
22431 @kindex maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
22432 @item maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
22433 @itemx maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
22434 Control the DWARF 2 compilation unit cache.
22435
22436 @cindex DWARF 2 compilation units cache
22437 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
22438 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF 2
22439 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
22440 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
22441 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
22442 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
22443 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
22444 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
22445
22446 @kindex maint set profile
22447 @kindex maint show profile
22448 @cindex profiling GDB
22449 @item maint set profile
22450 @itemx maint show profile
22451 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
22452
22453 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
22454 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
22455 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
22456 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
22457 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
22458 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
22459 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
22460
22461 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
22462 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
22463
22464 @kindex maint show-debug-regs
22465 @cindex x86 hardware debug registers
22466 @item maint show-debug-regs
22467 Control whether to show variables that mirror the x86 hardware debug
22468 registers. Use @code{ON} to enable, @code{OFF} to disable. If
22469 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or
22470 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
22471 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
22472
22473 @kindex maint space
22474 @cindex memory used by commands
22475 @item maint space
22476 Control whether to display memory usage for each command. If set to a
22477 nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
22478 took, following the command's own output. This can also be requested
22479 by invoking @value{GDBN} with the @option{--statistics} command-line
22480 switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
22481
22482 @kindex maint time
22483 @cindex time of command execution
22484 @item maint time
22485 Control whether to display the execution time for each command. If
22486 set to a nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
22487 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
22488 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
22489 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
22490
22491 @kindex maint translate-address
22492 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
22493 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
22494 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
22495 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
22496 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
22497 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
22498 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
22499
22500 @end table
22501
22502 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
22503 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
22504
22505 @table @code
22506 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
22507 @kindex set watchdog
22508 @cindex watchdog timer
22509 @cindex timeout for commands
22510 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
22511 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
22512 reports and error and the command is aborted.
22513
22514 @item show watchdog
22515 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
22516 @end table
22517
22518 @node Remote Protocol
22519 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
22520
22521 @menu
22522 * Overview::
22523 * Packets::
22524 * Stop Reply Packets::
22525 * General Query Packets::
22526 * Register Packet Format::
22527 * Tracepoint Packets::
22528 * Interrupts::
22529 * Examples::
22530 * File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension::
22531 * Library List Format::
22532 * Memory Map Format::
22533 @end menu
22534
22535 @node Overview
22536 @section Overview
22537
22538 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
22539 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
22540 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
22541 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
22542
22543 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
22544 transmitted and received data, respectively.
22545
22546 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
22547 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
22548 @cindex remote serial protocol
22549 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments) are
22550 sent as a @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
22551 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
22552 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
22553
22554 @smallexample
22555 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
22556 @end smallexample
22557 @noindent
22558
22559 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
22560 @noindent
22561 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
22562 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
22563 eight bit unsigned checksum).
22564
22565 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
22566 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
22567
22568 @smallexample
22569 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
22570 @end smallexample
22571
22572 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
22573 @noindent
22574 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
22575 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
22576 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
22577
22578 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
22579 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
22580 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
22581 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
22582 retransmission):
22583
22584 @smallexample
22585 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
22586 <- @code{+}
22587 @end smallexample
22588 @noindent
22589
22590 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
22591 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
22592 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
22593 when the operation has completed (the target has again stopped).
22594
22595 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
22596 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
22597 exceptions).
22598
22599 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
22600 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
22601 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
22602 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
22603
22604 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
22605 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
22606 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
22607
22608 @cindex remote protocol, binary data
22609 @anchor{Binary Data}
22610 Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
22611 digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
22612 protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
22613 Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
22614 connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
22615 binary data.
22616
22617 The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
22618 as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
22619 character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
22620 For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
22621 bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
22622 @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
22623 @samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
22624 must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
22625 is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
22626 (described next).
22627
22628 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space. A @samp{*}
22629 means that the next character is an @sc{ascii} encoding giving a repeat count
22630 which stands for that many repetitions of the character preceding the
22631 @samp{*}. The encoding is @code{n+29}, yielding a printable character
22632 where @code{n >=3} (which is where rle starts to win). The printable
22633 characters @samp{$}, @samp{#}, @samp{+} and @samp{-} or with a numeric
22634 value greater than 126 should not be used.
22635
22636 So:
22637 @smallexample
22638 "@code{0* }"
22639 @end smallexample
22640 @noindent
22641 means the same as "0000".
22642
22643 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
22644 error number. That number is not well defined.
22645
22646 @cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
22647 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
22648 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
22649 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
22650 on that response.
22651
22652 A stub is required to support the @samp{g}, @samp{G}, @samp{m}, @samp{M},
22653 @samp{c}, and @samp{s} @var{command}s. All other @var{command}s are
22654 optional.
22655
22656 @node Packets
22657 @section Packets
22658
22659 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
22660 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
22661 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File
22662 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
22663
22664 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
22665 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
22666 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
22667 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
22668 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
22669 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
22670 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
22671 @var{baz}. @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the
22672 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
22673 @var{baz}.
22674
22675 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
22676 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
22677
22678 Here are the packet descriptions.
22679
22680 @table @samp
22681
22682 @item !
22683 @cindex @samp{!} packet
22684 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
22685 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
22686 debugged.
22687
22688 Reply:
22689 @table @samp
22690 @item OK
22691 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
22692 @end table
22693
22694 @item ?
22695 @cindex @samp{?} packet
22696 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
22697 step and continue.
22698
22699 Reply:
22700 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
22701
22702 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
22703 @cindex @samp{A} packet
22704 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
22705 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
22706 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
22707
22708 Reply:
22709 @table @samp
22710 @item OK
22711 The arguments were set.
22712 @item E @var{NN}
22713 An error occurred.
22714 @end table
22715
22716 @item b @var{baud}
22717 @cindex @samp{b} packet
22718 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
22719 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
22720
22721 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
22722 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
22723 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
22724
22725 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
22726 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
22727 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
22728 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
22729 of view, nothing actually happened.}
22730
22731 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
22732 @cindex @samp{B} packet
22733 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
22734 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
22735
22736 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
22737 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
22738
22739 @item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
22740 @cindex @samp{c} packet
22741 Continue. @var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted,
22742 resume at current address.
22743
22744 Reply:
22745 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
22746
22747 @item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
22748 @cindex @samp{C} packet
22749 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
22750 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
22751
22752 Reply:
22753 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
22754
22755 @item d
22756 @cindex @samp{d} packet
22757 Toggle debug flag.
22758
22759 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
22760 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
22761
22762 @item D
22763 @cindex @samp{D} packet
22764 Detach @value{GDBN} from the remote system. Sent to the remote target
22765 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
22766
22767 Reply:
22768 @table @samp
22769 @item OK
22770 for success
22771 @item E @var{NN}
22772 for an error
22773 @end table
22774
22775 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
22776 @cindex @samp{F} packet
22777 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
22778 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
22779 Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification.
22780
22781 @item g
22782 @anchor{read registers packet}
22783 @cindex @samp{g} packet
22784 Read general registers.
22785
22786 Reply:
22787 @table @samp
22788 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
22789 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
22790 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
22791 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
22792 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal macros
22793 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{REGISTER_NAME} macros. The
22794 specification of several standard @samp{g} packets is specified below.
22795 @item E @var{NN}
22796 for an error.
22797 @end table
22798
22799 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
22800 @cindex @samp{G} packet
22801 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
22802 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
22803
22804 Reply:
22805 @table @samp
22806 @item OK
22807 for success
22808 @item E @var{NN}
22809 for an error
22810 @end table
22811
22812 @item H @var{c} @var{t}
22813 @cindex @samp{H} packet
22814 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
22815 @samp{G}, et.al.). @var{c} depends on the operation to be performed: it
22816 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations, @samp{g} for other
22817 operations. The thread designator @var{t} may be @samp{-1}, meaning all
22818 the threads, a thread number, or @samp{0} which means pick any thread.
22819
22820 Reply:
22821 @table @samp
22822 @item OK
22823 for success
22824 @item E @var{NN}
22825 for an error
22826 @end table
22827
22828 @c FIXME: JTC:
22829 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
22830 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
22831 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
22832 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
22833 @c described. For example:
22834 @c
22835 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
22836 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
22837 @c otherwise returns current registers.
22838 @c
22839 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
22840 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
22841 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
22842
22843 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
22844 @anchor{cycle step packet}
22845 @cindex @samp{i} packet
22846 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
22847 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
22848 step starting at that address.
22849
22850 @item I
22851 @cindex @samp{I} packet
22852 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
22853 step packet}.
22854
22855 @item k
22856 @cindex @samp{k} packet
22857 Kill request.
22858
22859 FIXME: @emph{There is no description of how to operate when a specific
22860 thread context has been selected (i.e.@: does 'k' kill only that
22861 thread?)}.
22862
22863 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
22864 @cindex @samp{m} packet
22865 Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
22866 Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to any particular boundary.
22867
22868 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
22869 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
22870 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
22871 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
22872 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
22873 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
22874 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
22875 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
22876
22877 Reply:
22878 @table @samp
22879 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
22880 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal
22881 number. The reply may contain fewer bytes than requested if the
22882 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
22883 @item E @var{NN}
22884 @var{NN} is errno
22885 @end table
22886
22887 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
22888 @cindex @samp{M} packet
22889 Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
22890 @var{XX@dots{}} is the data; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit
22891 hexadecimal number.
22892
22893 Reply:
22894 @table @samp
22895 @item OK
22896 for success
22897 @item E @var{NN}
22898 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
22899 written).
22900 @end table
22901
22902 @item p @var{n}
22903 @cindex @samp{p} packet
22904 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
22905 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
22906 register value is encoded.
22907
22908 Reply:
22909 @table @samp
22910 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
22911 the register's value
22912 @item E @var{NN}
22913 for an error
22914 @item
22915 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
22916 @end table
22917
22918 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
22919 @anchor{write register packet}
22920 @cindex @samp{P} packet
22921 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
22922 number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
22923 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
22924
22925 Reply:
22926 @table @samp
22927 @item OK
22928 for success
22929 @item E @var{NN}
22930 for an error
22931 @end table
22932
22933 @item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
22934 @itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
22935 @cindex @samp{q} packet
22936 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
22937 General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
22938 described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
22939
22940 @item r
22941 @cindex @samp{r} packet
22942 Reset the entire system.
22943
22944 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
22945
22946 @item R @var{XX}
22947 @cindex @samp{R} packet
22948 Restart the program being debugged. @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
22949 This packet is only available in extended mode.
22950
22951 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
22952
22953 @item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
22954 @cindex @samp{s} packet
22955 Single step. @var{addr} is the address at which to resume. If
22956 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
22957
22958 Reply:
22959 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
22960
22961 @item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
22962 @anchor{step with signal packet}
22963 @cindex @samp{S} packet
22964 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
22965 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
22966
22967 Reply:
22968 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
22969
22970 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
22971 @cindex @samp{t} packet
22972 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
22973 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}. @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4 bytes.
22974 @var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
22975
22976 @item T @var{XX}
22977 @cindex @samp{T} packet
22978 Find out if the thread XX is alive.
22979
22980 Reply:
22981 @table @samp
22982 @item OK
22983 thread is still alive
22984 @item E @var{NN}
22985 thread is dead
22986 @end table
22987
22988 @item v
22989 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
22990 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
22991
22992 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{tid}@r{]]}@dots{}
22993 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
22994 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
22995 If an action is specified with no @var{tid}, then it is applied to any
22996 threads that don't have a specific action specified; if no default action is
22997 specified then other threads should remain stopped. Specifying multiple
22998 default actions is an error; specifying no actions is also an error.
22999 Thread IDs are specified in hexadecimal. Currently supported actions are:
23000
23001 @table @samp
23002 @item c
23003 Continue.
23004 @item C @var{sig}
23005 Continue with signal @var{sig}. @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
23006 @item s
23007 Step.
23008 @item S @var{sig}
23009 Step with signal @var{sig}. @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
23010 @end table
23011
23012 The optional @var{addr} argument normally associated with these packets is
23013 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
23014
23015 Reply:
23016 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
23017
23018 @item vCont?
23019 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
23020 Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet.
23021
23022 Reply:
23023 @table @samp
23024 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
23025 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
23026 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
23027 @item
23028 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
23029 @end table
23030
23031 @item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
23032 @cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
23033 Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
23034 @var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
23035 its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
23036 flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map
23037 Format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
23038 together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
23039 stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
23040 packet is received.
23041
23042 Reply:
23043 @table @samp
23044 @item OK
23045 for success
23046 @item E @var{NN}
23047 for an error
23048 @end table
23049
23050 @item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
23051 @cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
23052 Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
23053 is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
23054 packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
23055 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
23056 not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
23057 (although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
23058 have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
23059 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
23060 neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
23061 target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
23062
23063
23064 Reply:
23065 @table @samp
23066 @item OK
23067 for success
23068 @item E.memtype
23069 for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
23070 @item E @var{NN}
23071 for an error
23072 @end table
23073
23074 @item vFlashDone
23075 @cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
23076 Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
23077 The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
23078 @samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
23079 @samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
23080 regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
23081 request is completed.
23082
23083 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
23084 @anchor{X packet}
23085 @cindex @samp{X} packet
23086 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
23087 @var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes,
23088 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
23089
23090 Reply:
23091 @table @samp
23092 @item OK
23093 for success
23094 @item E @var{NN}
23095 for an error
23096 @end table
23097
23098 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{length}
23099 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{length}
23100 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
23101 @cindex @samp{z} packet
23102 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
23103 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
23104 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} and covering the next
23105 @var{length} bytes.
23106
23107 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
23108 separately.
23109
23110 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
23111 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
23112 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
23113 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
23114 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
23115 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
23116
23117 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{length}
23118 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{length}
23119 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
23120 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
23121 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a memory breakpoint at address
23122 @var{addr} of size @var{length}.
23123
23124 A memory breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
23125 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
23126 @var{length} is used by targets that indicates the size of the
23127 breakpoint (in bytes) that should be inserted (e.g., the @sc{arm} and
23128 @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint).
23129
23130 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
23131 code that contains memory breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
23132 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
23133 target, is not defined.}
23134
23135 Reply:
23136 @table @samp
23137 @item OK
23138 success
23139 @item
23140 not supported
23141 @item E @var{NN}
23142 for an error
23143 @end table
23144
23145 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{length}
23146 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{length}
23147 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
23148 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
23149 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
23150 address @var{addr} of size @var{length}.
23151
23152 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
23153 dependant on being able to modify the target's memory.
23154
23155 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
23156 movement.}
23157
23158 Reply:
23159 @table @samp
23160 @item OK
23161 success
23162 @item
23163 not supported
23164 @item E @var{NN}
23165 for an error
23166 @end table
23167
23168 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{length}
23169 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{length}
23170 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
23171 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
23172 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint.
23173
23174 Reply:
23175 @table @samp
23176 @item OK
23177 success
23178 @item
23179 not supported
23180 @item E @var{NN}
23181 for an error
23182 @end table
23183
23184 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{length}
23185 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{length}
23186 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
23187 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
23188 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint.
23189
23190 Reply:
23191 @table @samp
23192 @item OK
23193 success
23194 @item
23195 not supported
23196 @item E @var{NN}
23197 for an error
23198 @end table
23199
23200 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{length}
23201 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{length}
23202 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
23203 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
23204 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint.
23205
23206 Reply:
23207 @table @samp
23208 @item OK
23209 success
23210 @item
23211 not supported
23212 @item E @var{NN}
23213 for an error
23214 @end table
23215
23216 @end table
23217
23218 @node Stop Reply Packets
23219 @section Stop Reply Packets
23220 @cindex stop reply packets
23221
23222 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s} and @samp{?} packets can
23223 receive any of the below as a reply. In the case of the @samp{C},
23224 @samp{c}, @samp{S} and @samp{s} packets, that reply is only returned
23225 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
23226 number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
23227 @value{GDBN} source code.
23228
23229 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
23230 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
23231 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
23232 components.
23233
23234 @table @samp
23235
23236 @item S @var{AA}
23237 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
23238 number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
23239 @var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
23240
23241 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
23242 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
23243 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
23244 number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
23245 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
23246 and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
23247 round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
23248 this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
23249
23250 @itemize @bullet
23251 @item
23252 If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
23253 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. @var{r} is a
23254 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
23255 two-digit hex number.
23256
23257 @item
23258 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the thread process ID, in
23259 hex.
23260
23261 @item
23262 If @var{n} is a recognized @dfn{stop reason}, it describes a more
23263 specific event that stopped the target. The currently defined stop
23264 reasons are listed below. @var{aa} should be @samp{05}, the trap
23265 signal. At most one stop reason should be present.
23266
23267 @item
23268 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
23269 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
23270 future.
23271 @end itemize
23272
23273 The currently defined stop reasons are:
23274
23275 @table @samp
23276 @item watch
23277 @itemx rwatch
23278 @itemx awatch
23279 The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
23280 hex.
23281
23282 @cindex shared library events, remote reply
23283 @item library
23284 The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed.
23285 @value{GDBN} should use @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} to fetch a new
23286 list of loaded libraries. @var{r} is ignored.
23287 @end table
23288
23289 @item W @var{AA}
23290 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
23291 applicable to certain targets.
23292
23293 @item X @var{AA}
23294 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
23295
23296 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
23297 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
23298 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
23299 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
23300 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc.
23301
23302 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
23303 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
23304 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
23305 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
23306 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented
23307 system calls.
23308
23309 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
23310 this very system call.
23311
23312 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
23313 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
23314 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
23315 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
23316 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O Remote
23317 Protocol Extension}, for more details.
23318
23319 @end table
23320
23321 @node General Query Packets
23322 @section General Query Packets
23323 @cindex remote query requests
23324
23325 Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
23326 packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
23327 query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
23328 sending information to and from the stub.
23329
23330 The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
23331 indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
23332 @value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
23333 definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
23334 conventions:
23335
23336 @itemize @bullet
23337 @item
23338 The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
23339 @item
23340 Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
23341 letter.
23342 @item
23343 The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
23344 lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
23345 the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
23346 foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
23347 @end itemize
23348
23349 The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
23350 parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
23351 separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
23352 full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
23353 in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
23354 with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
23355 packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
23356 for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
23357 are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
23358 existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
23359 packet.}.
23360
23361 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
23362 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
23363 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
23364 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
23365 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
23366
23367 Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
23368
23369 @table @samp
23370
23371 @item qC
23372 @cindex current thread, remote request
23373 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
23374 Return the current thread id.
23375
23376 Reply:
23377 @table @samp
23378 @item QC @var{pid}
23379 Where @var{pid} is an unsigned hexadecimal process id.
23380 @item @r{(anything else)}
23381 Any other reply implies the old pid.
23382 @end table
23383
23384 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
23385 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
23386 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
23387 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory.
23388 Reply:
23389 @table @samp
23390 @item E @var{NN}
23391 An error (such as memory fault)
23392 @item C @var{crc32}
23393 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
23394 @end table
23395
23396 @item qfThreadInfo
23397 @itemx qsThreadInfo
23398 @cindex list active threads, remote request
23399 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
23400 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
23401 Obtain a list of all active thread ids from the target (OS). Since there
23402 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
23403 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
23404 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
23405 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
23406 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
23407
23408 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
23409
23410 Reply:
23411 @table @samp
23412 @item m @var{id}
23413 A single thread id
23414 @item m @var{id},@var{id}@dots{}
23415 a comma-separated list of thread ids
23416 @item l
23417 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
23418 @end table
23419
23420 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
23421 more thread ids, in big-endian unsigned hex, separated by commas.
23422 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
23423 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
23424 with @samp{l} (lower-case el, for @dfn{last}).
23425
23426 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
23427 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
23428 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
23429 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
23430 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
23431
23432 @var{thread-id} is the (big endian, hex encoded) thread id associated with the
23433 thread for which to fetch the TLS address.
23434
23435 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
23436 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
23437 information associated with the variable.)
23438
23439 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the
23440 the load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
23441 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
23442 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
23443 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
23444 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
23445
23446 Reply:
23447 @table @samp
23448 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
23449 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
23450 local storage requested.
23451
23452 @item E @var{nn}
23453 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
23454
23455 @item
23456 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
23457 @end table
23458
23459 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
23460 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
23461 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
23462 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
23463 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
23464 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
23465 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
23466
23467 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
23468
23469 Reply:
23470 @table @samp
23471 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
23472 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
23473 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
23474 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
23475 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
23476 is a sequence of thread IDs from the target. @var{threadid} (eight hex
23477 digits). See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
23478 @end table
23479
23480 @item qOffsets
23481 @cindex section offsets, remote request
23482 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
23483 Get section offsets that the target used when relocating the downloaded
23484 image.
23485
23486 Reply:
23487 @table @samp
23488 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy}@r{[};Bss=@var{zzz}@r{]}
23489 Relocate the @code{Text} section by @var{xxx} from its original address.
23490 Relocate the @code{Data} section by @var{yyy} from its original address.
23491 If the object file format provides segment information (e.g.@: @sc{elf}
23492 @samp{PT_LOAD} program headers), @value{GDBN} will relocate entire
23493 segments by the supplied offsets.
23494
23495 @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset may be included in the response,
23496 @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data} offset
23497 to the @code{Bss} section.}
23498
23499 @item TextSeg=@var{xxx}@r{[};DataSeg=@var{yyy}@r{]}
23500 Relocate the first segment of the object file, which conventionally
23501 contains program code, to a starting address of @var{xxx}. If
23502 @samp{DataSeg} is specified, relocate the second segment, which
23503 conventionally contains modifiable data, to a starting address of
23504 @var{yyy}. @value{GDBN} will report an error if the object file
23505 does not contain segment information, or does not contain at least
23506 as many segments as mentioned in the reply. Extra segments are
23507 kept at fixed offsets relative to the last relocated segment.
23508 @end table
23509
23510 @item qP @var{mode} @var{threadid}
23511 @cindex thread information, remote request
23512 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
23513 Returns information on @var{threadid}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
23514 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{threadid} is a hex encoded 64 bit thread ID.
23515
23516 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
23517 (see below).
23518
23519 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
23520
23521 @item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
23522 @cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
23523 @cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
23524 @anchor{QPassSignals}
23525 Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
23526 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
23527 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
23528 strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
23529 the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
23530 reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
23531 combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
23532 new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
23533 @var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
23534
23535 Reply:
23536 @table @samp
23537 @item OK
23538 The request succeeded.
23539
23540 @item E @var{nn}
23541 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
23542
23543 @item
23544 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
23545 the stub.
23546 @end table
23547
23548 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
23549 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
23550 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
23551 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
23552
23553 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
23554 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
23555 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
23556 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
23557 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
23558 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
23559 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
23560 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
23561 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
23562
23563 Reply:
23564 @table @samp
23565 @item OK
23566 A command response with no output.
23567 @item @var{OUTPUT}
23568 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
23569 @item E @var{NN}
23570 Indicate a badly formed request.
23571 @item
23572 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
23573 @end table
23574
23575 (Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
23576 command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
23577 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
23578 packets.)
23579
23580 @item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
23581 @cindex supported packets, remote query
23582 @cindex features of the remote protocol
23583 @cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
23584 @anchor{qSupported}
23585 Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
23586 query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
23587 @value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
23588 features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
23589 at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
23590 packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
23591 high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
23592 be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
23593 stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
23594 automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
23595 reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
23596 unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
23597 helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
23598 versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
23599
23600 Reply:
23601 @table @samp
23602 @item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
23603 The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
23604 depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
23605 possible forms).
23606 @item
23607 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
23608 or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
23609 @end table
23610
23611 The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
23612 @samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
23613 are:
23614
23615 @table @samp
23616 @item @var{name}=@var{value}
23617 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
23618 with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
23619 on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
23620 @item @var{name}+
23621 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
23622 need an associated value.
23623 @item @var{name}-
23624 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
23625 @item @var{name}?
23626 The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
23627 @value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
23628 needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
23629 but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
23630 @end table
23631
23632 Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
23633 supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
23634 request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
23635 state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
23636 a different version of @value{GDBN}.
23637
23638 No values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
23639 are defined yet. Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
23640 @var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
23641 packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
23642 versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Values
23643 for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
23644 advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
23645 improvements in the remote protocol---support for unlimited length
23646 responses would be a @var{gdbfeature} example, if it were not implied by
23647 the @samp{qSupported} query. The stub's reply should be independent
23648 of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
23649 describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
23650 all the features it supports.
23651
23652 Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
23653 responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
23654
23655 Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
23656 should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
23657 require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
23658 form response.
23659
23660 Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
23661 @samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
23662 in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
23663 stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
23664
23665 Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
23666 mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
23667 architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
23668 about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
23669 stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
23670
23671 These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
23672
23673 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.2 0.12 0.2
23674 @c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
23675 @c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
23676 @item Feature Name
23677 @tab Value Required
23678 @tab Default
23679 @tab Probe Allowed
23680
23681 @item @samp{PacketSize}
23682 @tab Yes
23683 @tab @samp{-}
23684 @tab No
23685
23686 @item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
23687 @tab No
23688 @tab @samp{-}
23689 @tab Yes
23690
23691 @item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
23692 @tab No
23693 @tab @samp{-}
23694 @tab Yes
23695
23696 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
23697 @tab No
23698 @tab @samp{-}
23699 @tab Yes
23700
23701 @item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
23702 @tab No
23703 @tab @samp{-}
23704 @tab Yes
23705
23706 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:read}
23707 @tab No
23708 @tab @samp{-}
23709 @tab Yes
23710
23711 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:write}
23712 @tab No
23713 @tab @samp{-}
23714 @tab Yes
23715
23716 @item @samp{QPassSignals}
23717 @tab No
23718 @tab @samp{-}
23719 @tab Yes
23720
23721 @end multitable
23722
23723 These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
23724
23725 @table @samp
23726 @cindex packet size, remote protocol
23727 @item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
23728 The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
23729 length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
23730 transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
23731 data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
23732 There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
23733 stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
23734 byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
23735 @value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
23736
23737 @item qXfer:auxv:read
23738 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
23739 (@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
23740
23741 @item qXfer:features:read
23742 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
23743 (@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
23744
23745 @item qXfer:libraries:read
23746 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet
23747 (@pxref{qXfer library list read}).
23748
23749 @item qXfer:memory-map:read
23750 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
23751 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
23752
23753 @item qXfer:spu:read
23754 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:read} packet
23755 (@pxref{qXfer spu read}).
23756
23757 @item qXfer:spu:write
23758 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:write} packet
23759 (@pxref{qXfer spu write}).
23760
23761 @item QPassSignals
23762 The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
23763 (@pxref{QPassSignals}).
23764
23765 @end table
23766
23767 @item qSymbol::
23768 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
23769 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
23770 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
23771 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
23772
23773 Reply:
23774 @table @samp
23775 @item OK
23776 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
23777 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
23778 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
23779 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
23780 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
23781 below.
23782 @end table
23783
23784 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
23785 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
23786
23787 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
23788 target has previously requested.
23789
23790 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
23791 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
23792 will be empty.
23793
23794 Reply:
23795 @table @samp
23796 @item OK
23797 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
23798 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
23799 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
23800 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
23801 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
23802 @end table
23803
23804 @item QTDP
23805 @itemx QTFrame
23806 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
23807
23808 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{id}
23809 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
23810 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
23811 Obtain a printable string description of a thread's attributes from
23812 the target OS. @var{id} is a thread-id in big-endian hex. This
23813 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
23814 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
23815 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
23816 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
23817 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
23818
23819 Reply:
23820 @table @samp
23821 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
23822 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
23823 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
23824 the thread's attributes.
23825 @end table
23826
23827 (Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
23828 the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
23829 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
23830 packets.)
23831
23832 @item QTStart
23833 @itemx QTStop
23834 @itemx QTinit
23835 @itemx QTro
23836 @itemx qTStatus
23837 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
23838
23839 @item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
23840 @cindex read special object, remote request
23841 @cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
23842 @anchor{qXfer read}
23843 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
23844 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
23845 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
23846 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to @var{object}; it can supply
23847 additional details about what data to access.
23848
23849 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
23850 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
23851 formats, listed below.
23852
23853 @table @samp
23854 @item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
23855 @anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
23856 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
23857 auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
23858
23859 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
23860 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
23861
23862 @item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
23863 @anchor{qXfer target description read}
23864 Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The
23865 annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is
23866 always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
23867
23868 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
23869 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
23870
23871 @item qXfer:libraries:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
23872 @anchor{qXfer library list read}
23873 Access the target's list of loaded libraries. @xref{Library List Format}.
23874 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
23875 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
23876
23877 Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program's memory do
23878 not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms where
23879 the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries.
23880
23881 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
23882 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
23883
23884 @item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
23885 @anchor{qXfer memory map read}
23886 Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory Map Format}. The
23887 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
23888 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
23889
23890 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
23891 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
23892
23893 @item qXfer:spu:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
23894 @anchor{qXfer spu read}
23895 Read contents of an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
23896 annex specifies which file to read; it must be of the form
23897 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
23898 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
23899 in that context to be accessed.
23900
23901 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
23902 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
23903 @end table
23904
23905 Reply:
23906 @table @samp
23907 @item m @var{data}
23908 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
23909 target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
23910 it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
23911 block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
23912 @var{data} may have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
23913 request.
23914
23915 @item l @var{data}
23916 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
23917 There is no more data to be read. @var{data} may have fewer bytes
23918 than the @var{length} in the request.
23919
23920 @item l
23921 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
23922 There is no more data to be read.
23923
23924 @item E00
23925 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
23926
23927 @item E @var{nn}
23928 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
23929 @var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
23930
23931 @item
23932 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
23933 the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
23934 @end table
23935
23936 @item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
23937 @cindex write data into object, remote request
23938 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
23939 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
23940 into the data. @var{data}@dots{} is the binary-encoded data
23941 (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be written. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
23942 is specific to @var{object}; it can supply additional details about what data
23943 to access.
23944
23945 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
23946 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:write:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
23947 formats, listed below.
23948
23949 @table @samp
23950 @item qXfer:@var{spu}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
23951 @anchor{qXfer spu write}
23952 Write @var{data} to an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
23953 annex specifies which file to write; it must be of the form
23954 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
23955 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
23956 in that context to be accessed.
23957
23958 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
23959 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
23960 @end table
23961
23962 Reply:
23963 @table @samp
23964 @item @var{nn}
23965 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
23966 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
23967
23968 @item E00
23969 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
23970
23971 @item E @var{nn}
23972 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
23973 @var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
23974
23975 @item
23976 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
23977 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
23978 @end table
23979
23980 @item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
23981 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
23982 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
23983 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
23984 must respond with an empty packet.
23985
23986 @end table
23987
23988 @node Register Packet Format
23989 @section Register Packet Format
23990
23991 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
23992 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
23993 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
23994 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
23995 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
23996 most-significant - least-significant.
23997
23998 @table @r
23999
24000 @item MIPS32
24001
24002 All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
24003 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
24004 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
24005
24006 @item MIPS64
24007
24008 All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
24009 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
24010 as @code{MIPS32}.
24011
24012 @end table
24013
24014 @node Tracepoint Packets
24015 @section Tracepoint Packets
24016 @cindex tracepoint packets
24017 @cindex packets, tracepoint
24018
24019 Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
24020 tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
24021
24022 @table @samp
24023
24024 @item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}@r{[}-@r{]}
24025 Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
24026 is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
24027 the tracepoint is disabled. @var{step} is the tracepoint's step
24028 count, and @var{pass} is its pass count. If the trailing @samp{-} is
24029 present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this
24030 tracepoint's actions.
24031
24032 Replies:
24033 @table @samp
24034 @item OK
24035 The packet was understood and carried out.
24036 @item
24037 The packet was not recognized.
24038 @end table
24039
24040 @item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
24041 Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. @var{n} and
24042 @var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
24043 this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
24044 another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
24045 trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
24046 specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
24047
24048 In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
24049 can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
24050 is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
24051 actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
24052 taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
24053 @samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
24054 tracepoint actions.
24055
24056 The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
24057 actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
24058 following forms:
24059
24060 @table @samp
24061
24062 @item R @var{mask}
24063 Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask}. @var{mask} is
24064 a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
24065 @var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
24066 zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
24067 not fit in a 32-bit word.
24068
24069 @item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
24070 Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
24071 number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
24072 @samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
24073 address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
24074 @var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
24075 values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
24076
24077 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
24078 Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
24079 it directs. @var{expr} is an agent expression, as described in
24080 @ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
24081 two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
24082 in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
24083 packet).
24084
24085 @end table
24086
24087 Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
24088 packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
24089 length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
24090 action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
24091 actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
24092 must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
24093 ``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
24094 separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
24095
24096 Replies:
24097 @table @samp
24098 @item OK
24099 The packet was understood and carried out.
24100 @item
24101 The packet was not recognized.
24102 @end table
24103
24104 @item QTFrame:@var{n}
24105 Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
24106 register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
24107 request packets from @value{GDBN}.
24108
24109 A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
24110 requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
24111 without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
24112 one of the following forms:
24113
24114 @table @samp
24115 @item F @var{f}
24116 The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
24117 @var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
24118 was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
24119
24120 @item T @var{t}
24121 The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
24122 @var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
24123
24124 @end table
24125
24126 @item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
24127 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
24128 currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
24129 @var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
24130
24131 @item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
24132 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
24133 currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
24134 is a hexadecimal number.
24135
24136 @item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
24137 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
24138 currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
24139 and @var{end} (exclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
24140 numbers.
24141
24142 @item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
24143 Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
24144 frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses.
24145
24146 @item QTStart
24147 Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from tracepoint
24148 hits in the trace frame buffer.
24149
24150 @item QTStop
24151 End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
24152
24153 @item QTinit
24154 Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
24155
24156 @item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
24157 Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
24158 will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
24159 if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
24160
24161 @value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
24162 containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
24163 still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
24164 there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
24165
24166 @item qTStatus
24167 Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
24168
24169 Replies:
24170 @table @samp
24171 @item T0
24172 There is no trace experiment running.
24173 @item T1
24174 There is a trace experiment running.
24175 @end table
24176
24177 @end table
24178
24179
24180 @node Interrupts
24181 @section Interrupts
24182 @cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
24183
24184 When a program on the remote target is running, @value{GDBN} may
24185 attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C} or a @code{BREAK},
24186 control of which is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{remotebreak}
24187 setting (@pxref{set remotebreak}).
24188
24189 The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
24190 mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does
24191 not currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
24192 interfaces.
24193
24194 @samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
24195 transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
24196 @code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
24197 the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
24198 transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
24199 and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
24200 (@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
24201 @code{0x03} as part of its packet.
24202
24203 Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
24204 precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
24205 implementation defined. If the stub is successful at interrupting the
24206 running program, it is expected that it will send one of the Stop
24207 Reply Packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
24208 of successfully stopping the program. Interrupts received while the
24209 program is stopped will be discarded.
24210
24211 @node Examples
24212 @section Examples
24213
24214 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
24215 does not get any direct output:
24216
24217 @smallexample
24218 -> @code{R00}
24219 <- @code{+}
24220 @emph{target restarts}
24221 -> @code{?}
24222 <- @code{+}
24223 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
24224 -> @code{+}
24225 @end smallexample
24226
24227 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
24228
24229 @smallexample
24230 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
24231 <- @code{+}
24232 -> @code{s}
24233 <- @code{+}
24234 @emph{time passes}
24235 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
24236 -> @code{+}
24237 -> @code{g}
24238 <- @code{+}
24239 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
24240 -> @code{+}
24241 @end smallexample
24242
24243 @node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
24244 @section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
24245 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
24246
24247 @menu
24248 * File-I/O Overview::
24249 * Protocol Basics::
24250 * The F Request Packet::
24251 * The F Reply Packet::
24252 * The Ctrl-C Message::
24253 * Console I/O::
24254 * List of Supported Calls::
24255 * Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes::
24256 * Constants::
24257 * File-I/O Examples::
24258 @end menu
24259
24260 @node File-I/O Overview
24261 @subsection File-I/O Overview
24262 @cindex file-i/o overview
24263
24264 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
24265 target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
24266 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
24267 remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
24268 actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
24269 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
24270
24271 The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
24272 It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
24273 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
24274 translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
24275 protocol representations when data is transmitted.
24276
24277 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
24278 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
24279 or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
24280 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
24281 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
24282 the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
24283 (@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
24284
24285 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
24286 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
24287 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
24288 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
24289 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
24290
24291 @smallexample
24292 (@value{GDBP}) continue
24293 <- target requests 'system call X'
24294 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
24295 -> @value{GDBN} returns result
24296 ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target
24297 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
24298 @end smallexample
24299
24300 The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
24301 the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
24302 named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
24303 system are not supported by this protocol.
24304
24305 @node Protocol Basics
24306 @subsection Protocol Basics
24307 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
24308
24309 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
24310 as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
24311 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
24312 the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
24313 of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
24314 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
24315 to call the appropriate host system call:
24316
24317 @itemize @bullet
24318 @item
24319 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
24320
24321 @item
24322 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
24323 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
24324 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
24325 Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation.
24326
24327 @end itemize
24328
24329 At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
24330
24331 @itemize @bullet
24332 @item
24333 If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
24334 system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
24335 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
24336 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
24337 packet.
24338
24339 @item
24340 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
24341 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
24342
24343 @item
24344 @value{GDBN} calls the system call.
24345
24346 @item
24347 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
24348
24349 @item
24350 If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
24351 by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
24352 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
24353 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
24354 packet.
24355
24356 @end itemize
24357
24358 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
24359 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
24360
24361 @itemize @bullet
24362 @item
24363 Return value.
24364
24365 @item
24366 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
24367
24368 @item
24369 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
24370
24371 @end itemize
24372
24373 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
24374 the latest continue or step action.
24375
24376 @node The F Request Packet
24377 @subsection The @code{F} Request Packet
24378 @cindex file-i/o request packet
24379 @cindex @code{F} request packet
24380
24381 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
24382
24383 @table @samp
24384 @item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
24385
24386 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
24387 This is just the name of the function.
24388
24389 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
24390 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
24391 of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
24392 datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
24393 of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
24394 comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
24395 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
24396
24397 @end table
24398
24399
24400
24401 @node The F Reply Packet
24402 @subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet
24403 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
24404 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
24405
24406 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
24407
24408 @table @samp
24409
24410 @item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific
24411 attachment}
24412
24413 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
24414
24415 @var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific
24416 representation.
24417 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
24418
24419 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
24420 case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
24421 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
24422
24423 @smallexample
24424 F0,0,C
24425 @end smallexample
24426
24427 @noindent
24428 or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
24429
24430 @smallexample
24431 F-1,4,C
24432 @end smallexample
24433
24434 @noindent
24435 assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
24436
24437 @end table
24438
24439
24440 @node The Ctrl-C Message
24441 @subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message
24442 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
24443
24444 If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
24445 reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}),
24446 the target should behave as if it had
24447 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
24448 interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
24449 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
24450 packet.
24451
24452 It's important for the target to know in which
24453 state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
24454
24455 @itemize @bullet
24456 @item
24457 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
24458
24459 @item
24460 The system call on the host has been finished.
24461
24462 @end itemize
24463
24464 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
24465 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
24466 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
24467 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
24468 system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
24469 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
24470
24471 @value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
24472 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
24473 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
24474 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
24475 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
24476 The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
24477 or the full action has been completed.
24478
24479 @node Console I/O
24480 @subsection Console I/O
24481 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
24482
24483 By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file
24484 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
24485 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
24486 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
24487 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
24488 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
24489 conditions is met:
24490
24491 @itemize @bullet
24492 @item
24493 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
24494 @code{read}
24495 system call is treated as finished.
24496
24497 @item
24498 The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
24499 newline.
24500
24501 @item
24502 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
24503 character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
24504
24505 @end itemize
24506
24507 If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
24508 the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
24509 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
24510 is stopped at the user's request.
24511
24512
24513 @node List of Supported Calls
24514 @subsection List of Supported Calls
24515 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
24516
24517 @menu
24518 * open::
24519 * close::
24520 * read::
24521 * write::
24522 * lseek::
24523 * rename::
24524 * unlink::
24525 * stat/fstat::
24526 * gettimeofday::
24527 * isatty::
24528 * system::
24529 @end menu
24530
24531 @node open
24532 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
24533 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
24534
24535 @table @asis
24536 @item Synopsis:
24537 @smallexample
24538 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
24539 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
24540 @end smallexample
24541
24542 @item Request:
24543 @samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
24544
24545 @noindent
24546 @var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
24547
24548 @table @code
24549 @item O_CREAT
24550 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
24551 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
24552 are concerned.
24553
24554 @item O_EXCL
24555 When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
24556 an error and open() fails.
24557
24558 @item O_TRUNC
24559 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
24560 writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
24561 truncated to zero length.
24562
24563 @item O_APPEND
24564 The file is opened in append mode.
24565
24566 @item O_RDONLY
24567 The file is opened for reading only.
24568
24569 @item O_WRONLY
24570 The file is opened for writing only.
24571
24572 @item O_RDWR
24573 The file is opened for reading and writing.
24574 @end table
24575
24576 @noindent
24577 Other bits are silently ignored.
24578
24579
24580 @noindent
24581 @var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
24582
24583 @table @code
24584 @item S_IRUSR
24585 User has read permission.
24586
24587 @item S_IWUSR
24588 User has write permission.
24589
24590 @item S_IRGRP
24591 Group has read permission.
24592
24593 @item S_IWGRP
24594 Group has write permission.
24595
24596 @item S_IROTH
24597 Others have read permission.
24598
24599 @item S_IWOTH
24600 Others have write permission.
24601 @end table
24602
24603 @noindent
24604 Other bits are silently ignored.
24605
24606
24607 @item Return value:
24608 @code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
24609 occurred.
24610
24611 @item Errors:
24612
24613 @table @code
24614 @item EEXIST
24615 @var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
24616
24617 @item EISDIR
24618 @var{pathname} refers to a directory.
24619
24620 @item EACCES
24621 The requested access is not allowed.
24622
24623 @item ENAMETOOLONG
24624 @var{pathname} was too long.
24625
24626 @item ENOENT
24627 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
24628
24629 @item ENODEV
24630 @var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
24631
24632 @item EROFS
24633 @var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
24634 write access was requested.
24635
24636 @item EFAULT
24637 @var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
24638
24639 @item ENOSPC
24640 No space on device to create the file.
24641
24642 @item EMFILE
24643 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
24644
24645 @item ENFILE
24646 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
24647 has been reached.
24648
24649 @item EINTR
24650 The call was interrupted by the user.
24651 @end table
24652
24653 @end table
24654
24655 @node close
24656 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
24657 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
24658
24659 @table @asis
24660 @item Synopsis:
24661 @smallexample
24662 int close(int fd);
24663 @end smallexample
24664
24665 @item Request:
24666 @samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
24667
24668 @item Return value:
24669 @code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
24670
24671 @item Errors:
24672
24673 @table @code
24674 @item EBADF
24675 @var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
24676
24677 @item EINTR
24678 The call was interrupted by the user.
24679 @end table
24680
24681 @end table
24682
24683 @node read
24684 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
24685 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
24686
24687 @table @asis
24688 @item Synopsis:
24689 @smallexample
24690 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
24691 @end smallexample
24692
24693 @item Request:
24694 @samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
24695
24696 @item Return value:
24697 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
24698 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
24699 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
24700
24701 @item Errors:
24702
24703 @table @code
24704 @item EBADF
24705 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
24706 reading.
24707
24708 @item EFAULT
24709 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
24710
24711 @item EINTR
24712 The call was interrupted by the user.
24713 @end table
24714
24715 @end table
24716
24717 @node write
24718 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
24719 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
24720
24721 @table @asis
24722 @item Synopsis:
24723 @smallexample
24724 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
24725 @end smallexample
24726
24727 @item Request:
24728 @samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
24729
24730 @item Return value:
24731 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
24732 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
24733 is returned.
24734
24735 @item Errors:
24736
24737 @table @code
24738 @item EBADF
24739 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
24740 writing.
24741
24742 @item EFAULT
24743 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
24744
24745 @item EFBIG
24746 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
24747 host-specific maximum file size allowed.
24748
24749 @item ENOSPC
24750 No space on device to write the data.
24751
24752 @item EINTR
24753 The call was interrupted by the user.
24754 @end table
24755
24756 @end table
24757
24758 @node lseek
24759 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
24760 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
24761
24762 @table @asis
24763 @item Synopsis:
24764 @smallexample
24765 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
24766 @end smallexample
24767
24768 @item Request:
24769 @samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
24770
24771 @var{flag} is one of:
24772
24773 @table @code
24774 @item SEEK_SET
24775 The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
24776
24777 @item SEEK_CUR
24778 The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
24779 bytes.
24780
24781 @item SEEK_END
24782 The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
24783 bytes.
24784 @end table
24785
24786 @item Return value:
24787 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
24788 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
24789 value of -1 is returned.
24790
24791 @item Errors:
24792
24793 @table @code
24794 @item EBADF
24795 @var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
24796
24797 @item ESPIPE
24798 @var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
24799
24800 @item EINVAL
24801 @var{flag} is not a proper value.
24802
24803 @item EINTR
24804 The call was interrupted by the user.
24805 @end table
24806
24807 @end table
24808
24809 @node rename
24810 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
24811 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
24812
24813 @table @asis
24814 @item Synopsis:
24815 @smallexample
24816 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
24817 @end smallexample
24818
24819 @item Request:
24820 @samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
24821
24822 @item Return value:
24823 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
24824
24825 @item Errors:
24826
24827 @table @code
24828 @item EISDIR
24829 @var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
24830 directory.
24831
24832 @item EEXIST
24833 @var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
24834
24835 @item EBUSY
24836 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
24837 process.
24838
24839 @item EINVAL
24840 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
24841 of itself.
24842
24843 @item ENOTDIR
24844 A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
24845 path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
24846 and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
24847
24848 @item EFAULT
24849 @var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
24850
24851 @item EACCES
24852 No access to the file or the path of the file.
24853
24854 @item ENAMETOOLONG
24855
24856 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
24857
24858 @item ENOENT
24859 A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
24860
24861 @item EROFS
24862 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
24863
24864 @item ENOSPC
24865 The device containing the file has no room for the new
24866 directory entry.
24867
24868 @item EINTR
24869 The call was interrupted by the user.
24870 @end table
24871
24872 @end table
24873
24874 @node unlink
24875 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
24876 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
24877
24878 @table @asis
24879 @item Synopsis:
24880 @smallexample
24881 int unlink(const char *pathname);
24882 @end smallexample
24883
24884 @item Request:
24885 @samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
24886
24887 @item Return value:
24888 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
24889
24890 @item Errors:
24891
24892 @table @code
24893 @item EACCES
24894 No access to the file or the path of the file.
24895
24896 @item EPERM
24897 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
24898
24899 @item EBUSY
24900 The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
24901 being used by another process.
24902
24903 @item EFAULT
24904 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
24905
24906 @item ENAMETOOLONG
24907 @var{pathname} was too long.
24908
24909 @item ENOENT
24910 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
24911
24912 @item ENOTDIR
24913 A component of the path is not a directory.
24914
24915 @item EROFS
24916 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
24917
24918 @item EINTR
24919 The call was interrupted by the user.
24920 @end table
24921
24922 @end table
24923
24924 @node stat/fstat
24925 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
24926 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
24927 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
24928
24929 @table @asis
24930 @item Synopsis:
24931 @smallexample
24932 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
24933 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
24934 @end smallexample
24935
24936 @item Request:
24937 @samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
24938 @samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
24939
24940 @item Return value:
24941 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
24942
24943 @item Errors:
24944
24945 @table @code
24946 @item EBADF
24947 @var{fd} is not a valid open file.
24948
24949 @item ENOENT
24950 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
24951 path is an empty string.
24952
24953 @item ENOTDIR
24954 A component of the path is not a directory.
24955
24956 @item EFAULT
24957 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
24958
24959 @item EACCES
24960 No access to the file or the path of the file.
24961
24962 @item ENAMETOOLONG
24963 @var{pathname} was too long.
24964
24965 @item EINTR
24966 The call was interrupted by the user.
24967 @end table
24968
24969 @end table
24970
24971 @node gettimeofday
24972 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
24973 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
24974
24975 @table @asis
24976 @item Synopsis:
24977 @smallexample
24978 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
24979 @end smallexample
24980
24981 @item Request:
24982 @samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
24983
24984 @item Return value:
24985 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
24986
24987 @item Errors:
24988
24989 @table @code
24990 @item EINVAL
24991 @var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
24992
24993 @item EFAULT
24994 @var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
24995 @end table
24996
24997 @end table
24998
24999 @node isatty
25000 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
25001 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
25002
25003 @table @asis
25004 @item Synopsis:
25005 @smallexample
25006 int isatty(int fd);
25007 @end smallexample
25008
25009 @item Request:
25010 @samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
25011
25012 @item Return value:
25013 Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
25014
25015 @item Errors:
25016
25017 @table @code
25018 @item EINTR
25019 The call was interrupted by the user.
25020 @end table
25021
25022 @end table
25023
25024 Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
25025 1 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
25026 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
25027 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
25028 needed.
25029
25030
25031 @node system
25032 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
25033 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
25034
25035 @table @asis
25036 @item Synopsis:
25037 @smallexample
25038 int system(const char *command);
25039 @end smallexample
25040
25041 @item Request:
25042 @samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
25043
25044 @item Return value:
25045 If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
25046 available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
25047 For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
25048 return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
25049 command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
25050 return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
25051 @file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
25052
25053 @item Errors:
25054
25055 @table @code
25056 @item EINTR
25057 The call was interrupted by the user.
25058 @end table
25059
25060 @end table
25061
25062 @value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
25063 to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
25064 the host is simplified before it's returned
25065 to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
25066 is discarded, and the return value consists
25067 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
25068
25069 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
25070 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
25071 @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
25072
25073 @table @code
25074 @item set remote system-call-allowed
25075 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
25076 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
25077 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
25078
25079 @item show remote system-call-allowed
25080 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
25081 Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
25082 protocol.
25083 @end table
25084
25085 @node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
25086 @subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
25087 @cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
25088
25089 @menu
25090 * Integral Datatypes::
25091 * Pointer Values::
25092 * Memory Transfer::
25093 * struct stat::
25094 * struct timeval::
25095 @end menu
25096
25097 @node Integral Datatypes
25098 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes
25099 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
25100
25101 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
25102 @code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
25103 @code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
25104
25105 @code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
25106 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
25107
25108 @code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
25109
25110 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
25111 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
25112
25113 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
25114
25115 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
25116 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
25117 byte order.
25118
25119 @node Pointer Values
25120 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values
25121 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
25122
25123 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
25124 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
25125 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
25126 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
25127
25128 @smallexample
25129 @code{1aaf/12}
25130 @end smallexample
25131
25132 @noindent
25133 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
25134 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
25135 the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
25136 at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
25137
25138 @smallexample
25139 @code{123456/d}
25140 @end smallexample
25141
25142 @node Memory Transfer
25143 @unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer
25144 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
25145
25146 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
25147 example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format
25148 with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
25149 this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
25150 packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
25151 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
25152 data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
25153
25154
25155 @node struct stat
25156 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
25157 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
25158
25159 The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
25160 is defined as follows:
25161
25162 @smallexample
25163 struct stat @{
25164 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
25165 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
25166 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
25167 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
25168 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
25169 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
25170 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
25171 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
25172 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
25173 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
25174 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
25175 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
25176 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
25177 @};
25178 @end smallexample
25179
25180 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
25181 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
25182 structure is of size 64 bytes.
25183
25184 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
25185 range of values.
25186
25187 @table @code
25188
25189 @item st_dev
25190 A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
25191
25192 @item st_ino
25193 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
25194
25195 @item st_mode
25196 Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
25197 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
25198
25199 @item st_uid
25200 @itemx st_gid
25201 @itemx st_rdev
25202 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
25203
25204 @item st_atime
25205 @itemx st_mtime
25206 @itemx st_ctime
25207 These values have a host and file system dependent
25208 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
25209 support exact timing values.
25210 @end table
25211
25212 The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
25213 responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
25214 continuing.
25215
25216 Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
25217 representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
25218 get truncated on the target.
25219
25220 @node struct timeval
25221 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
25222 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
25223
25224 The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
25225 is defined as follows:
25226
25227 @smallexample
25228 struct timeval @{
25229 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
25230 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
25231 @};
25232 @end smallexample
25233
25234 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
25235 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
25236 structure is of size 8 bytes.
25237
25238 @node Constants
25239 @subsection Constants
25240 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
25241
25242 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
25243 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
25244 values before and after the call as needed.
25245
25246 @menu
25247 * Open Flags::
25248 * mode_t Values::
25249 * Errno Values::
25250 * Lseek Flags::
25251 * Limits::
25252 @end menu
25253
25254 @node Open Flags
25255 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags
25256 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
25257
25258 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
25259
25260 @smallexample
25261 O_RDONLY 0x0
25262 O_WRONLY 0x1
25263 O_RDWR 0x2
25264 O_APPEND 0x8
25265 O_CREAT 0x200
25266 O_TRUNC 0x400
25267 O_EXCL 0x800
25268 @end smallexample
25269
25270 @node mode_t Values
25271 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values
25272 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
25273
25274 All values are given in octal representation.
25275
25276 @smallexample
25277 S_IFREG 0100000
25278 S_IFDIR 040000
25279 S_IRUSR 0400
25280 S_IWUSR 0200
25281 S_IXUSR 0100
25282 S_IRGRP 040
25283 S_IWGRP 020
25284 S_IXGRP 010
25285 S_IROTH 04
25286 S_IWOTH 02
25287 S_IXOTH 01
25288 @end smallexample
25289
25290 @node Errno Values
25291 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values
25292 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
25293
25294 All values are given in decimal representation.
25295
25296 @smallexample
25297 EPERM 1
25298 ENOENT 2
25299 EINTR 4
25300 EBADF 9
25301 EACCES 13
25302 EFAULT 14
25303 EBUSY 16
25304 EEXIST 17
25305 ENODEV 19
25306 ENOTDIR 20
25307 EISDIR 21
25308 EINVAL 22
25309 ENFILE 23
25310 EMFILE 24
25311 EFBIG 27
25312 ENOSPC 28
25313 ESPIPE 29
25314 EROFS 30
25315 ENAMETOOLONG 91
25316 EUNKNOWN 9999
25317 @end smallexample
25318
25319 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
25320 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
25321
25322 @node Lseek Flags
25323 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags
25324 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
25325
25326 @smallexample
25327 SEEK_SET 0
25328 SEEK_CUR 1
25329 SEEK_END 2
25330 @end smallexample
25331
25332 @node Limits
25333 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
25334 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
25335
25336 All values are given in decimal representation.
25337
25338 @smallexample
25339 INT_MIN -2147483648
25340 INT_MAX 2147483647
25341 UINT_MAX 4294967295
25342 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
25343 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
25344 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
25345 @end smallexample
25346
25347 @node File-I/O Examples
25348 @subsection File-I/O Examples
25349 @cindex file-i/o examples
25350
25351 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
25352 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
25353
25354 @smallexample
25355 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
25356 @emph{request memory read from target}
25357 -> @code{m1234,6}
25358 <- XXXXXX
25359 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
25360 -> @code{F6}
25361 @end smallexample
25362
25363 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
25364 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
25365
25366 @smallexample
25367 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
25368 @emph{request memory write to target}
25369 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
25370 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
25371 -> @code{F6}
25372 @end smallexample
25373
25374 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
25375 file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
25376
25377 @smallexample
25378 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
25379 -> @code{F-1,9}
25380 @end smallexample
25381
25382 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
25383 host is called:
25384
25385 @smallexample
25386 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
25387 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
25388 <- @code{T02}
25389 @end smallexample
25390
25391 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
25392 host is called:
25393
25394 @smallexample
25395 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
25396 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
25397 <- @code{T02}
25398 @end smallexample
25399
25400 @node Library List Format
25401 @section Library List Format
25402 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
25403
25404 On some platforms, a dynamic loader (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) runs in the
25405 same process as your application to manage libraries. In this case,
25406 @value{GDBN} can use the loader's symbol table and normal memory
25407 operations to maintain a list of shared libraries. On other
25408 platforms, the operating system manages loaded libraries.
25409 @value{GDBN} can not retrieve the list of currently loaded libraries
25410 through memory operations, so it uses the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
25411 packet (@pxref{qXfer library list read}) instead. The remote stub
25412 queries the target's operating system and reports which libraries
25413 are loaded.
25414
25415 The @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet returns an XML document which
25416 lists loaded libraries and their offsets. Each library has an
25417 associated name and one or more segment base addresses, which report
25418 where the library was loaded in memory. The segment bases are start
25419 addresses, not relocation offsets; they do not depend on the library's
25420 link-time base addresses.
25421
25422 A simple memory map, with one loaded library relocated by a single
25423 offset, looks like this:
25424
25425 @smallexample
25426 <library-list>
25427 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6">
25428 <segment address="0x10000000"/>
25429 </library>
25430 </library-list>
25431 @end smallexample
25432
25433 The format of a library list is described by this DTD:
25434
25435 @smallexample
25436 <!-- library-list: Root element with versioning -->
25437 <!ELEMENT library-list (library)*>
25438 <!ATTLIST library-list version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
25439 <!ELEMENT library (segment)*>
25440 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
25441 <!ELEMENT segment EMPTY>
25442 <!ATTLIST segment address CDATA #REQUIRED>
25443 @end smallexample
25444
25445 @node Memory Map Format
25446 @section Memory Map Format
25447 @cindex memory map format
25448
25449 To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
25450 memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
25451 memory map.
25452
25453 The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
25454 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
25455 lists memory regions. The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
25456
25457 @smallexample
25458 <?xml version="1.0"?>
25459 <!DOCTYPE memory-map
25460 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
25461 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
25462 <memory-map>
25463 region...
25464 </memory-map>
25465 @end smallexample
25466
25467 Each region can be either:
25468
25469 @itemize
25470
25471 @item
25472 A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
25473 bytes from there:
25474
25475 @smallexample
25476 <memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
25477 @end smallexample
25478
25479
25480 @item
25481 A region of read-only memory:
25482
25483 @smallexample
25484 <memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
25485 @end smallexample
25486
25487
25488 @item
25489 A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
25490 bytes in length:
25491
25492 @smallexample
25493 <memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
25494 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
25495 </memory>
25496 @end smallexample
25497
25498 @end itemize
25499
25500 Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
25501 by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
25502 packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
25503
25504 The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
25505
25506 @smallexample
25507 <!-- ................................................... -->
25508 <!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
25509 <!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
25510 <!-- .................................... .............. -->
25511 <!-- memory-map.dtd -->
25512 <!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
25513 <!ELEMENT memory-map (memory | property)>
25514 <!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
25515 <!ELEMENT memory (property)>
25516 <!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
25517 and its type, or device. -->
25518 <!ATTLIST memory type CDATA #REQUIRED
25519 start CDATA #REQUIRED
25520 length CDATA #REQUIRED
25521 device CDATA #IMPLIED>
25522 <!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
25523 <!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
25524 <!ATTLIST property name CDATA #REQUIRED>
25525 @end smallexample
25526
25527 @include agentexpr.texi
25528
25529 @node Target Descriptions
25530 @appendix Target Descriptions
25531 @cindex target descriptions
25532
25533 @strong{Warning:} target descriptions are still under active development,
25534 and the contents and format may change between @value{GDBN} releases.
25535 The format is expected to stabilize in the future.
25536
25537 One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
25538 is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
25539 architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with
25540 a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or MIPS, for example ---
25541 and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some
25542 architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
25543 vendors. This leads to a number of problems:
25544
25545 @itemize @bullet
25546 @item
25547 With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
25548 the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
25549 @item
25550 Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
25551 audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
25552 variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
25553 @item
25554 When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
25555 at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
25556 @command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
25557 @end itemize
25558
25559 To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
25560 target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
25561 actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support
25562 processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
25563 descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
25564
25565 @value{GDBN} must be compiled with Expat support to support XML target
25566 descriptions. @xref{Expat}.
25567
25568 @menu
25569 * Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target.
25570 * Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description.
25571 * Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target
25572 descriptions.
25573 * Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about.
25574 @end menu
25575
25576 @node Retrieving Descriptions
25577 @section Retrieving Descriptions
25578
25579 Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
25580 specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the
25581 description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
25582 protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
25583 qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
25584 @samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
25585 XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
25586 Format}.
25587
25588 Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
25589 If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to
25590 specify a file are:
25591
25592 @table @code
25593 @cindex set tdesc filename
25594 @item set tdesc filename @var{path}
25595 Read the target description from @var{path}.
25596
25597 @cindex unset tdesc filename
25598 @item unset tdesc filename
25599 Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN}
25600 will use the description supplied by the current target.
25601
25602 @cindex show tdesc filename
25603 @item show tdesc filename
25604 Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
25605 @end table
25606
25607
25608 @node Target Description Format
25609 @section Target Description Format
25610 @cindex target descriptions, XML format
25611
25612 A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
25613 document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
25614 the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This
25615 means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
25616 check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
25617 However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
25618 their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
25619
25620 Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target
25621 and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register
25622 sets. @value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your
25623 target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
25624
25625 Here is a simple target description:
25626
25627 @smallexample
25628 <target version="1.0">
25629 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
25630 </target>
25631 @end smallexample
25632
25633 @noindent
25634 This minimal description only says that the target uses
25635 the x86-64 architecture.
25636
25637 A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking
25638 optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements
25639 are explained further below.
25640
25641 @smallexample
25642 <?xml version="1.0"?>
25643 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
25644 <target version="1.0">
25645 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]}
25646 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]}
25647 </target>
25648 @end smallexample
25649
25650 @noindent
25651 The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
25652 breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version
25653 declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
25654 (@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
25655 useful for XML validation tools. The @samp{version} attribute for
25656 @samp{<target>} may also be omitted, but we recommend
25657 including it; if future versions of @value{GDBN} use an incompatible
25658 revision of @file{gdb-target.dtd}, they will detect and report
25659 the version mismatch.
25660
25661 @subsection Inclusion
25662 @cindex target descriptions, inclusion
25663 @cindex XInclude
25664 @ifnotinfo
25665 @cindex <xi:include>
25666 @end ifnotinfo
25667
25668 It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into
25669 several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to
25670 share files between different possible target descriptions. You can
25671 divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of
25672 the target description with an inclusion directive of the form:
25673
25674 @smallexample
25675 <xi:include href="@var{document}"/>
25676 @end smallexample
25677
25678 @noindent
25679 When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve
25680 the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with
25681 the contents of that document. If the current description was read
25682 using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document;
25683 @var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the
25684 current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for
25685 @var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the
25686 original description.
25687
25688 @subsection Architecture
25689 @cindex <architecture>
25690
25691 An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form:
25692
25693 @smallexample
25694 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture>
25695 @end smallexample
25696
25697 @var{arch} is an architecture name from the same selection
25698 accepted by @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a
25699 Debugging Target}).
25700
25701 @subsection Features
25702 @cindex <feature>
25703
25704 Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target
25705 system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU
25706 registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element
25707 has this form:
25708
25709 @smallexample
25710 <feature name="@var{name}">
25711 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]}
25712 @var{reg}@dots{}
25713 </feature>
25714 @end smallexample
25715
25716 @noindent
25717 Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name
25718 of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special
25719 knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature
25720 should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}.
25721
25722 @subsection Types
25723
25724 Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must
25725 interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer,
25726 but other types can be requested by name in the register description.
25727 Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined
25728 Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite types.
25729
25730 Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives
25731 a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type.
25732 Types must be defined before they are used.
25733
25734 @cindex <vector>
25735 Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays
25736 of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements,
25737 specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements,
25738 @var{count}:
25739
25740 @smallexample
25741 <vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/>
25742 @end smallexample
25743
25744 @cindex <union>
25745 If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it
25746 with a union type containing the useful representations. The
25747 @samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements,
25748 each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}:
25749
25750 @smallexample
25751 <union id="@var{id}">
25752 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
25753 @dots{}
25754 </union>
25755 @end smallexample
25756
25757 @subsection Registers
25758 @cindex <reg>
25759
25760 Each register is represented as an element with this form:
25761
25762 @smallexample
25763 <reg name="@var{name}"
25764 bitsize="@var{size}"
25765 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]}
25766 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]}
25767 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]}
25768 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/>
25769 @end smallexample
25770
25771 @noindent
25772 The components are as follows:
25773
25774 @table @var
25775
25776 @item name
25777 The register's name; it must be unique within the target description.
25778
25779 @item bitsize
25780 The register's size, in bits.
25781
25782 @item regnum
25783 The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater
25784 than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in
25785 a preceeding feature); the first register in the target description
25786 defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write
25787 the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P}
25788 packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets
25789 in order of increasing register number.
25790
25791 @item save-restore
25792 Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function
25793 calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is
25794 @code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for
25795 some system control registers; this is not related to the target's
25796 ABI.
25797
25798 @item type
25799 The type of the register. @var{type} may be a predefined type, a type
25800 defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int}
25801 and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size
25802 for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the
25803 architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for
25804 @var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}.
25805
25806 @item group
25807 The register group to which this register belongs. @var{group} must
25808 be either @code{general}, @code{float}, or @code{vector}. If no
25809 @var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register
25810 in @code{info registers}.
25811
25812 @end table
25813
25814 @node Predefined Target Types
25815 @section Predefined Target Types
25816 @cindex target descriptions, predefined types
25817
25818 Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types
25819 from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead,
25820 standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental
25821 types. The currently supported types are:
25822
25823 @table @code
25824
25825 @item int8
25826 @itemx int16
25827 @itemx int32
25828 @itemx int64
25829 Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
25830
25831 @item uint8
25832 @itemx uint16
25833 @itemx uint32
25834 @itemx uint64
25835 Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
25836
25837 @item code_ptr
25838 @itemx data_ptr
25839 Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and
25840 any dedicated return address register may be marked as code
25841 pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic
25842 address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers
25843 may be marked as data pointers.
25844
25845 @item ieee_single
25846 Single precision IEEE floating point.
25847
25848 @item ieee_double
25849 Double precision IEEE floating point.
25850
25851 @item arm_fpa_ext
25852 The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
25853
25854 @end table
25855
25856 @node Standard Target Features
25857 @section Standard Target Features
25858 @cindex target descriptions, standard features
25859
25860 A target description must contain either no registers or all the
25861 target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then
25862 @value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on
25863 the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the
25864 default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be
25865 described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN}
25866 can recognize them.
25867
25868 This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements
25869 which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features
25870 with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers;
25871 if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required
25872 feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target
25873 description. You can add additional registers to any of the
25874 standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if
25875 they were added to an unrecognized feature.
25876
25877 This section lists the known features and their expected contents.
25878 Sample XML documents for these features are included in the
25879 @value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}.
25880
25881 Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the
25882 company or organization which selected the name, and the overall
25883 architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature
25884 containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}.
25885
25886 The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose
25887 of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display
25888 registers using the capitalization used in the description.
25889
25890 @menu
25891 * ARM Features::
25892 * M68K Features::
25893 @end menu
25894
25895
25896 @node ARM Features
25897 @subsection ARM Features
25898 @cindex target descriptions, ARM features
25899
25900 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for ARM targets.
25901 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp},
25902 @samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
25903
25904 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it
25905 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}.
25906
25907 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present,
25908 it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and
25909 @samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon},
25910 @samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional.
25911
25912 @subsection MIPS Features
25913 @cindex target descriptions, MIPS features
25914
25915 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cpu} feature is required for MIPS targets.
25916 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, @samp{lo},
25917 @samp{hi}, and @samp{pc}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending
25918 on the target.
25919
25920 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cp0} feature is also required. It should
25921 contain at least the @samp{status}, @samp{badvaddr}, and @samp{cause}
25922 registers. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
25923
25924 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.fpu} feature is currently required, though
25925 it may be optional in a future version of @value{GDBN}. It should
25926 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcsr}, and
25927 @samp{fir}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
25928
25929 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.linux} feature is optional. It should
25930 contain a single register, @samp{restart}, which is used by the
25931 Linux kernel to control restartable syscalls.
25932
25933 @node M68K Features
25934 @subsection M68K Features
25935 @cindex target descriptions, M68K features
25936
25937 @table @code
25938 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.m68k.core}
25939 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.core}
25940 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.fido.core}
25941 One of those features must be always present.
25942 The feature that is present determines which flavor of m86k is
25943 used. The feature that is present should contain registers
25944 @samp{d0} through @samp{d7}, @samp{a0} through @samp{a5}, @samp{fp},
25945 @samp{sp}, @samp{ps} and @samp{pc}.
25946
25947 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.fp}
25948 This feature is optional. If present, it should contain registers
25949 @samp{fp0} through @samp{fp7}, @samp{fpcontrol}, @samp{fpstatus} and
25950 @samp{fpiaddr}.
25951 @end table
25952
25953 @include gpl.texi
25954
25955 @raisesections
25956 @include fdl.texi
25957 @lowersections
25958
25959 @node Index
25960 @unnumbered Index
25961
25962 @printindex cp
25963
25964 @tex
25965 % I think something like @colophon should be in texinfo. In the
25966 % meantime:
25967 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
25968 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
25969 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
25970 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
25971 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
25972 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
25973 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
25974 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
25975 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
25976 \page\colophon
25977 % Blame: doc@cygnus.com, 1991.
25978 @end tex
25979
25980 @bye
This page took 0.675557 seconds and 4 git commands to generate.